181 47 32MB
English Pages 706 [686] Year 1984
Marker Proteins in Inflammation Volume 2
Marker Proteins in Inflammation Volume 2 Proceedings of the Second Symposium Lyon, France, June 27 - 30,1983 Editors P Arnaud • J. Bienvenu • P Laurent
W G DE
Walter de Gruyter • Berlin • New York 1984
Editors Philippe Arnaud, Ph. D., M. D. Department of Basic and Clinical Immunology and Microbiology Medical University of South Carolina 171 Ashley Road Charleston, South Carolina 29403 U.S.A. Jacques Bienvenu, M. D. Biochemical Laboratory Hôpital Jules Courmont F - 6 9 3 1 0 Pierre Bénite France Philippe Laurent, M. D. Department of Immunology Institut Pasteur de Lyon 77, Rue Pasteur F - 69365 Lyon Cedex 2 France CIP-Kurztitelaufnahme der Deutschen
Bibliothek
Marker proteins in inflammation: proceedings of t h e . . . symposium. - Berlin ; New York : de Gruyter Vol. 2. Proceedings of the second symposium, Lyon, France, June 2 7 - 3 0 , 1 9 8 3 . - 1 9 8 4 . ISBN 3-11-009872-5
Library of Congress Cataloging in Publication Data Main entry under title: Marker proteins in inflammation, volume 2. Proceedings of the "Second Symposium sur les marqueurs de l'inflammation," sponsored by the Groupe d'étude et de recherche sur les marqueurs de l'inflammation (GERMI) Bibliography: p. Includes indexes. 1. Inflammation—Congresses. 2. Proteins—Congresses. I. Arnaud, P (Philippe) II. Bienvenu, J. (Jacques), 1950. III. Laurent, P (Philippe), 1949. IV Symposium sur les marqueurs de l'inflammation (2nd : 1983 : Lyon, France) V. Groupe d'étude et de recherche sur les marqueurs de l'inflammation (France) [DNLM: 1. Blood Proteins—diagnostic use—congresses. 2. Blood Proteinsimmunology—congresses. 3. Inflammation—congresses. QZ 150 M3451983] RB131.M353 1984 616'.0473 84-9462 ISBN 3-11-009872-5
Copyright © 1984 by Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin 30. All rights reserved, including those of translation into foreign languages. No part of this book may be reproduced in any form - by photoprint, microfilm or any other means nor transmitted nor translated into a machine language without written permission from the publisher. Printing: Gerike GmbH, Berlin. - Binding: Dieter Mikolai, Berlin. Printed in Germany.
PREFACE
In the l a s t w e e k
in J u n e
1983, m o r e t h a n 2 5 0 r e s e a r c h s c i e n t i s t s
c l i n i c i a n s m e t at the F a c u l t é A l e x i s C a r r e l , (University, Claude Bernard, participants
Lyon-I)
a School
to p a r t i c i p a t e
sur les M a r q u e u r s de l ' I n f l a m m a t i o n "
s p o n s o r s h i p o f the " G r o u p e d ' E t u d e e t de R e c h e r c h e l'Inflammation" c h o s e n by the provide
a comprehensive
under
S c i e n t i f i c C o m m i t t e e of G E R M I
in I n f l a m m a t i o n a n d t h e i r c l i n i c a l
in h o s t d e f e n s e s ,
main theme running
had
a s u b j e c t of p e r e n n i a l
to the p r o t e a s e
the
proteins
in
the i m p o r t a n c e o f A c u t e P h a s e P r o t e i n s m e a s u r e m e n t
in
zinc, protein deprivation,
and malnutrition
the l a s t s e c t i o n of the book
biological
the r o l e
in h o s t d e f e n s e s . T h e models of
r e p o r t s on c o n f e r e n c e s
t h e i r use as a tool
their
lectins:
biological
to P r o f e s s o r F r a n k W.
of the d e p a r t m e n t of M o l e c u l a r B i o l o g y a n d B i o c h e m i s t r y , (Bloomington,
et
specificity.
W e w i s h to e x p r e s s o u r d e e p e s t g r a t i t u d e
University
fifth
held Caron
aspects of
for the s t u d y o f g l y c o c o n j u g a t e s ,
of
inflammation.
l e c t i n s w o r k s h o p a r r a n g e d by Drs. M i c h e l
and their a f f i n i t y a n d
are
central
A l a i n F a u r e , w h i c h w a s d e v o t e d to t h r e e c o m p l e m e n t a r y
functions,
the
lung
a n d d i s e a s e s o f the
s e c t i o n o f the book d e a l s w i t h
s e c t i o n f e a t u r e s a g r o u p of p a p e r s on animal
a satellite
field
mechanism
interplay
system. The fourth
to
implications.
interest which was
anti-protease
de
been
in o r d e r
a n d the r o l e s s u c h
f l u i d s f o r the d i a g n o s i s o f j o i n t d i s e a s e s ,
during
the
t h r o u g h o u t the m e e t i n g . T h e n e x t t h r e e s e c t i o n s
devoted respectively
Finally,
the
v i e w o f the d i f f e r e n t a s p e c t s o f the w i d e
of Acute Phase R e a c t a n t Proteins synthesis
nervous
in
sur les M a r q u e u r s
The p r o c e e d i n g s begins with a series of papers concerning
diseases,
The
(GERMI). The topics for this second symposium
International
of M a r k e r P r o t e i n s
play
Medicine
l o c a t e d in L y o n , F r a n c e .
had come from fifteen countries
"Second Symposium
of
and
Putnam
Indiana
I n d i a n a , USA) w h o w a s the o u t s t a n d i n g
president
VI
of this Symposium. We also want to extend our thanks to Professor Henry Gewürz, department of Immunology/Microbiology, Rush Medical College (Chicago, USA), Professor Robert Engler, department of Biochemistry, UER des Saints Peres (Paris, France) and Professor Roger Creyssel, department of Biochemistry UER Grange Blanche (Lyon, France), who acted as Symposium Co-Presidents and whose knowledge and understanding in the field made the program and its conferences
possible.
We wish to thank the members of the Organizing Committee for their support and help. This includes Helene Bernon, Jacques
Bienvenu,
Philippe Laurent, Abel Roullet, and J.L. Touraine. The following institutions provided financial
and practical
support: GERMI,
Institut
Pasteur de Lyon et du Sud Est, Fondation Merieux, Société Française d'Immunologie, Association des Anciens Internes et Internes en Pharmacie de Lyon, Commission Médicale Consultative de Hospices Civils de Lyon, BioMerieux, Travenol France, Du Pont de Nemours, HoechstBehring, Boehringer Mannheim, Technicon, Roger Bellon. We would also like to express our sincere gratitude to Professor Maurice Carraz, Director of the Pasteur Institute of Lyon
for his important help, and
Dr. Charles Merieux, who hosted the International
Scientific Advisory
Committee of GERMI and organized the social events. We would like to express our thanks to all other individuals, companies and who contributed to the success of the
institutions
symposium.
The fact that expert researchers agreed to write papers on this rather new and important subject has made our job a considerable pleasure. We also extend our gratitude to the staff of Walter de Gruyter, Berlin, whose labors have led to the rapid publication of this second volume on Marker Proteins in Inflammation.
February
1984
P. Arnaud J. Bienvenu P. Laurent
CONTENTS
SECTION I
THE INFLAMMATORY RESPONSE AND ACUTE PHASE REACTANT PROTEINS
Induction and Control of Acute Phase Reactant Synthesis I. Kushner
3
Use of Immunomorphological Methods and Hemolytic Plaque Tests to Investigate the Synthesis and Secretion of Plasma Proteins by the Liver Cells During the Acute Inflammatory Reaction G. Feldmann
15
Progress in Plasma Proteins: Recent Findings on the Structure of Ceruloplasmin F.W. Putnam
25
Recent Findings on the Isoelectric Points of Human C-Reactive Protein P. Laurent, D.L. Emerson, R.C. Allen, P. Arnaud
43
SAA is a more Sensitive Marker for Chronic Inflammatory Disease than C-Reactive Protein or ct-^-Acid Glycoprotein R.E. Chambers, J.T. Whicher
47
Elastase-a^ Proteinase Inhibitor Complex (E-ct^PI) and C-Reactive Protein (CRP): Early Indicators of Inflammatory Processes M. Jochum, K.H. Duswald, H. Dittmer, S. Neumann
51
Human Kallikrein-Kininogen-Kinins (KKK) System and AcutePhase Reactant Proteins (APRP) in Humans Undergoing Extracorporeal Circulation (ECC) M.E. Faymonville, A. Adam, P. Malengreaux, J. Damas, P. Ers, M. Hulot, M. Lamy, J. Lecomte
57
Vili Effect of Non Sterodial Anti-Inflammatory Drug Acide) on Acute Phase Protein Response.
(Niflumique
P. Laurent, A. Delvil, J. Bienvenu, C. Lahet, B. Colin, J.P. Rebattu, L.F. Perrin
71
Transcortin Activities, Cortisol and Progesterone in Pathological Sera: Inflammation, Septic Shock, Renal and Cardiac Diseases H. Zouaghi, L. Savu, E.A. Nunez, A. Carli, D. Kleinknecht, C. Guerot
75
Measurement of Human High Molecular Weight Kininogen (HMW-K) by Laser Nephelometry A. Adam, G. Calay, P. Ers, H. De Hertogh
SECTION
II
BIOLOGICAL REACTANT
ROLES
OF
ACUTE
79
PHASE
PROTEINS
Functions of Acute Phase Proteins in the Inflammatory Response J.T. Whicher
89
Interaction of the Acute Phase Reactants a^-Acid Glycoprotein, C-Reactive Protein and Serum Amyloid P-Component with Platelets and the Coagulation System B.A. Fiedel
99
Monoclonal Antibodies as Probes of Complement Function S. Ruddy
125
Modulation of Formation of the C3 Amplification Convertase of Human Complement by Acute Phase Proteins E. Fischer, M. Pontet, F. Delers, N. Tran Quang, M. Kazatchkine, R. Enler
135
Materno-Trophoblastic Relationship in Normal Human Pregnancy and Recurrent Spontaneous Abortion W.P. Faulk, C.-J. Yeh, B.-L. Hsi
139
IX
Chemotactic Factors in the Airspaces that may Modulate Inflammation H. Reynolds, C. Roth-Fouret
SECTION
III
PROTEASE
ANTI-PROTEASE
AND L U N G
DISEASES
153
INTERACTIONS
Human a-^-Antichymotrypsin: Purification, Properties and Reactions with some Serine Proteases A. Laine, A. Hayem, M. Davril
171
Alpha,-Antitrypsin-Protease Interactions: The Biological Aspect P. Arnaud, E. Gianazza
181
On the Interaction Between Human Liver Cathepsin L and the two Cysteine Proteinases Inhibitors Present in Human Serum M. Pagano, R. Engler, F. Esnard, F. Gauthier
203
Modulation of Human Lymphocyte Responses by «^-Antitrypsin and o^-Macroglobulin J.-P. Revi1lard, G. Cordier, J. Bata, M. Latour
207
Mediators of Inflammation in Inflammatory Alveolitis R.G. Crystal, J.F. Cordier
219
Idiophathic Pulmonary Fibrosis. Multiparametric Evaluation of Alveolar Lymphocyte and Macrophage Activation J.F. Mornex, G. Cordier, B. Lahneche, J. Pages, P. Chauvot, J.M. Vergnon, T. Wiesendanger, R. Loire, M. Vincent, J.F. Cordier, F. Mornex, J.-P.Revillard, J. Brune
223
The Alpha, Proteinase Inhibitor of the Lower Respiratory Tract. Effect of Cigarette Smoking A. Pelletier, C. Boudier, G. Pauli, J.G. Bieth
227
X Collagenolytic Enzymes and Fibrosis of the Lung J.F. Cordier, 0. Benzerara, Y. Lasne, J. Brune, R. Touraine
231
Elastolytic Activities and Proteinase Inhibitors in Sputum from Patients with Cystic Fibrosis J.M. Tournier, J. Jacquot, E. Puchelle, P. Sadoul, J.-P. Chazalette
235
Serum Derived Proteins and Antibacterial Proteins in Cystic Fibrosis Sputum J. Jacquot, J.M. Tournier, E. Puchelle, P. Sadoul, J.-P. Chazalette
239
Alveolar Fibronectin and Interstitial Lung Diseases N. Biot, D. Gindre, R. Harf, F. Maréchal, B. Vercoustre, M. Perrin-Fayol le
243
Sarcoidosis: IgG, B2 Microglobulin and Evolutivity. D. Duchassaing, P. Leclerc, M. Cambillau, 0. de Fenoyl, M. Paris
247
a^-Proteinase Inhibitor in Meconium from Healthy Infants and Infants with Cystic Fibrosis P. Lafont, Y. Barbier, M. Barbier, J. Mathian, R.C. Boisson, I. Garcia, R. Gilly
251
Qualitative Analysis of Proteins of Alveolar Fluid: A Study by Ultra-Thin Layer Immunoelectrophoresis and Electrofocusing C. Chapuis-Cellier, J.-F. Cordier, J.-M. Vergnon, A. Penet, J. Brune
255
Protease-Ant.iprotease Imbalance in Lung Diseases J.F. Mornex, R.G. Crystal
261
XI SECTION
IV
INFLAMMATION
AND A R T I C U L A R
DISEASES
The Acute Phase Response in Connective Tissue Disease I. Rowe
273
The GLA-Containing Protein öf Bone P.D. Delmas
281
Role of an Acute Phase Reactant, Retroviral gp70, in Murine SLE S. Izui, I. Hara
295
Study of 8 Marker Proteins of Inflammation in Synovial Fluid and Serum of Patients with Joint Diseases P. Bourg, B. Cartier, M. Mathieu, C. Collombel
305
Fibronectin in Arthropathies J. Lecocq, N.Y. Lecocq, L. Asch, M. Roth, M.L. North
SECTION
V
INFLAMMATORY
DISEASES
OF
NERVOUS
311
SYSTEM
Multiple Sclerosis: Clues for a Pathogenesis C. Confavreux, P. Arnaud
319
Immunoglobulins in Neuropathology A. Lowenthal
339
Cellular Inflammatory Response in Cerebrospinal Fluids C. Caudie, 0. Freney, F. Touraine
345
Evaluation of CSF Lymphocyte Subsets Using the OKT Series of Monoclonal Antibodies (OKT 3+ , 0 K T 4 + , 0KTg + ) in Various Neurological Diseases G. Servoz, F. Touraine, C. Quincy
355
XII Cytological Study and Protein Profile in Cerebrospinal Fluid, Before and During Treatment of Neurosyphilis 0. Freney, C. Caudie, S. Gas, C. Quincy
359
Cerebrospinal Fluid Cytology and Protein Parameters in 219 Multiple Sclerosis S. Gas, C. Caudie, C. Quincy
365
Interpretation of the Protein Profile of Cerebrospinal Fluid in Children L. Gerbaut, G. Ponsot
369
Cerebrospinal Fluid Ferritin: Interest as Biological Marker of Central Nervous System Tumors P. Antoine, R. Later, J.C. Eynard, F. Durand, B. Marechal, C. Quincy
375
Clinical Relevance of Beta 2 Microglobulin Levels of the Cerebrospinal Fluid in Children with Acut.e Encephalitis E.J. Raynaud, F. Demeocq, P. Vanlieferinghen, G. Malpuech, G. Gaillard
379
Electrophoretical Patterns of Acetylcholinesterase in Cerebrospinal Fluid J.C. Frot, F. Muller, P. Giraudet
383
Cholinesterase Isoenzymes of Cerebrospinal Fluid and Guillain-Barre Syndrome A. Simplot, S. Guibaud, A. Mercatello, D. Robert, 0. Robert
387
Lymphocytotoxic and Monocytotoxic Antibodies in Multiple Sclerosis L. Rumbach, M.M. Tongio, J.M. Warter, C. Marescaux, M. Col lard, S. Mayer
391
Interest of a High Resolution Agarose Gel Electrophoresis System (Panagel with a Silver Staining Revelation in the Study of Cerebrospinal Fluid (CSF) Immunoglobulin G E. Plan, J.B. Seneterre, C. Quincy
395
XIII Two Dimensional Electrophoresis of CSF Proteins: Electrophoresis Quality Control S. Gehamy, S. Reynier, C. Caudie, C. Quincy
SECTION VI
INFLAMMATION AND
401
MALNUTRITION
Anthropometric and Biological Characterization of Malnutrition States in Man C. André, S. Daniére
409
New Findings on the Role of Zinc as a Biological Response Modifier S. Cunningham-Rundles
421
Immunodeficiency in Protein or Vitamin A Deprived Mice P. Binder, B. Gassies, R. Fontanges
429
Immunological Consequences of Protein Deprivation in Primates S. Qazza
439
Serum Thymic Factor (FTS) Contents of the Thymus in Undernourished Senegalese Children B. Jambon, 0. Ziegler, B. Maire, G. Parent, M.C. Bene, G. Faure, A. Patris, J. Duheille
453
The Clinico-Pathological Consequences of Severe ProteinEnergy Malnutrition in Deceased Senegalese Children O. Ziegler, B. Jambon, G. Parent, M. Maire, R. Dardelin, M. Fall, J. Duheille
457
Protein Profile and Thymic Function in Protein-Energy Malnutrition without Surimposed Infections: Anorexia Nervosa F. Bleiberg, S. Wade, D. Lemonnier, M. Dardenne, H. Flavigny, A. Mosse, J. Lubetzki, P. Chapuis, D. Roche
461
XIV
Malnutrition in Cancer and Cachectic Patients F. Bozzetti
465
Marker Proteins of Inflammation and Nutrition in Advanced Cancer L. Deneux, M. Magalhaes, H. Magdelenat, P. Pouillart
477
Nutritional and Inflammatory Status in 26 Cases of Malignant Hemopathies of the Infancy F. Bienvenu, A. Rochette, G. Souillet
481
Comparison between CRP Serum Values and Hematological Parameters for Diagnosis and Therapeutic Surveillance of Neonatal Infections C. Benattar, D. Vauzelle, A. Lindenbaum, J.F. Magny
485
Contribution of Principal Components Analysis to the Study of Inflammatory and Nutritional Status on Intensive Care Patients J.P. Clavel, D. Gerbet, M.C. Diemert, J. Galli, A. Galli, P. Glaser
489
Effects of Nutrition on the Post-Operative Serum Levels of Prealbumin (PA), Transferrin (T) and Fibronectin (FN) J.F. Zazzo, B. Millat, D. Vauzelle, A. Abella
493
Surgery Induced Modifications of Plasma Protein Levels A. Lepape, J.P. Perdrix, B. Rondelet, V. Banssillon, J. Bienvenu, H. Bernon, A. Roullet, P. Laurent
497
Study of 8 Plasma Proteins during a Case of Severe Heat Stroke J.P. Perdrix, A. Lepape, J.M. Grozel, V. Banssillon, J. Bienvenu, M. Manchon, H. Bernon, A. Roullet
503
Serum Protein Profile Evolution after Sub-Total Hepatectomy M. David, A. Lobera, D. Marée, E. Legrand
507
XV
Malnutrition and Immunity in Chronic Heavy Drinkers with and without Cirrhosis D. Vuitton, P. Rollin, P. Jeambrun, H. Allemand, M.T. Henriet, P. Herve, J.P. Miguet
513
Biological Nutritional Markers which Poorly Reflect the Activity of Crohn's Disease L. Descos, C. André, F. André, P. Landais, J. Fermanian .. 519 Prediction of Success or Failure of Parenteral Alimentation in the Treatment of Severe Forms of Crohn's Disease and Rectocolitis C. André, L. Descos, N. Stremsdorfer 523 Albumin Assay with Astra 8 by a Technique Using Bromocresol Green: Quality Criteria, Comparison with Nephelometry J. Oglobine, B. Bouchet, Z. Pourshaidi, A. Desplaces 527 Quantitative Estimate of the Nutrional Status Through the Measurement of the Electrical Body Impedence A.L. Thomasset, C. Roullet, J. Lenoir
SECTION
VII
MARKER OF
PROTEINS
IN
EXPERIMENTAL
531
MODELS
INFLAMMATION
Characterization of Circulating Alpha-l-Acid-Glycoprotein in Normal and Inflammatory Mice P.M.H. Heegaard, J. Bienvenu, I. Sabbagh, A. Delvil, P. Laurent, T.C. BszSg-Hansen
539
The Inflammatory Reaction of the Developing Rat: Responses of Serum Steroid Hormones and Proteins H. Zouaghi, L.Savu, R. Vranckx, M.E. Martin, E.A. Nunez .. 549 The Effects of Ethinyl-Oestradiol and of Acute Inflammation on the Plasma Level of Rat Alpha 1-Acid Glycoprotein and on the Cell-Free Translation of its Hepatic mRNA M. Diarry-Mehrpour, J. Bourguignon, I. Leroux-Nicollet, D. Vercaigne, D. Biou, M. Hiron, J.P. Lebreton
553
XVI
Evidence for the Identy Between Alpha 1-CysteineProteinase-Inhibitor and Alpha 1-Acute-Phase Globulin in Rat Serum F. Esnard, L. Wibissono, C. Lombart, F. Gauthier
557
Changes in Concentration of Five Rat Serum ProteinaseInhibitors During Experimental Diabetes. Possible Relevance to Non Enzymatic Glycosylation F. Esnard, A. Lepape, W.T. Stauber, J.D. Guitton, F. Gauthier
561
Acute Phase Reactants, Thromboxane and Prostacyclin During Calcium Pyrophosphate-Induced Pleurisy in the Rat M. Tissot, M. Solier, J.P. Giroud, M. D'Asniere, R. Engler
565
Study of the Glycosylated Variants of Chicken Haptoglobin F. Delers, M. Domingo, Y. Rondeau, R. Engler Evidence for the Presence in Chicken Plasma of a Ligand for Haptoglobin which Differs from Hemoglobin F. Delers, M. Domingo, Y. Rondeau, R. Engler
569
575
Effect of an Acute Inflammatory Reaction on the Haptoglobin, Albumin, Cytochrome P-450 Contents and Glucose6-Phosphatase Activity in Hepatic Microsomal Fractions in the Rat J.L. Mahu, G. Feldmann, R. Engler
581
Circadian Variation in PMN-Migration Induced by Live BCG in Swiss Mice J.P. Bureau, L. Garrelly, M. Coupé, G. Labrecque
SECTION VIII
585
LECTINS
Introductive Notes M. Caron, A. Faure
591
XVII
Part Is Lectins as Tools The Use of Lectins to Study Changes in Rat Membrane Glycoproteins Induced by Oral Contraceptives B. Toor, L. McGregor, J. McGregor, S. Renaud, K.J. Clemetson
597
Identification of Cytoplasmic and Membrane Platelet Glycoproteins Using a Combination of SDS-Polyacrylamide Gel Electrophoresis and 125-j.-Labelled Lectins P. Clezardin, J.L. McGregor, E. James, M. Dechavanne, K.J. Clemetson
601
Characterization of Human Epidermal Glycoproteins Recognized by the Lectins Con A and PNA P.W. Ledger, A. Réano, J.Y. Bonnefoy, J. Thivollet
605
Fluorescent Lectins and Quantitative Microscopy M.A. Deugnier, X. Albe, J.C. Bisconte
609
Effects of Serum on Lectin-Induced Lymphocyte Proliferation P.J. Neveu, D. Perdoux 613 Concanavalin A and Prothrombin Complex M. Coulet, M.J. Bezou, P. Travade
615
Modification of Thymidine Transport in LectinStimulated Lymphocytes P. Beaudry, A. Sharif, Y. Goussault
619
Induction of a Thymidine Metabolisme Enzyme in Human Lymphocytes Stimulated by the Robinia pseudoacacia Lectin A. Sharif, P. Beaudry, Y. Goussault
621
Lectins of Robinia pseudoacacia J. Wantyghem, C. Goulut, J.P. Frénoy, Y. Goussault
625
XVIII
Specificity of Human Plasma Fibronectin Towards Biomaterials M. Caron, A. Faure, D. Gulino, C. Boisson, J. Jozefonvicz
627
Study of the Glycosylated Populations of Plasma Alpha 1-Acid Glycoprotein in Human Breast Cancer Patients Treated with Tamoxifen I. Leroux-Nicollet, J.P. Lebreton, M. Hiron, F. Sauger, C. Veyret, P. Bastit
631
Physico-Chemical and Biochemical Characteristics of the Con-A Reactive and Non Reactive Molecular Variants of Human Alpha 1-Acid Glycoprotein I. Leroux-Nicollet, M. Hiron, M. Fontaine, J.P. Lebreton, J.P. Kerckaert, B. Bayard
635
Part 2: Biological Functions of Lectins Biological Functions of Lectins M. Caron, M.A. Deugnier, R. Joubert, P.P. Rouge
641
Localization and Biosynthesis of Lathyrus ochrus Seeds Lectin C. Boisseau, H. Causse, A. Moisand, D. Pere, B. Sousa-Cavada, P. Rouge
651
Surface and Total Receptors for Asialoglycoproteins in Hepatocytes from Diabetic Rats G. Durand, M. Dodeur, J.P.Dumont, S. Coumoul, J. Agneray, J. Feger
655
Part 3: Affinity and Specificity of Lectins Lectin(s) - Ligand(s) Interactions J.P. Frenoy
661
XIX
A Comparative Study of Affinity Constants Measured by Different Methods, Between Peanut Lectin and Sugars with Galactosyl Modified on C(6) or C(l) J. Ohanessian, M. Caron
665
Effect of pH on Binding Properties of Peanut Agglutinin (PNA) M. Decastel, J.P. Frenoy
671
Use of Lectins to Examine the Microheterogeneity of Rat Hemopexin N. Bernard, R. Vranckx
673
AUTHOR INDEX
679
SUBJECT INDEX
683
INDUCTION AND CONTROL OF ACUTE PHASE REACTANT SYNTHESIS
Irving Kushner Department of Medicine, Case Western Reserve University Metropolitan General Hospital, Cleveland, Ohio
I
44109, U.S.A.
The Acute Phase Response
There are both local and systemic responses to infection or tissue injury. The local response to stimulation, inflammation, i s characterized by the consequences of vascular dilatation, increased capillary permeability and leukocyte migration, and i s the subject of intense investigation. Ordinarily, this process leads to repair at the involved s i t e . addition, however, there i s a systemic response (1).
In
Some of the elements
of this response are fever, leukocytosis and a vast variety of hormonal and metabolic changes. The l i v e r plays a major role in this systemic response.
In addition to
many morphologic and enzymatic changes, there i s an increase in synthesis of a number of plasma proteins, the acute phase proteins (or acute phase reactants).
I have a r b i t r a r i l y defined acute phase proteins as those
plasma proteins whose concentrations increase by 25% or more f a i r l y regularly at some point during the f i r s t 5-7 days after stimulus (1). Such changes may not f u l l y reflect changes in synthesis, since increased catabolism may also occur during the acute phase.
I t may be that in the
future a definition based on rate of synthesis would be preferable. TABLE I i s a partial l i s t of the human acute phase proteins, divided into three groups based on the usual magnitude of the plasma changes observed. The most s t r i k i n g changes are seen with C-reactive protein (CRP), the f i r s t acute phase protein recognized, and serum amyloid A protein (SAA), recently discovered.
Neither i s glycosylated.
SAA i s the only acute
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
4
TABLE I
BEST STUDIED HUMAN ACUTE PHASE PROTEINS
Group I - about 50% increase
Group I I - about 2-4 X increase
Ceruloplasmin C3, C4
cq acid glycoprotein a-] anti-trypsin a] anti-chymotrypsin Haptoglobin Fibrinogen
Group I I I - up to 1000 X increase C-reactive protein (CRP) Serum amyloid A (SAA)
phase protein thus far identified which manifests a plasma response comparable to that seen with CRP.
I t i s undoubtedly the precursor of the
major f i b r i l of secondary amyloid tissue.
Much of this presentation will
deal with CRP, which has been our major research focus over the years. Human CRP, with a molecular weight of 105,000, i s a pentraxin; i t i s composed of identical subunits of 21 ,000 daltons, arranged in c y c l i c symmetry.
The related molecule, SAP, another pentraxin, i s a plasma
protein o r i g i n a l l y discovered because of i t s occurrence in all types of amyloid tissue.
This protein shows over 60% amino acid homology with
CRP. I t i s an acute phase protein in some species, such as the mouse, but not in others, such as man. TABLE I I summarizes some of the s i m i l a r i t i e s and differences between three of the plasma proteins which have j u s t been referred to.
SAP i s
glycosylated and makes up about 15% of all types of amyloid t i s s u e , while SAA i s found only i n , and characterizes, the amyloidosis seen in individuals with chronic inflammatory states. One of the s t r i k i n g observations regarding the acute phase response i s the great v a r i a b i l i t y in acute phase behavior from one species to another. Some of these differences, in a few of the proteins, in a few species, are tabulated in TABLE I I I .
The major acute phase proteins in man are
5
TABLE II CRP
SAP
SAA
Acute phase protein in nan
+
-
+
Amino acid homology
+
+
Ca ++ -dependent binding
+
+
Amyloid-associated
+
+
CRP and SAA, in the mouse SAA alone (2), and in the rat a^ acid glycoprotein and "major acute phase a-| protein" described by Schreiber's group (3) and not indicated on this figure.
SAA apparently does not
In each of these species other plasma proteins
occur in the rat.
manifest acute phase behavior, but not of a magnitude comparable to the proteins tabulated.
TABLE III
ACUTE PHASE PROTEINS
SOME MAMMALIAN INTERSPECIES DIFFERENCES CRP
SAA
++++
MOUSE RAT
MAN
SAP
c*2 macro
cq acid GP
++++
0
0
++
+
++++
++
?
++
+
-
0
+++
++++
6 II
Biosynthesis
A.
Site
For many of the studies of C-reactive protein, the rabbit has been used as a model because the serum response appears to be identical to that seen in man.
The major, if not the only, site of CRP synthesis is the
liver, and specifically, the hepatocyte (4).
Following stimulus, the
first cells which can be shown to be synthesizing CRP are located in periportal areas and around the periphery of the hepatic lobules.
With
time, more and more cells can be found to be committed to CRP synthesis; at the peak of the response, virtually all hepatocytes are found to be synthesizing CRP.
Therefore the mechanism of increased synthesis appears
to be progressive recruitment of cells to CRP synthesis.
The sequence is
centripetal, proceeding inward within lobules, suggesting entry of mediator via nerves or blood.
This increased synthesis of plasma proteins is not global.
Some proteins
decrease their plasma concentrations and rates of synthesis during the acute phase. man (5).
Among these are albumin, prealbumin and transferrin in
The term "negative acute phase reactants" has been employed by
some to describe these changes. Two additional points about biosynthesis need to be made: a) on balance, there is a mild but significant increase in total plasma protein synthesis by the liver during the acute phase (6), despite decreased albumin synthesis,
b) The liver is not the only site of synthesis of
acute phase proteins.
For example, complement components and
aj-antitrypsin are also made in monocytes (7, 8); SAA is made to some extent in polymorphonuclear cells (9). synthesized in other sites.
It is not known whether CRP is
Overall, however, it is clear that the liver
is the major site of acute phase protein synthesis.
7 B.
Serum Kinetics
Following stimulus there is a tremendous difference in the rapidity of rise in serum concentrations between CRP and SAA, on the one hand, and the other acute phase proteins. a-j-antichynotrypsin.
The next most rapid rise is shown by
Rate of rise in concentration of other proteins
is even slower than a^-antichymotrypsin, as shown by Laurell's group over a decade ago (5).
These types of observations suggest the
possibility of different mechanisms controlling the synthesis of different acute phase proteins.
In a detailed study of change in serum CRP levels following acute myocardial infarction, an apparently exponential increase in CRP levels was found (10).
The average doubling time was about 8 hours; peak levels
occurred at about 3 days in patients with severe infarction. studies a sort of dose response relationship was observed.
In these In patients
with mild infarction lower CRP levels were achieved than in severe infarction, and they were achieved earlier.
The difference in the
magnitude of response was largely due to the difference in duration of continuing rise in concentration, and, inferentially, to a difference in continuing high rates of hepatic CRP synthesis. C.
Studies of Biosynthesis:
Liver Perfusion and Hepatocyte Culture
We directly measured CRP synthesis by isolated perfused rabbit livers obtained at intervals after intramuscular typhoid vaccine injection (11) A constant linear rate of CRP accumulation was found in each study, which we showed by cycloheximide inhibition studies to be synthesis and not mere secretion.
Rates of synthesis clearly increased with time in vivo
after stimulus.
But synthesis rate did not increase during the course of
each individual perfusion.
Therefore, the increase in rate of CRP
synthesis which occurs in vivo must depend on extrahepatic factors. In comparable studies in which we measured CRP synthesis by primary hepatocyte cultures from rabbits manifesting differing degrees of CRP response, we found rate of CRP synthesis and secretion to correlate with the serum CRP levels at the time of isolation of the hepatocytes (6).
8 Similar results were found in the perfusion studies summarized above. These observations suggested that rates of synthesis observed in these in vitro studies reflected in vivo rates. [1.
Serum Turnover Studies
It was possible to calculate approximate in vivo CRP synthetic rates from serum turnover studies in rabbits. In unstimulated rabbits, the serun half-life of CRP generally lay between 4 and 6 hours, remarkably rapid compared to most plasma proteins.
Fractional catabolic rates derived
from such studies lay in the range of about 15% per hour and did not appear to vary significantly regardless of serum CRP levels (12).
It is
possible that studies of larger numbers of animals or animals with even higher CRP levels might reveal smaller fractional catabolic rates in strongly responding rabbits.
Nonetheless, using these values, we were able to calculate approximate rates of CRP synthesis in some of the rabbits we studied (TABLE IV). Substantial differences between unstimulated and moderately stimulated rabbits were observed (12).
In addition, assuming a fractional
cata-
bolic rate of 15% per hour, we calculated theoretical rates of CRP synthesis in rabbits with low normal serum levels and in rabbits with a marked CP.P response.
These studies showed that synthesis rates in the
latter group might be 4000 times as great as in the former, and would exceed 25% of normal albumin secretion rate in the rabbit.
Thus, in the
rabbit, and presumably in man, there is a major commitment to CRP synthesis in the presence of severe tissue injury or infection.
Major changes in acute phase protein synthesis have been demonstrated in vivo in another species, the rat, by Schreiber, et al (13). synthesis decreased to 1/3 of normal rates.
Albumin
There was a 20-fold
increase, or more, in the two major acute phase proteins in this species.
9 TABLE IV
CALCULATION OF RABBIT CRP SYNTHESIS RATE (yg/Kg/hr) From direct measurement Liver Hepatocyte perfusion culture
From turnover in vivo
Experimental animals: Unstimulated: CRP conc = 0.9 yg/ml 24 h p stimulus; CRP conc = 65-70 ug/ml
6.7 560
410
475
36 h p stimulus; CRP conc = 104 yg/ml
560
Theoretical: for serum CRP conc = 0.1 yg/ml
ca. 0.7
for serum CRP conc = 400 pg/ml
ca. 2,700
For comparison, normally rabbit albumin = ca. 10,600 ug/Kg/hr
III
Molecular Biology
Concentrations of mRMA for rat a-j acid glycoprotein were demonstrated to be increased in livers from stimulated animals compared to normal animals (14). for albumin.
At the same time there was a marked decrease in the mRNA Similar findings have been reported for mouse SAA (15) and
hemopexin (16). CRP (17).
Harvey Colten's group has now found the same for human
Therefore, in all instances studied, evidence of increased
amounts of mRNA during the acute phase has been found, presumably on the basis of increased transcription.
In the case of SAA, increased
transcription itself has been shown (18).
10
IV
Induction
A wide variety of diverse stimuli lead to the acute phase response in vivo (1). induction?
Are there common mechanisms by which all of these lead to APP One set of candidates in which there i s a great deal of
interest i s the products of activated macrophages.
The greatest interest
has focused on a molecule or family of molecules with a molecular weight of about 15,000 , whose a c t i v i t i e s have led to i t s being identified over the years as Endogenous Pyrogen, Leukocytic Pyrogen, Leukocytic Endogenous Mediator and now, Interleukin 1 (19). In in vivo studies, monokines have produced many acute phase phenomena, including increased levels of CRP and other acute phase proteins (20, 21). However, there are reasons to believe that the effect of monokines on the acute phase response i s not entirely straightforward.
For example, there
are questions regarding whether the effect on the l i v e r i s direct or mediated, at least to some extent, via the central nervous system.
In
studies by Turchik and Bornstein in the rabbit, (TABLE V), doses of Leukocytic Pyrogen which failed to produce a CRP response when administered intravenously produced a marked response when injected into the cerebral ventricles (22).
The effects of various doses and routes of
administration paralleled the effect on fever, known to be mediated'via the central nervous system.
TABLE V
ROLE OF CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM
IN CRP RESPONSE TO LEUKOCYTIC PYROGEN from Turchik & Bornstein (ref. 22) Route of administration
24 hr CRP r i s e
T: r i s e in °C
0.1
cerebral ventricle
25 yg/ml
1.9
1.0
cerebral ventricle
50 yg/ml
2.6
1.0
intravenous
1 yg/ml
0.7
10.0
intravenous
10 yg/ml
1.3
Dose of LP
11
In addition, studies of the molecular size of active monokines indicate that more than one molecular species may directly influence acute phase protein synthesis, and that factors other than monokines may be important in this process.
TABLE VI l i s t s reports of acute phase protein induction
in hepatocyte cultures.
Several of these deserve comment:
in molecular sizes of active monokines have been shown.
Differences
A requirement
for dexamethasone i s reported in one instance, rat fibrinogen (23). While SAP induction by Interleukin 1 preparations i s reported by one group (24), an increase of only about 10", hardly persuasive, i s reported by another (25).
There are differences regarding the effect of normal
serum on SAA synthesis.
TABLE VI
FACTORS INDUCING ACUTE PHASE
PROTEIN SYNTHESIS IN HEPATOCYTE CULTURES I MONOKINES MW
Species & Protein
Reference
15,000 10,000 - 50,000 not 10,- 50,000
murine SAA murine a] AGP, SAA, hemopexin murine haptoglobin
not determined
murine SAP (difference of opinion)
25,000 - 30,000 not determined not determined
rat fibrinogen (requires dex) rat a2 macro, ai AT, C3 rat haptoglobin
(23) (27) (28)
rat ai AGP, a 2 macro
(29)
murine SAA but not SAP
(25)
murine SAA (not induced by normal serum)
(30)
I I CORTICOSTEROIDS ALONE I I I NORMAL SFRUM (fetal c a l f , human, mouse) IV LATENT PHASE SERUM
(mouse)
(26) (2) (2) (24, 25)
12
In our own attempts to stimulate CRP synthesis in rabbit primary hepatocyte cultures, we have tested a number of monokine preparations obtained from different investigators and different species, including rabbit, man, and mouse. induction.
We have never been able to show reproducible CRP
Recently we have used an anti-rabbit SAA antiserum (31)
obtained from Drs. Skogen and Natvig of Norway to study whether SAA induction occurred in any of these experiments.
Ue've been able to
employ this only in the absence of serum and have found, in one experiment, a 50% increase in secretion of an antigen reacting with this antiserum.
We have not as yet been able to confirm the s p e c i f i c i t y of
this antiserum.
V Summary Acute phase reactants i s a generic term for the individual plasma proteins whose synthesis increases at variable rates, to variable extents during the f i r s t few days after tissue injury or infection.
During this
period, synthesis of certain other plasma proteins decreases, suggesting complex integration of the l i v e r ' s protein synthetic system. There i s great v a r i a b i l i t y between mammalian species in the spectrum of acute phase reactants. The acute phase response probably results largely from increased transcription of acute phase proteins.
In every instance thus far
studied, increased accumulation of specific mRNA has been shown. Induction of acute phase proteins i s probably an intricate and complex process.
I t can be caused by monokines of varying molecular sizes.
It
i s l i k e l y that other mechanisms, perhaps involving the central nervous system, may participate.
13 References
1.
Kushner, I.: Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sei. 389, 39-48
(1982).
2.
Baumann, H., Jahreis, G.P., Gaines, K.C.: J. Cell. Biol. 97: 866-876 (1983).
3.
Urban, J., Chan, D., Schreiber, G.: J. Biol. Chem. 254, (1979).
10565-10568
4.
Kushner, I., Feldmann, G.: J. Exp. Med. 801, 466-477
5.
Aronsen, K.F., Ekelund, G., Kindmark, C.O., Laurel 1, C.B.: Scand. J. Clin. Lab. Invest. 29, 127-136 (1972).
(1978).
6.
Macintyre, S.S., Schultz, D., Kushner, I.: Biochem. J. 2K), 707-715 (1983).
7.
Col ten, H.R., Ooi, Y.M., Edelson, P.J.: Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sei. 332, 482-490 (1979).
8.
Isaacson, P., Jones, D.B., Judd, M.A.: Lancet 2, 964-965
9.
Rosenthal, C.J., Sullivan, L.: J. Clin. Invest. 62, 1181-1186
10.
Kushner, I., Broder, M.L., Karp, D.: J. Clin. Invest. 61_, 235-242 (1978).
11.
Kushner, I., Ribich, W.N., Blair, J.B.: J. Lab. Clin. Med. 96, 1037-1045 (1980).
12.
Chelladurai, M., Macintyre, S.S., Kushner, I.: J. Clin. Invest. 71_, 604-610 (1983).
13.
Schreiber, G., Howlett, G., Nagashima, M., Millership, A., Martin, H. Urban, J., Kotler, L.: J. Biol. Chem. 257, 10271-10277 (1982).
14.
Ricca, G.A., Hamilton, R.W., McLean, J.W., Conn, A., Kalinyak, Taylor, J.M.: J. Biol. Chem. 256, 10362-10368 (1981).
15.
Morrow, J.F., Stearman, R.S., Peltzman, C.G., Potter, D.A.: Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. USA 78, 4718-4722 (1981).
16.
McLean, J.W., Taylor, J.M.: Fed. Proc. 42, 1039
17.
Whitehead, A.S., Bruns, G.A.P., Markham, A.F., Colten, H.R., Woods, D.E.: Science 221, 69-71 (1983).
18.
Stearman, R.S., Lowell, C.A., Pearson, W.R., Morrow, J.F.: N.Y. Acad. Sei. 389, 106-115 (1982).
19.
Dinarello, C.A.: Lymphokines 7, 24-74
(1979). (1978).
J.E.,
(1983).
(1982).
20.
Bornstein, D.L., Walsh, E.C.: J. Lab. Clin. Med. 91_, 236-245
21.
Merriman, C.R., Pulliam, L.A., Kampschmidt, R.F.: J. Lab. Clin. Med. 83, 310-322 (1974).
(1978).
22.
Turchik, J.B., Bornstein, D.L.: Infect. Immun. 30, 439-444
23.
Ritchie, D.G., Fuller, G.M.: Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sei. 408, 490-500 (1983).
(1980).
14
24.
Le, P . T . , M ü l l e r , M.T., Mortensen, R.F.: J . Immun. 129, 665-67? (1982).
25.
Tatsuta, E . , Sipe, J . D . , Shirahama, T., Skinner, M., Cohen, A . S . : J . B i o l . Chem. 258, 5414-5418 (1983).
26.
McAdam, K.P.W.J., L i , J . , Knowles, J . , Fuss, N.T., D i n a r e l l o , C.A., Rosenwasser, L . J . , S e i i n g e r , M.J., Kaplan, M.M., Goodman, R.: Ann. H. Y. Acad. Sei. 389, 126-136 (1982).
27.
Fouad, F.M., Scherer, R., Abd-El-Fattah, M., Ruhenstroth-Bauer, G.: Euro. J. Cell B i o l . 2T_, 175-179 (1980).
28.
Hooper, D.C., Steer, C . J . , D i n a r e l l o , C.A., Peacock, A.C.: Biochimica et Biophysica Acta 653, 118-129 (1981).
29.
Baumann, H., Firestone, G.L., Burgess, T . L . , Gross, K.W., Yamamoto, K.R., Heid, W.A.: J. B i o l . Chen. 258, 563-570 (1983).
30.
Benson, M.D.: Ann. N.Y. Acad. S e i . 389, 116-120 (1982).
31.
Anders, R . F . , Matvig, J . B . , S l e t t e n , K., Husby, G., Nordstoga, K.: J. Immun. 118, 229-234 (1977).
USE OF IMMUNOMORPHOLOGICAL METHODS AND HEMOLYTIC PLAQUE TESTS TO INVESTIGATE THE SYNTHESIS AND SECRETION OF PLASMA PROTEINS BY THE LIVER CELLS DURING THE ACUTE INFLAMMATORY REACTION
Gérard Feldmann Laboratoire de Biologie Cellulaire, Faculté de Médecine XavierBichat, 16 rue Henri-Huchard, 75018 Paris and Unité de Recherches de Physiopathologie Hépatique, INSERM U24, Hôpital Beaujon, Clichy, France.
Acute phase reactant proteins
(APRP) form a heterogeneous
group of at least nine plasma proteins : ai-acid glycoprotein (orosomucoid), ai-antitrypsin, ai-antichymotrypsin, a 2 -macroglobulin, C-reactive protein, ceruloplasmin, fibrinogen, haptoglobin and the recently discovered serum amyloid A-protein (1, 2). Except for ai-antichymotrypsin, for which no convincing arguments as to its origin have yet been forthcoming, the hepatic origin of the APRP listed above has been well demonstrated by the use of biochemical technique
(1, 3, 4),
which, however, only provide overall information on the hepatic formation of these proteins. All the biochemical results are based on the assumption that the liver is composed of only one cell type, acting homogeneously both under normal conditions and during the acute inflammatory reaction. In fact, however, the liver is a complicated organ, which, in addition to the different cells constituting the walls of the vessels and biliary ducts, is formed of four different cell cytes, and three kinds of sinusoidal cells and endothelial cells
-
types-hepatoKupffer, Ito
(5). Hepatocytes represent about 78 % of
the cellular volumetric mass, and the remaining 22 % is unequally divided among the extracellular space and the various sinusoidal cells
(6). The cytoplasm of each of these four cells
contains the organelles responsible for the synthesis and secretion of exported proteins i.e., the endoplasmic
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
reticulum
16
and Golgi apparatus (7). Consequently, each cell could produce the APRP. Moreover, in the liver, the four cells are arranged according to a definite order. The morphofunctional unit of the liver is the hepatic lobule, which is surrounded by several portal spaces at its periphery and centered by a unique centro-lobular vein. Between these structures are the hepatic plates, composed of hepatocytes surrounded by the sinusoids, with the sinusoidal cells located very close to the hepatocytes. Depending on the location of the cells in the lobule, cellular metabolism has been demonstrated to differ, at least for some hepatic functions (8). The cells located around portal spaces are the most active metabolically. The opposite situation is observed in the centro-lobular zone around the central vein and an intermediary situation exists in the medio-lobular zone. It should be remembered that the mediators acting in APRP production reach the liver through the portal vessels, and the first liver cells they encourted are those located around the portal spaces (9, 10). The cellular organization of the liver makes it necessary to use methods other than biochemical techniques to obtain information on the biology of the cells responsible for APRP production. Schematically, these methods can be divided into two groups, according to the investigation : 1) In cases when it is necessary to preserve the hepatic lobules, techniques must be used which are capable of identifying the APRP while maintening the structure of the cells intact and their position in the lobule unchanged : so far, immunomorphological techniques have proved the only ones to meet these requirements. Among, the various techniques available, a distinction must be drawn between those that can be used on electron microscopy and are therefore capable of providing information on APRP synthesis and secretion, and those that can be used on optical microscopy and capable simply to demonstrate that a cell contains APRP with no possibility to distinguish between active synthesis and passive accumulation. In the first category, the leading techniques are immunoenzymatic techniques with their principal
17
variant immunoperoxidase (IPO) while in the second categorythere is immunofluorescence (IF). 2) When the nature of the cells with preservation of their structure but not their location in the hepatic lobule is required, isolated liver cells can be investigated, at least in the animals. The behavior of some APRP has been investigated in isolated hepatocytes (11-13X However, in all these reports, APRP synthesis was measured using biochemical techniques which, as it was pointed out above, did not supply any information on functions at single cell level. Immunomorphological techniques can be used on single cell in the same way as they are employed for the whole liver. However, as illustrated below, they are more appropriated when the information required concerns intracellular synthesis and secretion. When extracellular secretion is investigated, techniques like the hemolytic plaque tests are very advantageous.
Contribution of immunomorphological techniques The principle of these techniques is the following : under certain conditions of cell fixation, intracellular proteins preserve their antigenic determinants instead of being destroyed or transformed. They can be recognized in the cells by the use of specific antibodies labelled with a fluorochrome on with the enzyme horseradish peroxidase. Immunomorphological techniques have been used to locate, ai-acid glycoprotein (10), ai-antitrypsin (14), 012-macroglobulin (10), C-reactive protein (9), ceruloplasmin (15), fibrinogen (10) and serum amyloid Aprotein (16) in the liver cells of man, rat, rabbit or mouse. The cells labelled were generally the hepatocytes. However, some discrepancies have been observed between the results obtained with IF and IPO. For instance, fibrinogen (17) and haptoglobin (18) were reported to be present in both hepatocytes and Kupffer cells when IF was used, whereas with IPO, they were only identified in hepatocytes (10). These differences
18
are probably due to the fact that the IPO is more specific and sensitive that IF. The use in IPO of affinity-purified antibodies instead of immunoglobulins as in IF affords greater specificity in cellular localization
(19), and in particular re-
duces the frequency of artifacts. The possibility provided by IPO of examining the cells by electron microscopy easily accounts for its sensitivity. Moreover, ultrastructural observations can definitively confirm that the cell structure is correctly preserved and that the protein correctly localized
(19,
20) . Another feature demonstrated by IF and/or IPO is that only between 1 and 10 % of normal hepatocytes produce a particular APRP at any given time (10, 14, 15). When the cellular kinetics of the APRP were followed during the acute inflammatory reaction, as we did in the rabbit for C-reactive protein (9) and in the rat for four different APRP (10), we observed that at the beginning of the reaction, APRP-producing hepatocytes were visible first around the portal spaces, then in the medio-lobular zone, and later as the inflammatory reaction extended in the centro-lobular zone. At the maximum of the reaction, almost all the hepatocytes were producing the APRP
(Fig. 1) (9, 10).
On electron microscopy, large amounts of APRP were visible in the endoplasmic reticulum and Golgi apparatus (Fig. 2). Optical (Fig. 1) and ultrastructural observation of the hepatocytes (10) suggested, however, that the activity of each cell was not of the same intensity. Fig. 1. Optical microscopy. Immunoperoxidase. Twenty-four hours after the beginning of the acute inflammatory reaction, almost all the hepatocytes produce haptoglobin, indicated on this figure by black deposits visible in the cytoplasm of the cells. Note that the intensity of the staining is variable from cell to cell (nuclei uncont e s t e d ) (x 400). Fig. 2. Electron microscopy. Immunoperoxidase. Same conditions as in Fig. 1. Large amounts of haptoglobin indicated by electron-dense deposits, are visible in the endoplasmic reticulum (ER) and Golgi apparatus (GA) of this hepatocyte. (N : Nucleus ; M : Mitochondria) (x 22,000).
20
The small percentages of APRP-producing hepatocytes, which was also observed for other non-APRP proteins, like albumin (21), transferrin (22) or prothrombin (23), is connected to the technical conditions employed to prepare the liver cells, as it was observed recently (20). When liver fragments were immersed in the fixative (immersion fixation) as it was done in most investigations (9, 10, 14, 15, 17,20), only a small percentage of hepatocytes was observed to produce APRP. The same results were obtained with this method, for instance for fibrinogen, when a cell membrane permeabilizing agent, like saponin, was added to the fixative (20). In contrast, striking differences were seen when the fixation was conveyed to the liver through the portal vein (perfusion fixation) and saponin added to the fixative : instead of a few labelled hepatocytes, almost all the cells were observed to synthetize and secrete fibrinogen (20). Under these
conditions, the recruitment observed in the
hepatic lobule during the acute inflammatory reaction (9, 10) had to be reinvestigated. Preliminary results showed that there was apparently no difference between controls and experimental animals 24 hours after an inflammatory reaction induced by turpentine administration (24). Quantitative electron microscopy studies are now in progress to ascertain whether there are any difference
between the hepatocytes producing APRP.
Finally, immunomorphological techniques have been used to demonstrate that a single hepatocyte is capable to produce several proteins at the same time. Our experiments with primary cultures of rat hepatocytes suggested that the same hepatocyte was able to synthetize fibrinogen and albumin (25). In vivo, when serial liver sections were each incubated in labelled antibodies against different APRP, we observed that during an experimental acute inflammatory reaction a single hepatocyte was capable of producing four different APRP at a given time (10). Consequently, in seems clear that the hepatocyte is not specialized, at least for this function (10). This does not mean, however, that the hepatocyte can produce all the APRP at the same time, or all the plasma proteins coming from the li-
21 ver. It is well known that the different APRP have different kinetics for instance those of C-reactive protein are not the same as those of haptoglobin
(9, 10). Further, it is reasona-
ble to suppose that the activity of the hepatocytes in protein synthesis is restricted to a certain level. For instance, the capacity of hepatocytes to synthetize albumin cannot exceed two of three times (26). The production capacity of the liver for APRP has not yet been investigated at least to our knowlegde. However, a level in their production might exist. This is suggested for instance, by the finding that when the dose of turpentine administered to the rat was double or tripled
(1 ml or
1.5 ml per 100 g body weight instead of the usual 0.5 ml (10)), the plasma concentration of fibrinogen did not differ from that observed with 0.5 ml (24). When hepatocytes are strongly stimulated, they apparently cannot synthetize all the proteins. This situation is not restricted to the proteins exported in the plasma, as we shown in the next paragraph, but also applies to the non-exported proteins like cytochrome Pi, 50 as we observed with J.L. Mahu and R. Engler (see the communication on this subject in this volume). APRP production by hepatocytes under experimental or pathological conditions has so far been little investigated by immunomorphological techniques. In addition to the works already reported ealier
(9, 10), the acute inflammatory reaction was fol-
lowed in the liver for haptoglobin with IF up to 125 hours. In such late times, Kupffer cell localization was possibly an artifact (see above) but interpreted as a morphological sign of cellular catabolism
(18). We investigated the behavior of some
APRP in the hepatocytes of rats with carbon-tetrachloride-induced cirrhosis
(27) and we observed that, despite changes in
the liver, hepatocytes were still able to produce APRP almost as much as those observed
in
animals with a normal liver.
These results suggest that under certain conditions, the hepatocytes remaining in cirrhosis could compensate for the destruction induced by this disease by increasing their protein synthesizing capacity.
22 Contribution of hemolytic plaque tests The hemolytic plaque tests used to explore plasma protein secretion by hepatocytes originated in immunology, a field in which they are very often proposed to investigate immunoglobulin production by plasma cells. The principle of the technique is the following : isolated liver cells are incubated with sheep red blood cells labelled with specific antibodies against a given plasma protein. In the presence of guinea-pig complement, the red blood cells are destroyed and hemolytic plaques appear around the secreting cells. The technique can be semiquantitative, measuring the diameter of the hemolytic plaques and of the secreting cells. Unlike to immunomorphological techniques, hemolytic plaque tests have only begun to be applied to liver cells. We used them to compare the amounts of albumin and fibrinogen secreted by hepatocytes in normal conditions and during an"acute inflammatory reaction induced in the rat by in vivo turpentine administration (28). Firstly, we observed that there was a direct relationship between the diameters of the secreting hepatocytes and the hemolytic plaques, suggesting that protein production is dependent on the quantities of active ribosomes and of nuclear DNA present. Secondly, we saw that while the percentages of albumin and fibrinogen-secreting hepatocytes were respectively about 7 0 % and 1 % in the normal state, the opposite situation was observed 24 hours after the beginning of the inflammatory reaction, when about 50 % of the hepatocytes were secreting fibrinogen, and only 1 %, albumin. This observation confirms other biochemical findings (29, 30) and provides a strong argument in favour of the possibility that even if a single hepatocyte is potentially able to synthetize all proteins, it cannot synthetize all proteins at any given time. In view of these results, the significance of the so-called acute-phase "negative" reactant proteins (31, 32) remains uncertain. It is possible that the behavior of these proteins can only be explained by some physiological cellular functions of
23 the hepatocytes.
Acknowledgments : The authors wishes to think Mrs Maurice and Malet for their help in the preparation of the manuscript.
References 1.
Koj, A.: In Structure and function of plasma proteins, Allison, A.C. edit., Plenum Press, London, Vol 1, pp 73131, 1974
2.
Kushner, I.: In C-reactive protein and the plasma protein response to tissue injury, Kushner, I., Volanakis, J.E., Gewürz, H. edits, Ann. N.Y., Acad. Sei., 389, 39-48, 1982
3.
Schultze, H.E., Heremans, J.F.: Molecular biology of human proteins with special reference to plasma proteins. Elsevier, Amsterdam, Vol 1, pp 354-355, 1966
4.
Putnam, F.W.: In The plasma proteins. Structure, function, and genetic control, Putnam F.W. edit., Academic Press, New York, Vol 1, Second edition, pp 57-131, 1975
5.
Feldmann, G.: In Physiologie humaine, Meyer, P. edit., Flammarion, Paris, pp 113-119, 1983
6.
Blouin, A., Bolender, R.P., Weibel, E.R.: J. Cell Biol. 72, 441-455 (1977).
7.
Palade, G.E.: Science JJ3J3, 347-358
(1975).
8.
Jungermann, K., Katz, N.: Hepatology 2, 385-395
9.
Kushner, I., Feldmann, G.: J. Exp. Med. 148, 466-477 (1978).
(1982).
10. Courtoy, P.J., Lombart, C., Feldmann, G., Moguilevsky, N., Rogier, E.: Lab. Invest. 44, 105-115 (1981). 11. Crane, L.J., Miller, D.L.: J. Cell Biol. 72, 11-25
(1975).
12. Canonico, P.G., Ayala, E., Rill, W.L., Little, J.S.: Am. J. Clin. Nutr. 30, 1359-1363 (1977). 13. Hooper, D.C., Steer, C.J., Dinarello, C.A., Peacok, A.C.: Biochim. Biophys. Acta 653, 118-129 (1981). 14. Feldmann, G., Guillouzo, A., Maurice, M., Guesnon, J.: In Immunoenzymatic techniques, Feldmann, G., Druet, P., Bignon, J., Avrameas, S. edits, Elsevier, Amsterdam, pp 379394, 1976 15. Feldmann, G.: In Electron microscopy and cytochemistry. Wisse, E., Daems, W.Th., Molenaar, I., Van Duijn, P. edits, Elsevier, Amsterdam, pp 145-149, 1973
24
16. Benson, M., Kleiner, E.: J. Immunol. 124, 495-499 (1980). 17. Hamashima, Y., Harter, J.C., Coons, A.H.: J. Cell Biol. 2_0, 271-279 (1964). 18. Peters, J.H., Alper, G.A.: J. Clin. Invest. 45, 314-320 (1966). 19. Feldmann, G.: J. Microscopie Tt, 293-300 (1974). 20. Pignal, F., Maurice, M., Feldmann, G.: J. Histochem. Cytochem. 3J), 1004-1014 (1982). 21. Feldmann, G., Penaud-Laurencin, J., Crassous, J., Benhamou, J.P.: Gastroenterology 63, 1036-1048 (1972). 22. Lane, R.S. : Nature 215, 161-162 (1967). 23. Barhnart, M.I.: J. Histochem. Cytochem. 13, 740-751 (1965). 24. Feldmann, G.: Unpublished data. 25. Guillouzo, A., Feldmann, G., Boisnard, M., Sapin, C., Benhamou, J.P.: Exp. Cell Res. 96, 239-246 (1975). 26. Katz, J., Bonorris, G., Okuyama, S., Sellers, A.L.: Am. J. Physiol. 212, 1255-1260 (1967). 27. Courtoy, P.J., Feldmann, G., Rogier, E., Moguilevsky, N.: Lab. Invest. 45, 67-76 (1981). 28. Bernuau, D., Rogier, E., Feldmann, G.: Hepatology _3» 29-33 (1983) . 29. Princen, J.M.G., Nieuwenhuizen, W., Mol-Backx, G.P.B.M., Yap, S.H.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 102, 717-723 (1981) . 30. Morow, J.F., Stearman, R., Peltzman, C.G., Potter, D.A.: Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. USA 78, 4718-4722 (1981). 31. Lebreton, J.P., Joisel, F., Raoult, J.P., Lannuzel, B., Roger, J.P., Humbert, G.: J. Clin. Invest. jv4, 1118-1129 (1979). 32. Savu, L., Lombart, C., Nunez, E.A.: Febs Lett. 113, 102106 (1980).
PROGRESS
IN PLASMA PROTEINS:
RECENT F I N D I N G S ON THE STRUCTURE
OF CERULOPLASMIN
Frank
W. Putnam, N o b u h i r o T a k a h a s h i ,
Department of B i o l o g y , Bloomington,
Indiana
Introduction: The
(1)
larly
to
reviewed
as
the
First
progress
reflected about
University
in Plasma
in
Proteins
Symposium
in
plasma
At t h a t
some 50
were
properties
available
that
allowed
quantitative
immunoglobulins
a c u t e phase r e a c t a n t s . family
control,
structure
genetic
biosynthesis
states.
for
Furthermore, or
the
of
the
factors
that
are a
greatly
we know l i t t l e
or cause the c h a r a c t e r i s t i c
in
and in
about
regulate
response
of
especial-
function,
differ
the
principal
the i m m u n o g l o b u l i n s
the acute phase p r o t e i n s
control
other
antisera
changes
T h i s was
r e l a t e d in s t r u c t u r e ,
and f u n c t i o n .
and
measurement
and a l s o
Yet, whereas
of p r o t e i n s c l o s e l y
genetic their
disease
much could
specific
and o f s i g n i f i c a n t
in v a r i o u s
the
reac-
They
mobilities
I n many c a s e s
ly
for
proteins.
(2-4).
the b l o o d l e v e l true
Mar-
particu-
of the acute phase
human p l a s m a
range of c o n c e n t r a t i o n
normal
(2-4),
t i m e t h e r e was a l r e a d y
be i d e n t i f i e d by t h e i r e l e c t r o p h o r e t i c physical
on I n f l a m m a t i o n
proteins
the p r o p e r t i e s
t a n t s o f human p l a s m a . information
Ortel
47405
Progress
introduction
kers
Indiana
and Thomas L .
their
inflamma-
tion. At
the
ture,
time of the F i r s t that
bonding
is,
Symposium we knew the p r i m a r y
the c o m p l e t e
pattern,
location
characteristics
of
immunoglobulins
IgG,
four IgA,
amino of of
acid
sequence,
oligosaccharides the
IgM,
five
and
IgE
classes (4).
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in Germany
struc-
disulfide and
other
of
human
Recently
the
26 primary
structure
of
IgD -
has been r e p o r t e d by our
the
laboratory
human i m m u n o g l o b u l i n c l a s s e s Also,
at
the
properties
of
First the
ing f i b r o n e c t i n ) primary
alpha
complete
Then,
1-antitrypsin
amino
published
in
laboratory
acid
1982
has
by
table
acute
phase
At t h a t
sequence
of
Carrell
e_t
completed
the
Antitrypsin Ceruloplasmin C-reactive protein
of
(exclud-
the
complete
the
proteins:
protein,
haptoglobin,
structure
was known
However,
the
1-antitrypsin
was
(6) acid
table
the
of
and
recently
sequence
of
properties
our
human can
be
1.
Pi
Carbohydrate content
Amount in normal plasma (mg/lOOml)
Sequence
40,000
2.7
41.4
55-140
complete
ajAT
54,000
4.8
12.4
200-400
compiete
Cp
135,000
4.4
8.0
15-60
compiete
0
-0>Ti>T3>-n Î i i i r i i i i ï i i î
CRP
%
Haptoglobin
^
Orosomucoid
•
alpha 2 macroglobulin
•
alpha 1 antitrypsin
65 to 177% (p ^
50 30 M I N U T E I0-
LÜ
cr Figure 5
106 E f f e c t s of A A G and H e p a r i n on P l a t e l e t A g g r e g a t i o n / C l o t F o r m a t i o n in PRP I n d u c e d by A c t i v a t e d T h r o m b o f a x R e a g e n t . We n e x t i n v e s t i g a t e d the a n t i - h e p a r i n e f f e c t of A A G f o l l o w i n g c h a l l e n g e of PRP w i t h A c t i v a t e d T h r o m b o f a x R e a g e n t . In this s y s t e m , p l a t e l e t s are a c t i v a t e d by the i n t r i n s i c g e n e r a t i o n of t h r o m b i n as o p p o s e d to its e x o g e n o u s a d d i t i o n as d e p i c t e d in F i g u r e s 1-3; clot f o r m a t i o n is s i m i l a r l y s t i m u l a t e d . As s h o w n in F i g u r e 4, h e p a r i n p r o l o n g e d the o n s e t of p l a t e l e t a g g r e g a t i o n and clot f o r m a t i o n (curve B). The a d d i t i o n of A A G (2 m g ; curve C) s h o r t e n e d the o n s e t of p l a t e l e t a g g r e g a tion but p r o l o n g e d the o n s e t of clot f o r m a t i o n ; A A G (plus h e p a r i n ) at 4 mg (curve D) had e v e n a m o r e d r a m a t i c and dichotomous effect. In the a b s e n c e of h e p a r i n , A A G (4 m g ; c u r v e E) s h o r t e n e d e a c h the o n s e t of p l a t e l e t a c t i v a t i o n and coagulation. A t no c o n c e n t r a t i o n of h e p a r i n or A A G c o u l d an a n t i - h e p a r i n e f f e c t be d e m o n s t r a t e d . M o r e o v e r , the p r o - a g g r e g a n t a c t i v i t y a s s o c i a t e d w i t h A A G w a s not e v i d e n t u n l e s s the clotting system was initiated. T h i s is d e p i c t e d in F i g u r e 5 w h i c h i l l u s t r a t e s that, i n d e p e n d e n t of h e p a r i n , an a m o u n t of A A G w h i c h acts as a p l a t e l e t p r o - a g g r e g a n t a n d / o r p r o - c o a g u lant f o l l o w i n g t h r o m b i n or T h r o m b o f a x c h a l l e n g e of P R P inhibits platelet aggregation following challenge with ADP. C-REACTIVE
PROTEIN.
The c l a s s i c a l acute p h a s e r e a c t a n t , C - r e a c t i v e p r o t e i n (CRP), d e s c r i b e d by T i l l e t t and F r a n c i s in 1930 (19), a p p e a r s in m a r k e d l y e l e v a t e d c o n c e n t r a t i o n in the sera of i n d i v i d u a l s u n d e r g o i n g r e a c t i o n s of acute i n f l a m m a t i o n and tissue d e g r a d a t i o n and is found d e p o s i t e d at sites of tissue injury ( r e v i e w e d in ref. 20). C R P has an Mr of 1 1 5 , 0 0 0 , c o n s i s t i n g of five i d e n t i c a l , n o n c o v a l e n t l y b o u n d s u b u n i t s , and s h a r e s m u l t i p l e functional similarities with immunoglobulins. T h e s e include the a b i l i t y to i n i t i a t e r e a c t i o n s of c o m p l e m e n t c o n s u m p t i o n and p h a g o c y t o s i s and the c a p a c i t y to bind w i t h m o n o n u c l e a r p e r i p h e r a l blood c e l l s _in v i t r o . T h e s e r e a c t i v i t i e s e a c h require C R P to bind w i t h one of its m u l t i v a l e n t l i g a n d s or to be h e a t m o d i f i e d or c h e m i c a l l y a g g r e g a t e d ( r e v i e w e d in 20). We r e c e n t l y r e p o r t e d (3) that t h e r m a l l y m o d i f i e d CRP (H-CRP) i n d u c e d r e a c tions of a g g r e g a t i o n and s e c r e t i o n from i s o l a t e d p l a t e l e t s in a m a n n e r s i m i l a r to t h e r m a l l y m o d i f i e d h u m a n igG (AHGG) but, on a w e i g h t b a s i s , w a s 10-20 fold more e f f e c t i v e than A H G G . We d e s c r i b e here the e v i d e n c e that H - C R P c a u s e s p l a t e l e t s to release a - g r a n u l e c o n s t i t u e n t s , to p r o d u c e and s e c r e t e a p o t e n t a o r t a - c o n t r a c t i n g s u b s t a n c e w h i c h we b e l i e v e to be p r e d o m i n a n t l y t h r o m b o x a n e A2r and to p o t e n t i a t e the o n s e t of b l o o d c o a g u l a t i o n . A c t i v a t i o n of P l a t e l e t s by H - C R P . Thermally modified CRP a c t i v a t e d i s o l a t e d h u m a n p l a t e l e t s to r e a c t i o n s of a g g r e g a t i o n and s e c r e t i o n (Figure 6). I n c r e a s i n g d o s e s of H - C R P r e s u l t e d in c o n c o m m i t a n t l y g r e a t e r a m o u n t s of a g g r e g a t i o n and the release of s e r o t o n i n from the p l a t e l e t s (a m e a s u r e of d e n s e g r a n u l e constituent release). Using a L u m i - A g g r e g o m e t e r , w h i c h p e r m i t t e d a k i n e t i c a s s e s s m e n t of d e n s e g r a n u l e s e c r e t i o n (as ATP) a n d p l a t e l e t a g g r e g a t i o n , we o b s e r v e d that p l a t e l e t a g g r e g a t i o n
107 H-CRFfyg/ml)
UJ O
80
(68)
80
(43)
40
(25)
20
(19)
10
(10)
5
70
CO a. x c? _J UJ >
60 50 40 3020
LU
cr
10I 1 MIN UTE
Figure
6.
R e p r e s e n t a t i v e e x p e r i m e n t i l l u s t r a t i n g the stimulat i o n of p l a t e l e t a g g r e g a t i o n and s e c r e t i o n of s e r o t o n i n by increasing a m o u n t s of H - C R P . The p e r c e n t s e r o t o n i n release is in p a r e n t h e s e s . F r o m r e f e r e n c e (3).
s t i m u l a t e d by H - C R P o c c u r r e d c o i n c i d e n t l y w i t h the s e c r e t o r y event. H - C R P also s t i m u l a t e d p l a t e l e t s to r e l e a s e 8 - t h r o m b o g l o b u l i n a n t i g e n , indicating a c a p a c i t y to m e d i a t e s e c r e t i o n of c o n s t i t u e n t s from p l a t e l e t a g r a n u l e s (Figure 7). However, the r e l e a s e of the l y s o s o m a l acid h y d r o l a s e s ( m e a s u r e d as 3 - g l u c u r o n i d a s e ) w a s not d e t e c t e d in the s u p e r n a t a n t s of platelet suspensions challenged with H-CRP. G e n e r a t i o n of T X B ? and TXA? A c t i v i t y from P l a t e l e t s S t i m u l a t e d by H - C R P . H - C R P induced p l a t e l e t a c t i v a t i o n is m e d i a t e d , in p a r t , by an i n d o m e t h a c i n s e n s i t i v e p a t h w a y . The next e x p e r i m e n t s s o u g h t to identify the c o n v e r s i o n of p l a t e l e t p h o s p h o l i p i d l ^ C - a r a c h i d o n i c acid into 1 4 C - T X B 2 (the stable h y d r a t e d end p r o d u c t of TXA2) d u r i n g p l a t e l e t a c t i v a t i o n w i t h H - C R P .
108
70-
b
a
LJ
1 8,000n
O
£ THROMBIN
7,000-
6,0005,000-
T
10 r 0
2
3
MINUTES
Figure 7.
4
5
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
90
H-CRP ( ^ g / m l )
In (a), the aggregation response of isolated platelets to increasing amounts of H-CRP. In (b), the release of 3-thromboglobulin antigen from platelets challenged in (a) using five different H-CRP concentrations marked A-E and corresponding to the H-CRP concentrations used in (a). B-thromboglobulin antigen was measured using radio-immunoassay with platelet activating conditions as described in Materials and Methods. For comparison, the p-thromboglobulin antigen released following challenge of platelet suspensions with a concentration of thrombin yielding a maximal platelet aggregation event is depicted in (b). Data is given as the mean and range of three independent determinations for each H-CRP or thrombin concentration used From reference (21).
Low concentrations of H-CRP (10-20 ug/ml) did not generate detectable 1 4 C-TXB2; however, challenge of platelets with 50-100 ug/ml H-CRP, which produced maximal amounts of aggregation, generated 14q_txB2 (Figure 8). The % conversion of platelet membrane AA into TXB2 in thrombin and H-CRP activated platelets was 8.2% + 4.5% and 2.8% + 0.9% respectively (nine experiments). The inclusion of indomethacin in these systems inhibited TXB2 generation, and imidazole, an inhibitor of thromboxane synthetase, shunted PGG2/PGH2 into production of the prostaglandins (as measured by PGE2). H-CRP, unlike ADP but like thrombin, did not require platelet aggregation to generate TXA2 since the apparent % conversion of platelet AA was similar in the presence or absence of added calcium.
109
A s a d d i t i o n a l e v i d e n c e that H - C R P s t i m u l a t e d p l a t e l e t s p r o d u c e b i o l o g i c a l l y active m e t a b o l i t e s from a r a c h i d o n a t e , we a s s e s s e d w h e t h e r p l a t e l e t TXA2 a c t i v i t y w a s g e n e r a t e d . As cont r o l s , TXA2 a c t i v i t y g e n e r a t e d by a r a c h i d o n a t e , c o l l a g e n and thrombin! w a s also a s s e s s e d . A s d e p i c t e d in Figure 9, H - C R P s t i m u l a t e d p r o d u c t i o n of TXA2 a c t i v i t y from p l a t e l e t s , as did a r a c h i d o n a t e , c o l l a g e n and t h r o m b i n ; TXA2 p r o d u c t i o n w a s a b s e n t in c h a l l e n g e d p l a t e l e t s u s p e n s i o n s in the p r e s e n c e of indomethacin.
THROMBIN THROMBIN + INDO
H-CRP
H-CRP + INDO H-CRP + IMID
TxBz
Figure
8.
PGE 2
R a d i o - t h i n l a y e r c h r o m a t o g r a p h y of lipid p r o d u c t s g e n e r a t e d from i s o l a t e d p l a t e l e t s i n c o r p o r a t e d w i t h I ^ C - a r a c h i d o n i c acid. P l a t e l e t s s u s p e n d e d in TBS (pH 7.4) w i t h 0.2 m M c a l c i u m w e r e c h a l l e n g e d w i t h t h r o m b i n (10 U/ml) or H - C R P (100 u g / m l ) . Indom e t h a c i n w a s used at 20 uM and i m i d a z o l e at lOmM. M i g r a t i o n of n o n - r a d i o a c t i v e p r o s t a g l a n d i n PGE2 a n d of t h r o m b o x a n e B2 (TXB2) are s h o w n below the r a d i o thinlayer chromatograms. Reaction mixtures were m i x e d w i t h an internal ^H-TXBJ s t a n d a r d , a c i d i f i e d (pH 3.5) and e x t r a c t e d w i t h ethyl a c e t a t e . The o r g a n i c m i x t u r e w a s e v a p o r a t e d u n d e r n i t r o g e n , red i s s o l v e d in m e t h a n o l and a p p l i e d to s i l i c a gel G - 6 0 p l a t e s and c h r o m a t o g r a p h e d in two d i m e n s i o n s F r o m r e f e r e n c e (21).
110
lOug/ml
lOOuM
ARACHIDONIC ACID
THROMBIN
COLLAGEN 30SEC IOU/ml
lU/ml
0.2U/ml
-J 60SEC 80uq/ml 4Quq/ml J^
H-CRP
IQuq/ml
60SEC Figure 9.
A comparison of the ability of arachidonic acid, collagen, thrombin or H-CRP to generate TXA2 activity from platelets. Platelets suspensions were challenged with the concentrations shown and the reaction mixtures assayed. Aortic strips were suspended from transducers at a constant tension of 2 gm/cm and calibrated using a polygraph with recorder From reference (21).
The ability of H-CRP and AHGG to Facilitate Blood Coagulation. In an attempt to ascertain whether aggregate CRP or IgG could facilitate blood coagulation, we performed experiments to simultaneously measure clot formation and platelet aggregation in PRP in the presence of H-CRP or AHGG; results are seen in Figure 10. Each decreased the time of onset for clot formation; H-CRP also markedly enhanced (synergistically) the amount of platelet aggregation (Figure 11). This phenomena required the presence of platelets as the onset of clot formation was not enhanced in platelet-poor-plasma.
111 01 M
3 T) t-1 tí o ta o ^ ^ PH 4-1 cri O c o O 0) i S
> • r-1 •H 00 M 4-1 3 3 n) Otí U o O Ci e r4 o U-1 * — tn o O u e ex 3 O tn •H 1-J 4J 4-1 3 O tí O U QJ O •— — ' P. O tß ai Ol 0) n cri ^ o 3 o < 00 1 4-1 •r-t a: 0¡ Ù0 [n -o e 01 1 IJ en »< > 1-1 3 O
— ,\
1 0) 00 0) ^ 00 00 ta w CJ i—i 0) 4-1 0) T-H P. -o tí ta
tí
o •H 4-1 ra g H O 4-1 4-1 O i—i O M — 1 O
tí
O 4-1 ra 4-1 • r4 CL, — i 1 Cri •H u tj 1 ra Ed [n • I-I
>>
*—
i— CM cri 145%) w a s o b s e r v e d . We b e l i e v e that these d a t a r e f l e c t the p r i m a r y m e c h a n i s m s by w h i c h serum a m y l o i d P - c o m p o n e n t i n f l u e n c e s blood coagulation. In c l o s i n g , I have p r e s e n t e d some of our d a t a c o n c e r n i n g the i n t e r a c t i o n of c e r t a i n acute p h a s e r e a c t a n t s w i t h the hemostatic mechanism. T h e s e data p r e s e n t c l e a r e v i d e n c e for an i n t e r - l o c k i n g s y s t e m of i n d u c t i o n and r e g u l a t o r y c o n t r o l t h a t we s u s p e c t w i l l be found to be the c o r n e r s t o n e " p u r p o s e " of the acute p h a s e r e s p o n s e .
124 ACKNOWLEDGEMENTS The author gratefully acknowledges the insight of Henry Gewürz, MD, Chairm a n of the department of Immunology/Microbiology, R u s h Medical Center, Chicago, Illinois, without whose w i s d o m these projects would not have been undertaken. The technical and developmental expertise of Robert M. Simpson, PhD, Cecilia S.L. Ku, PhD and Joyce M. Izzi, BSc, is also greatly appreciated, as is the excellent secretarial assistance of Ms. Mary A n n Briggs. REFERENCES 1- Fiedel, B.A., Costello, M., Gewürz, H. and Hussissian, E. 1983. H a e m o s tasis 13:89. 2 - Fiedel, B.A., Potempa, L.A., Frenzke, M.E., Simpson, R.M. and Gewürz, H . 1982. Immunology 45:15. 3 - Fiedel, B.A. and Ku, C.S.L. 1983. J. Exp. Med. (in press). 4- Fiedel, B.A., Simpson, R.M. and Gewürz, H. 1982, Immunology 45:439. 5 - Haupt, H., Heimburger, N. and Bauder, S. 1972, III Hoppe-Seyler's Z. Physiol. Chem. 353:1841. 6- Lowry, 0., Rosenbrough, N.J., Farr, A.L. and Randall, R.J. 1951. J. Biol. Chem. 193:265. 7- Osmand, A.P., Friedensen, B., Gewürz, H., Painter, R.H., Hofman, T. and Shelton, E. 1977. Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei. (USA) 74:739. 8 - Laemmli, U.K. 1970. Nature 227:680. 9 - Jeanloz, R.W.: in Glycoproteins (ed. A. Gottschalk) p. 560-585. Elsevier North Holland, New York, 1965. 10- Winzler, R.J.: Glycoproteins in disease. In Glycoproteins of Red Cells and Plasma (eds. G.A. Jamieson and T.J. Greenwalt) p. 204-218. J.B. Lippincott, New York, 1971. 11- Schmid, K.: Alpha 1-acid glycoprotein. In, The Plasma Proteins: Structure Function and Genetic Control (ed. F.W. Putnam) p. 163-228, Academic Press New York, 1975. 12- Schmid, K., Kaufman, H., Isemura, S., Bauer, F., Emura, J., Montoyama, T. Ishigura, M. and Nann, S. 1973. Biochem. 12:2721. 13- Snyder, S. and Coodley, E.I. 1976. Arch. Intern. Med. 136:778. 14- Costello, M., Fiedel, B.A. and Gewürz, H. 1979. Nature 281:667. 15- Andersen, P. and Eika, C. 1979. Thromb. Haemostasis 42:299. 16- Godal, H.C. 1961. Scand. J. Clin, and Laboratory Invest. 13:314. 17- Andersen, P. and Godal, H.C. 1977. Haemostasis 6:339. 18- Andersen, P. 1980. Haemostasis 9:303. 19- Tillett, W.S. and Francis, T. Jr. 1930. J. Exp. Med. 52:561. 20- Gewürz, H., Mold, C., Siegel, J. and Fiedel, B.A. 1982. C-reactive protein and the acute phase response. Adv. Int. Medicine (G.H. Stollerman, ed.) v.27, Y e a r Book Medical Pub., Chicago, pgs. 345-372. 21- Simpson, R.M., Prancan, A., Izzi, J.M. and Fiedel B.A. 1982. Immunology 47:193. 22- Fiedel, B.A., Ku, C.S.L., Izzi, J.M. and Gewürz, H. 1983, J. Immunol, (in press). 23- Holmsen, H. 1977. Thromb. (Haemostasis) 38:1030. 24- Pepys, M.B., Becker, G.J., Dick, R.F., McCraw, A . , Hilgard, P., Rosemary, E. and Thomas, D.P. 1980. Clin. Chim. A c t a 105:83.
MONOCLONAL ANTIBODIES AS PROBES OF COMPLEMENT FUNCTION
Shaun Ruddy Medical College of Virginia, Virginia Commonwealth Richmond, Virginia, U.S.A.
University
Introduction Polyclonal antisera directed against individual plasma proteins have been widely used as tools to study the function of these proteins. of
the
complement
than twenty years the
system
antigenic have
been
peptide
(4).
or
useful
(3) and have the
antisera
Such polyclonal
determinants
determining
such
have
been
available
for
more
(1) and have been prepared to all twenty components
(2).
often
medicine
proteins,
In the case
Because
epitopes
for
of
they
on
measuring
sometimes
function
antisera, which the
are
individual
plasma
a
collection
protein
in inhibition
complement of
of
a variety
concentrations
been valuable
a particular
recognize
molecules, in
clinical
studies
protein or
heterogenous
of
for
cleavage
antibodies
directed against all of the epitopes on an individual protein, such antisera are of no utility
in determining
the fine
specificity
involved
in
the protein-protein interactions characteristic of complement activation.
The successful fusion of B-lymphocytes from an immune animal with a myeloma
line
in continuous
culture
(5) has
afforded
the opportunity of de-
veloping reagents in which all of the antibody molecules a single clone.
are products
of
Such monoclonal reagents are homogenous in their reactiv-
ity with a single antigenic determinant on the immunizing protein, and can therefore
be used
to delineate
the function of the protein. four monoclonal
the
importance
of
individual
This manuscript presents
epitopes
information
to
about
antibodies: two directed against Factor B of the alterna-
tive complement pathway, one of which blocks the sis and monocyte spreading
activity of B in hemoly-
(6) and two others reactive with the C3d frag-
ment of the third component which appear to discriminate between the sites on C3d of most importance in the alternative and classical pathways (7).
M a r k e r Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1 9 8 4 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
126 Materials and Methods Production of monoclonal antibodies from rat X rat hybrids DA rats were immunized with human alternative pathway convertase
prepared
by incubating purified C3b (8), B and D (9) for 30 min at 37° C. two
injections
in
Freund's
complete
or
incomplete
adjuvant,
After
rats
boosted by intravenous injection three days prior to the fusion.
were
Myeloma
lines used for fusion were Y3 Ag 1.2.3 (for the anti-B clones) or 210.RCY0 (for the anti-C3 clones). en
in
(10),
myeloma
but
cells
in
in the presence of
from hybrids selected thymidine
Details of the hybridization procedure are givo 7 brief, 10 spleen cells were fused with 5 X 10 polyethylene
glycol
4000.
Supernates
in medium containing hypoxanthine, aminopterin and
(HAT), were screened for anti-B or anti-C3
in an ELISA or RIA
system using purified B or C3 bound to 96-well microtiter plates. ficity
of
reactivity
for
C3
was
determined
using
sheep
Speci-
erythrocytes
coated with C3b, C3bi or C3d prepared with purified CI, C4, C2, C3, H and I (11) and indirect agglutination using goat the
second
antibody.
Positive
pristane-primed
immunoglobulin
culture wells were cloned
either on soft agar or by limiting dilution. injecting
anti-rat
and
subcloned
Ascites fluid produced
DA rats or nu/nu mice with cloned
as
cell
by
lines
was fractionated by precipitation either in polyethylene glycol or caprylic acid, followed by chromatography on DEAE cellulose to yield homogeneous solutions of the monoclonal
antibodies.
Hemolytic assays Sheep erythrocytes were coated with purified complement proteins to generate EAC14
the 0Xy
23b
intermediates was
EAC14 o x y 23b
accomplished
and
by exposure
to
EAC43b.
source
of
of
a reagent containing
fied human C5 (50 U/ml) and a source of C6-C9. with purified
Lysis
The EAC43Bb were
the purilysed
B and D followed by rat serum diluted in EDTA-buffer as a
C3-C9.
Hemolysis
was
quantitated
spectrophotometrically
and
expressed as the average number of sites (Z) per cells according to the Poisson distribution where Z = -ln(l-y) and y is the decimal fraction of cells
lysed. Reagents were adjusted to yield between 80 and 95 per cent
127 lysis corresponding
to Z values of 1.6 and 3.0.
Inhibition of lysis was
calculated from the decrease in Z and expressed as a per cent. Inhibiton of monocyte spreading Human monocytes
were purified from peripheral
blood by counterflow
elu-
triation as described previously and were the gift of Dr. Bruce Rutherford (8).
The
spreading
assay
was
performed
essentially
as
described
by
Sundsmo and Gotze, except that eight-chambered tissue culture glass slides (Lab Tek Products Division of Miles Laboratories, Napierville,
111) were
used in place of glass cover slips contained in plastic plates. were
adhered
to
the
slides
autologous serum for 16 hr.
in medium
containing
20%
heat
Monocytes inactivated
Serum-containing medium was washed away and
serum-free medium replaced, followed by a 3 day incubation before exposure to the reagents used to induce spreading for 3 hr.
Results Monoclonal anti-B For the inhibition of monocyte clonal antibodies were used.
spreading
induced by Factor B, two mono-
C81 had previously been shown to react with
the Bb moiety of B and to inhibit the hemolytic activities of Factor B either
in
EAC43bBbP.
the
fluid
phase
or
when
bound
to
the
cell
intermediate
D21 reacted with the Ba fragment of B and had no effect on
the hemolytic activity of this component.
Cells were exposed to Factor B
which
at 37° C. for 90 min with an
had been activated by preincubation
equal concentration of C3b and l/20th the concentration of Factor D, or to this activated preparation of B in the presence of either monoclonal antibody.
The final concentration of B in the culture medium was 2 y g / m l ;
monoclonal antibodies were added to a final concentration of l O y g / m l . Table
I gives
spreading
the
in medium
results
of
alone was
induced by activated B in the
three
separate
variable, absence
experiments.
as was the extent of
of monoclonal
antibody.
Background spreading In each
128 experiment,
however,
inhibition
of
B-induced spreading
was observed
with
clone C81, but not with D21.
Table I INHIBITION OF HUMAN MONOCYTE SPREADING BY MONOCLONAL ANTIBODIES TO HUMAN B
Cells Spread (per cent)* Expt I
Expt II
7 ± 3
12 ± 4
4± 3
Medium + B
34 ± 8
47 ± 6
28 ± 5
Medium + B + D21
37 ± 6
42 ± 7
31 ± 6
Medium + B + C81
4 ±2
Condition Medium
6
±
Expt III
3
8 ± °>
* > 2 0 0 cells counted per sample; mean + S.E. of triplicate
Monoclonal
Products
determinations.
anti-C3
of
two
clones,
3C4
and 4D7, were studied for their capacity
to
block the hemolytic activity of C3 in either the classical
or
alternative
pathway.
to
agglutinate
EAC43d that 125
In
preliminary
(trypsin) they
I-C3
cells
reacted
was
studies,
as well
with
reduced
the
with
as C3d
both
had
EAC43b
been
and
fragment
shown
EAC43bi
of
2-mercaptoethanol,
the
cells,
C3
indicating
molecule.
incubated
with
When
the
IgG
fraction of 3C4, and excess goat anti-rat Ig added, the alpha chain of C3 was
preferentially
precipitated,
mide gel electrophoresis and To
assess
used B,
to
D
their
inhibit
and
with
C3-C9
effects the in
in
hemolysis, either
following
both
EAC14
0Xy
monoclonal 23
experiment.
of
either
3C4
or
4D7
at 37° C. for
washed free of the antibodies, suspended excess
C5-C9,
cells yielded with
polyacryla-
antibodies
by C5-C9 or EAC14oxy23
limited
and
94 per C3b
allowed
cent
were
to
lysis.
exposed
to
lyse
30 min.
37°
60 min;
In a similar fashion, the
concentra-
The cells
c . for
two
antibodies,
EAC43b
washed,
by
prepared
in a developing reagent at
were
EAC43bBb
were
limited amount of C3b, washed, and incubated with varying
tions
ing
SDS
radioautography.
lysis of the
as judged by subsequent
were
then
containuntreated prepared incubated
129 with
excess
B
cells yielded
and
D,
85 per
and
lysis
cent
lysis.
developed The
with
extent
the two cell types by the two monoclonal
excess
of
C3-C9;
inhibition
antibodies
untreated
of
lysis
of
is shown in Table II.
It is apparent that 3C4 efficiently inhibits the formation of the alternative pathway convertase
as assessed
by the reaction
between
EAC43b,B
and
D; whereas 4D7 is more potent at interfering with the reaction between C3b and
C5
involved
in
the
formation
of
the
terminal
lytic membrane
attack
complex.
Table II INHIBITION OF C3 HEMOLYTIC ACTIVITY BY MONOCLONAL ANTIBODIES TO C3
Reaction
0
0 ^
1.3
6.4
32
160
3C4 Concentration (ng/ml) C3b + C5-C9
0
17*
C3b + B + D + C3-C9
0
7
18
23
28
100
32
95
100
100
4D7 Concentration (ng/ml) C3b + C5-C9
0
0
2
10
55
92
C3b + B + D + C3-C9
0
3
10
23
25
35
*per cent inhibition of average number of hemolytic sites per cell.
Discussion
The in
experiments defining
presented
the
fine
anti-B monoclonal tic
activity
tained
in
of
the
illustrate
specificity
the
power
involved
of monoclonal
in
biologic
C81 had previously been shown Factor
fluid
B regardless
phase
or
already
of
antibodies
reactions.
(6) to block the
whether
this
incorporated
molecule
into
the
pathway convertase
in the form C3bBb or C3bBbP; the presumption the
with
site of this protein. specifically sized with
binding the
Bb fragment
B on or
Direct radioautography
precipitate site.
of
The
the
Bb
fragment,
inactive
Ba fragment which
has
the
active
D21,
biologic
by
with
con-
was
that
enzymatic
showed that C81 did
consistent
monoclonal
no known
near
hemoly-
was
alternative
C81
combined
The
indeed
the
hypothe-
contrast,
combined
activity.
The
finding
130 that
the
active-site
reagent
spreading of human monocytes
C81
blocked
the capacity of Bb to
induce
indicates that the enzymatic site of Bb is
required for this activity as well.
These data independently confirm the
earlier observations (13, 14) that the active serine esteratic site on Bb was necessary for the spreading phenomenon.
A similar definition of fine specificity with the monoclonal
antibodies
tral role in both classical of
complex
interactions
to C3.
is apparent
in the
experiments
This component, which has a cen-
and alternative pathways, undergoes a number
with
other plasma proteins,
including
C42,
the
enzyme for which it is the substrate; C5, which binds to C3b and thereby becomes a better substrate for initiation of the terminal attack sequence; Factor B, which binds to C3b and thereby becomes susceptible to cleavage by Factor D to form the alternative pathway convertase; Factor H, which binds to C3b and renders it both incapable of interaction with B and susceptible to cleavage by Factor I; and properdin, which is believed to bind to
the
alternative
pathway
convertase
active enzymatic form of this complex.
via
C3b
thereby
Although there
stabilizing
the
is evidence
that
B, P and H may react on or near the same site, the remaining
interactions
clearly
these
occur
at
independent
loci
on
the molecule.
Since
sites
vary in their structure, they may also differ in their antigenic composition, and may display epitopes which may be distinguished by the appropriate monoclonal antibodies. preliminary,
Although the data presented in Table II are
it appears that 3C4 preferentially recognizes the B binding
site and thereby blocks formation of the alternative
pathway
convertase;
the effect on hemolysis of EAC1423b in the presence of C5-C9 observed at high concentrations of this monoclonal remains unexplained at present.
By
contrast, 4D7 appears to interfere with the interaction of C5 with C3b, an effect which is more apparent with EAC1423 where the numbers of C3 molecules are continuously limited than with EAC43b where the numbers of C3b molecules are only initially limited when the alternative pathway convertase is being formed, but are relatively plentiful
during the developing
reaction when diluted whole rat serum is used as a source of C3-C9. Monoclonal
antibodies to C3 have been used to characterize the breakdown
of this molecule into fragments by Factor I, and provided evidence for a
131 new
fragment,
C3dg,
which
cleavage of bound C3bi
is
the
(15).
physiologic
fragment
derived
from
Tamerius described several monoclonal
the
anti-
C3 antibodies which blocked binding of H, and others which blocked both P and H binding; none inhibited the binding of B (16). gant studies with eight different monoclonal
In a series of ele-
antibodies
to guinea pig
(17), Burger and co-workers delineated a number of discrete sites ted with various functions of C3. tive
with
antigenic
They described three monoclonals,
determinants
on C3c, which
inhibited
C3
associareac-
the binding
of
125 I-B from
to
those
cells
bearing
presented
C3b.
here for
yet
These 3C4,
blocks
the
results
which
C3d-coated
cells,
convertase
(Table I) and the uptake of
has
formation 1
are
distinctly
been of
found
the
to
different agglutinate
alternative
I-B (data not shown).
pathway Further
experiments will be required to resolve these differences. Although ficity, nature
monoclonal as
in the
should
antibodies studies
be made
just
may
provide
described,
for workers
are
because
listed
of
the
in Table
very
project utilizing monoclonal
some real
homogeneity
III, and should
of exquisite caveats
of
in the field of acute phase
There are a number of disadvantages, arise
reagents several
be
of
a
specigeneral
proteins.
and some potential,
monoclonal
considered
antibodies.
before
embarking
which These on
a
reagents.
Table
III
POTENTIAL DISADVANTAGES OF MONOCLONAL ANTIBODIES FOR THE STUDY OF ACUTE PHASE REACTANTS
Excessive Relative
lability to pH, temperature or other physical
conditions
insolubility
Poor tolerance of labelling procedures (e.g., tyrosine in combining site may result in loss of activity with oxidative iodination) Low affinity of binding (important in immunoassay) Isotype class or species poorly reactive with staphylococcal
protein A
132 Summary Two sets of monoclonal antibodies directed against proteins of the complement system, Factor B and C3, have been developed. active with
Factor
Of two antibodies re-
B, one which reacts on or near the active
esteratic
site of this enzyme blocks both its activity in immune hemolysis and its capacity to induce the spreading
of human monocytes.
Of two antibodies
reactive with C3, both of which react with an epitope present on the C3d fragment of this molecule, one preferentially blocks the reactivity of C3b with Factor B.
These antibodies are illustrative of the high degrees of
specificity which may be obtained with such reagents.
They do not illus-
trate some of their pitfalls, which need also to be considered.
References 1. Müller-Eberhard, H.J., Nilsson, U.:
J. Exp. Med. Ill, 217-234 (1960).
2. Muller-Eberhard, H.J.: Hos. Pract. 12, 33-43 (1978). 3. Ruddy, S., Carpenter, C.B., Muller-Eberhard, H.J., Austen, K.F.: In Miescher, P.A. and Grabar, P. (eds.), Mechanisms of Inflammation Induced by Immune Reactions, Vth Int. Immunopath. Symposium, Schwabe & Co., Basel (1968). pp. 231-251. 4. Ward, P.A.: In Ingram, D.G., (ed), Biological Activities of Complement, S. Karger, Basel (1972). pp. 108-116. 5. Kohl er, G., Milstein, C.:
Nature 256, 495 (1975).
6. Ruddy, S., Lachmann, P.: Molec. Immun. 19, 1399 (1982). 7. Ruddy, S., (1983).
Moxley,
G.
F.,
8. Rutherford, B., Schenkein, H.:
Purkall,
D.B.:
Immunobiology
Immunology 46, 163-173 (1982).
10. Lachmann, P.J., Oldroyd, R.G., Milstein, C., Wright, B.W.: 41:503-515 (1980) 11. Carlo, J., Conrad, D.H., Ruddy, S.:
Immunology
J. Immunol. 123, 523-528 (1979).
Cell. Immunol. 52, 1-11 (1979).
13. Gotze, 0., Bianco, C., Cohn, A.Z.: 14. Sundsmo, J.S., Gotze, 0.:
291
J. Period. Res. 17, 484-486 (1982).
9. Carlson, P., Ruddy, S., Conrad, D.H.:
12. Sundsmo, J.S., Gotze, 0.:
164,
J. Exp. Med. 149, 372-386 (1979).
J. Exp. Med. 154:763-777 (1981).
15. Lachmann, P.J., Pangburn, M.K., Oldroyd, R.G.: 219 (1982).
J. Exp. Med. 156, 205-
133 16. Tamerius, J.D., Pangburn, M.K., Eberhard, H.J.: 518 (1982).
J. Immunol. 128, 512-
17. Burger, R., Deubel, U., Hadding, U., Bitter-Suermann, D.: 129, 2042-2050 (1982).
J. Immunol.
MODULATION OF FORMATION OF THE C3 AMPLIFICATION CONVERTASE OF HUMAN COMPLEMENT BY ACUTE PHASE PROTEINS
Elizabeth Fischer, Michel Pontet, François Delers, N. Tran Quang, Michel Kazatchkine and Robert Engler Inserm U 28, Hôpital Broussais and UER Biomedicale des Saints Pères, Paris, France
Introduction The plasma concentration of acute phase reactants, C-reactive protein (CRP), orosomucoïd and haptoglobin increase during inflammatory processes. CRP has been shown to interact with the human complement system in several ways. Binding of CRP to Pneumococcal
C polysaccharide, to phosphocholine
containing molecules and to polycationic substances results in complement activation through the classical pathway (1). Complexes between CRP and Pneumococcal
C polysaccharide are solubilized by the classical
complement
pathway (2). Binding of CRP to liposomes and to S. pneumoniae inhibits the ability of the liposomes to activate the alternative pathway (3). The present study investigated the effect of human CRP, orosomucoïd and haptoglobin on the formation of the alternative pathway C3 convertase in vitro (4).
Methods CRP was purified from acute phase sera by chromatography on phosphoethanolamine-sepharose using phosphorylcholine in the eluting buffer. Orosomucoïd was purified by ammonium sulfate precipitation and sequential chromatography on CM cellulose and Sephacryl S 200. Haptoglobin (1-1) was purified as previously described (5). The alternative pathway proteins •C3,B,D,P and H were purified to homogeneity from normal human plasma using the methods quoted in ref 4. In order to examine the effect of acute phase proteins on formation of alternative pathway C3 convertase, sheep erythrocytes bearing C3b, EAC4b,
M a r k e r Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1 9 8 4 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
136 3b, were interacted with various concentrations of B,D and P in the presence of 0.5 mM of M g + + at 30° C so as to generate approximately
1.5 sites/
cell. 0.1 ml of the reaction mixture were added to 0.1 ml of buffer alone ( D G V B + + i.e. low ionic strength buffer containing 0.5 mM M g + + and 0.15 mM C a + + ) or containing increasing amounts of purified acute phase
proteins.
After incubation for 30 min at 30° C, cells were washed once, resuspended in 0.2 ml of D G V B + + and incubated with 0.3 ml of a 1/20 dilution of rat serum in 40 mM EDTA for 60 min at 37° C so as to reveal hemolytic sites that had been formed during the first incubation step.
Results CRP, haptoglobin and orosomucoïd inhibited formation of the C3 amplification convertase of complement in a dose dependent manner. Fifty per cent inhibitory concentrations were approximately 35 pg, 70 pg, 140 pg/1.10^ EAC4b3bBbPin 0.2 ml respectively
(Fig 1). Serum albumin at similar con-
centrations had no effect.
ug protein/10 7 EAC43bBbP/0.2 ml
Fig. 1
- Inhibition of formation of P stabilized C3 convertase
sites,
C3b,Bb,P, in the presence of purified CRP ( A — • ), orosomucoïd ( • — • ), haptoglobin ( • — • ) and BSA ( o — o ).
137 Experiments using orosomucoTd and haptoglobin during formation of the C3 convertase in the absence of D and in the presence or absence of P indicated that these two proteins have a minor inhibitory effect on P and D and that the major site of action is between cell bound C3b and factor B. CRP and orosomuco'Td did not affect the spontaneous decay of a preformed P stabilized C3 convertase
; in contrast, haptoglobin actively
dissocia-
ted Bb from a P stabilized convertase similarly to factor H although on a molar basis it is about 10000 times less effective than H (Fig. 2). Thus, acute phase proteins may modulate the expression of the amplification C3 convertase of complement at concentrations similar to those found in inflammatory
sera.
o
? •
Fig. 2
il
To
ng H I0 7 EAC43bBbP. 0 . 2 ml
- Dose dependent decay (20 min at 30° C) of P stabilized C3 convertase sites, C3b,Bb,P in the presence of haptoglobin ( • — • ), in the presence of H ( • — • ) and in the presence of H and 35 ug haptoglobin ( • — • ).
138 References 1.
Kaplan, M.H., V o l a n a k i s , J . E .
2.
V o l a n a k i s , J.E.
: J . Immunol. U 2 , 2135
3.
Mold, C . , Gewurtz, H. : J . Immunol. J_27, 2029 (1981 ).
(1974).
: Ann. N. Y. Acad. S c i . 389, 235 ( 1 9 8 2 ) .
4.
K a z a t c h k i n e , M.D. and Nydegger, U.E.
5.
D e l e r s , F. et a l .
: Prog. A l l e r g y 30, 193
: A n a l . Biochem. 118, 353 ( 1 9 8 1 ) .
(1982).
MATERNO-TROPHOBLASTIC
RELATIONSHIP
RECURRENT
ABORTION
SPONTANEOUS
W. P a g e F a u l k , C h a n g - 3 i n g
IN NORMAL H U M A N P R E G N A N C Y
Yeh, B.-L.
AND
Hsi
INSERM U n i t U2""0, D e p a r t m e n t of I m m u n o l o g y , F a c u l t y of Ave. V a l l o m b r o s e , 06000 Nice
Medecine
Introduction
It m u s t in the f i r s t i n s t a n c e be said that m o s t m e d i c a l p e o p l e to i m a g i n e
the e x i s t e n c e of a m a t e r n o - f e t a l
relationship
that is
g o v e r n e d p r i m a r i l y by the p l a c e n t a , but both of these c o n c e p t s anatomically incorrect. maternal
T h e r e are no i n t e r f a c e s of c o n t a c t
and e m b r y o n i c or fetal
entirely extra-embryonic, presented
to m a t e r n a l
relationship.
t i s s u e s . The p r i n c i p a l
e x i s t at the e n d o v a s c u l a r the i n t e r s t i t i a l
materno-
The
materno-trophoblastic
c o n t a c t , for there are four d i f f e r e n t i n t e r f a c e s
arteries,
between
maternal
materno-trophoblastic
trophoblast uithin
trophoblast within
the
the p l a c e n t a l
spiral bed,
the
and
the
c y t o t r o p h o b l a s t of the c h o r i o n i c a s p e c t of the a m n i o c h o r i o n , syncytiotrophoblast
of the p l a c e n t a l
will be c o n s i d e r e d in
tropho-
and this p h r a s e s h o u l d be usr-d in p r e -
p l a c e n t a is c l e a r l y not r e s p o n s i b l e for all
interfaces
is
tissue w h i c h is
does not e x i s t in o t h e r
to the l e s s m e a n i n g f u l m a t e r n o - f e t a l
and e x t r a - e m b r y o n i c
contribution
s e n s e , but there is such a thing as the
trophoblastic relationship, ference
relationship
are
betueen
cells at all of these i n t e r f a c e s is the
b l a s t . Thus, the m a t e r n o - f e t a l than a b i o c h e m i c a l
tissue. The fetal
and the e x t r a - e m b r y o n i c
tend
c h o r i o n i c v i l l i . Ef-ch of
turn.
M a r k e r Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1 9 8 4 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
these
140 Endovascular
trophoblast
At an i m p r e c i s e l y
known
time b e f o r e
g r a t i o n of c y t o t r o p h o b l a s t i n t o P a r t of terial
these e n t e r a n d m a k e
lumen where
endothelium, occurs
from
w a v e of
the e i g h t h w e e k ,
human decidua
they c h a l l e n g e
and another the s e r o s a l
trophoblast
their way upstream
and e v e n t u a l l y
trophoblastic surface.
invasion
teries
(Pijnenborg
this is r a t h e r o b s c u r e ,
et al..
into
trate into
the m y o m e t r i a l the s p i r a l
histopathological Robertson gested wave. also
segments
arteries'
Hospital Medical
t h a t p r e - e c l a m p s i a is a d i s e a s e Another
characteristic
to be t e m p o r a l l y
filtration
trophoblast
of
f e a t u r e of s p i r a l
is the l o s s of a d i s c e r n i b l e
lock
the v e s s e l s
taneously
disallowing
materials
in the u t e r u s ,
has b e e n p r e s e n t e d material
(Faulk 4 M c l n t y r e ,
e t al.,
arteries
ara suboptimally
1975), and
t h e s i s of a f a i l u r e if i n d e e d
to p o i n t o u t h e r e
t h a t the
of
Whatever they
functions
certainly
a successful
(uteroplacental)
vasoactive
the
trophoblast
trophoblast
moof
(Robertson hypo-
invasion,
is in s o m e w a y
host-parasite
a r t e r y is a m a t e r n a l
Evidence
the R o b e r t s o n
t h a t is a l m o s t w i t h o u t p r e c e d e n t i n i m m u n o b i o l o g y , spiral
re-
simul-
aspects
by e n d o v a s c u l a r
the e n d o v a s c u l a r
create
to
PAS-reactive
in p r e - e c l a m p s i a
the s e c o n d e n d o v a s c u l a r
artery endothelium
to
c e l l s , b u t for
with
in-
function
dilatation while
the r e p l a c e m e n t of b a s e m e n t m e m b r a n e
r e p l a c e m e n t of s p i r a l
serve,
dilated
seems
due
could
t h a t the d i s t a l
t h a t this is c o m p a t i b l e
sug-
second
the p r o s t a g l a n d i n s .
1983)
in
B.
which
to v a s o c o n s t r i c t in r e s p o n s e
s u c h as s o m e of
is p r o b a b l y m a d e by e x t r a - e m b r y o n i c
m e n t i t is p e r t i n e n t spiral
them
pene-
has
the
basement membrane
in m a x i m u m
of oc-
trophoblastic
p l a c e m e n t by a P A S - p o s i t i v e m a t e r i a l . T h i s s t r u c t u r e to o p e r a t i o n a l l y
found
of
arteries
associated with endovascular
ar-
elongation-and
London,
the f a i l u r e
to to
Indeed, Prof. W. School,
second
significance
the s e c o n d w a v e
e n d s as has b e e n
s t u d i e s of p r e - s c l a m p s i a .
at St. G e o r g e ' s
arteries
and spiral
and with inadeguate
distal
ar-
vascular
t h e r e is a
i 9 B " b ) . The p h y s i o l o g i c a l
c u r is a s s o c i a t e d w i t h a f a i l u r e of e n d o v a s c u l a r
d i l a t i o n of
al.,
the
spiral
the e n d o m e t r i u m
b u t f a i l u r e of
et
in the
replace
Several weeks later
that again invades
all of
t h e r e is a m i -
(Pijnenborg
due
to
trophoblast. subset
might
relationship
for the
mature
v e s s e l w h i c h is
lined,
141 infiltrated
and in part surrounded
gin. This seems sequelae,
for l y m p h o c y t e s
and rejection
reactions
not known, unlike
a n d o t h e r c e l l s r e m i n i s c e n t of
1 9 8 1 ) . The e n d o v a s c u l a r
for m a t e r n a l
stimulation
syncytiotrophoblast,
major histocompatibility 1983).
In l i g h t of
to m o u n t i m m u n e
complex
the p r e s e n c e
trophoblast,
iodide
and p l a s m i n o g e n
(Faulk
& Mclntyre,
(MHC)
1983). More importantly,
1 9 8 0 ) . T h e s e new f i n d i n g s w i l l
the n o t i o n of
the i m m u n o p a t h o l o g y
Interstitial At term cally
the p l a c e n t a l
of h u m a n
antigens so
cells a
certain
pregnancy,
some
as a g r a f t w a s
(Barnstable
but
investigators
& Bodmer,
due 1978).
simple.
bed is f i l l e d w i t h
cytotrophoblast.
trophoblast
cells. Sometimes these
f u s i o n s are
i n the p l a c e n t a l
bed which
heterologous In f a c t ,
or m o n o c l o n a l
antibodies
the r e a c t i v i t i e s of a n t i - T A
to be
cells
cannot
hybridization
to i d e n t i f y m u l t i n u c l e a t e d
react with anti-HLA
and
form
thought
but hybridization with maternal
for we are a b l e
morphologi-
they f u s e to
be r u l e d o u t . The m a t t e r of m a t e r n o - t r o p h o b l a s t i c be k e p t o p e n ,
that
T h e s e are in the e n d o m e t r i u m
g i a n t c e l l s . M o s t of
trophoblast-trophoblast,
(TA).
with
was HLA-negative,
had b e e n s t u d i e d ,
to be q u i t e
in a s e a of m a t e r n a l
multinucleated
either
tropho-
trophoblast;
resembles
survive
necessitate
t h a t the s u c c e s s of p r e g n a n c y
transplantation
Alas, it does not appear
possibility
w h i c h are m a r k e r s of e n d o t h e l i a l
for a f t e r i t w a s s h o w n t h a t s y n c y t i o t r o p h o b l a s t
to the a b s e n c e
was
propidium
the e n d o u a s c u l a r
antibodies
trophoblast subsets
a
sera and does not react
(Matter 4 Faulk,
developed
the
& Mclntyre,
m a r k e r s of
this a n u n l i k e l y
are
subset,
in w h i c h e n d o t h e l i u m
a n t i - F a c t o r VIII
before other
recognition
a n t i g e n s o n this s u b s e t ,
b u t the a d d i t i o n a l
receptors make
about
antigens
trophoblast
(Hsi, 1983; Faulk
of M H C
b l a s t is r e a c t i v e w i t h a n t i - t r o p h o b l a s t
a m o u n t of r e t h i n k i n g
distribu-
d o e s e x p r e s s C l a s s I a n t i g e n s of
c a s e of m i s t a k e n i d e n t i t y m i g h t be a s s u m e d confused with
recognition
trophoblast
b u t i t s h o u l d be p o i n t e d o u t t h a t this
ori-
immunological
h a v e b e e n n o t e d in a p e r i - a r t e r i a l
tion (Robertson et al.. responsible
by t i s s u e s of e x t r a - e m b r y o n i c
to n o t be w i t h o u t a c e r t a i n a m o u n t of
giant
sera but not
to t r o p h o b l a s t
sera with
must cells
with antigens
interstitial
142 t r o p h o b l a s t in g e n e r a l
are v a r i a b l e
t h a t this g r o u p m i g h t be m o r e although it probably waves
that spawned
and u n p r e d i c t a b l e ,
heterogeneous
originated
from
the endov/ascular
suggesting
t h a n the o t h e r
the o r i g i n a l trophoblast
subset,
cytotrophoblast
(Pijnenborg
et
al.,
1981b). Another peculiar
a s p e c t of
s u b s e t is i t s p e r i p a t e t i c commonly wandering being
found
into
(Pijnenborg
this s t r a n g e
a t the m o m e n t no r e a s o n a b l e be s a i d a g a i n
for m e m b r a n e m a r k e r s
extraordinary tial
et a l . ,
of t r o p h o b l a s t ,
t h a t the l a c k
than a subset. Finally,
tissues which simply
within
1954; D a l l e n b a c h - H e l l u i e g ,
according
to its h i s t o c h e m i c a l
of
t h e r e is
a phloxine-tartrazine
characteristics.
T h i s is a
mononuclear
in i t s c y t o p l a s m , w h o s e Not surprisingly,
is n o t
tissues
tissue interfaces
trophoblastic mantle
containing
5-7 cells, although
variations, trophoblast. reactions
is v a r i a b l e
Unlike
(Hsi e t a l . ,
1981; Hsi e t a l . , 1 9 8 2 ) ,
extra-
cytotrophoroughly
physiological
to two or e v e n o n e
positive
cyto-
immunocytological, in a fairly
1982), and monoclonal I antigens
with
thickness,
to h u g e
trophoblast,
s e r a are u s u a l l y
c o m m o n d e t e r m i n a n t of M H C C l a s s
reagents.
thinned
the i n t e r s t i t i a l
with anti-TA
in its
this is s u b j e c t
a n d c a n be a b n o r m a l l y
pattern
of m a t e r n a l
is t h a t b e t w e e n d e c i d u a a n d c h o r i o n i c
b l a s t . The
clonal
domain
function
cytotrophoblast
the m o s t e x t e n s i v e
embryonic
geneous
its
known.
Amniochorionic O n e of
cell
et al. . 1980),
appears
to the u t e r u s .
may
intersti-
leukocyte with eosinophilic granules to be l i m i t e d
only
homogeneity
another
uterine
1971; Pijnenborg
is
however
t h a t the g r o u p i n g
the m a t e r n a l
has been called
(Hamperl,
ask
trophoblast forms a subset and
un-
not
but there
to t h i s q u e r y . I t m u s t
location,
cell i d e n t i f i e d
not
but
1981a). One m u s t
s u c h as HLA a n d TA i n d i c a t e
be m o r e of a h o d g e p o d g e
1974),
e a r l y in g e s t a t i o n
group
response
t h a t the i n t e r s t i t i a l
by v i r t u e of i t s a n a t o m i c a l
cytotrophoblastic
(Robertson & Warner,
the m y o m e t r i u m
t h e r e a t term
a b o u t the f u n c t i o n of
nature
the i n t e r s t i t i a l
antisera
are n e g a t i v e
homoto
(Akle
b u t t h i s is n o t true for all a n t i - H L A
T h i s is t h o u g h t to be d u e
to the s h a r i n g
of a
HLA et
al.,
monocon-
143 s t a n t r e g i o n d o m a i n b e t w e e n HLA a n d c e r t a i n TA, p a n c y in r e a c t i o n p a t t e r n s is n o t s e e n w h e n studied on somatic
tissues
problem,
4 Flclntyre,
see F a u l k
(for a m o r e
for s u c h a
the s a m e a n t i s e r a
technical
interaction
a m n i o c h o r i o n uilxch m i g h t h a v 8 i m m u n o p a t h o l o g i c a l covered while conducting
though ample evidence
immunocytological
metrium
to s o m e t i m e s
nal c e l l s m i g r a t i n g ignored.
It w a s
the p r e s e n c e
into
now g r o w n
harbinger
s t u d i e s of
data. Clearly, with disease
a thinned
4 Hsi
the
migration
of
has b e e n
largely
cells deep w i t h i n 1983),
in normal
the c h o r i o n i c
observed
the
cyto-
b u t we
have
amnio c h o r i o n s .
cytotrophoblastic
b u t t h e r e are so few
this
subset
immunopatho-
that conclusions m u s t a w a i t
as has b e e n d i s c u s s e d
endomater-
that we first
(Faulk 4 H s i ,
Al-
has b e e n by F a u l k
more
associated et al.
(19G3) .
trophoblast
The interface
formed
t h a t of
by the v i l l o u s
the e n d o v a s c u l a r
b a t h e d by m a t e r n a l
The v i l l o u s
blood forms a syncytium,
m o s t s t u d i e d of all
t r o p h o b l a s t s u b s e t is trophoblast inasmuch
blood, but other
subsets differ greatly. maternal
territory
cytotrophoblastic mantle
in the f e t u s ,
(1982) and Faulk
The v i l l o u s
tissues
for
dis-
distribution
c e l l s in the m i d s t of
of d i s e a s e ,
these
was
interface.
the p o s s i b i l i t y
this as a c o m m o n f i n d i n g n u m b e r s of
the
the
through decidua and
interest
TA-negative
the p r e s e n c e of m a t e r n a l
is a d e f i n i t e
ally like
extra-embryonic
of a m n i o c h o r i o n
Thus, neither diminished
logical
the m y o m e t r i u m ,
of H L A - P o s i t i v e ,
to a c c e p t
subset nor
bed,
thus w i t h c o n s i d e r a b l e
trophoblastic mantle
s t u d i e s of
been put forward
the p l a c e n t a l
reach
this
in
significance
a t the a m n i o c h o r i o n i c
has already
of c y t o t r o p h o b l a s t i n t o
are
d i s c u s s i o n of
1983).
A n o t h e r a s p e c t of m a t e r n o - t r o p h o b l a s t i c
of TA a n d C l a s s I M H C a n t i g e n s
discre-
than
this,
the e x t r a - e m b r y o n i c
metabolically
the e v o l u t i o n a r y
events
a t the s y n c y t i o t r o p h o b l a s t ' s
(Boyd 4
advantages,
interface.
in an i m m u n o p a t h o l o g i c a l is the b u d d i n g
of
the
Hamilton,
d e v e l o p m e n t of a s y n c y t i u m
surface
with
this is c e r t a i n l y
tissues
important materno-trophoblastic
most bizarre metabolic
as i t is trophoblast
trophoblast which interfaces and a l t h o u g h
1 9 7 0 ) , i t is n o t a t all c l e a r w h a t b i o l o g i c a l derived from
the two
superfici-
if a n y , at
One of
sense
were
this
to
the occur
microvilli,
144 b i t s a n d p i e c e s of p l a s m a m e m b r a n e trophoblastic and e n t e r maternal
sprouts
the i n f e r i o r
vena cava and enter
heart
remain. Histological of i n f l a m m a t i o n
s t u d i e s of
n o m e n o n of a s e e m i n g by
these
1976)
to the m o t h e r .
recognition
and C l a s s
II
& Hsi,
IgG
s u c h as
(Johnson & Faulk,
for s y n c y t i u m , Fc-receptors thelium, many binds
on p l a c e n t a l
b u t n o t to
different to
are
not normally
thought
cross
the p l a c e n t a
able
to m a k e
spontaneous
a s p e c t of
the
times
syncytio-
have
the
9 8 0 ) . In
i9Ri).
immune
as p r o v i d i n g
1970).
high
reverse bind
newborns
spontaneous
IgG
These
re-
into
for the h i g h
(Wood e t a l . .
obdo
a specific
the
known, levels
1978).
abortion
data, Komlos et al..
conclusion
endo-
complexes
IgG
to
contrast,
I n s o f a r as is
thus a c c o u n t i n g
Fc-
monomeric
that m o n o m e r i c
t r a n s p o r t of m a t e r n a l
and B - typing
the i n s i g h t f u l abortions
shown
1
(Johnson & Brown,
(Brambell,
a n t i g e n s in r e c u r r e n t HLA-A
& Johnson,
have
as well
the r e c e p t o r is s p e c i f i c f o r I g G ,
While only using
anti-
and c h o r i o n i c stem v e s s e l
(Faulk
approaches
of o n l y IgG in c o r d b l o o d of n o r m a l
Trophoblast
interesting
macrophages
for
1976;
19B1,
c o m p l e x e s m a d e in the l a b o r a t o r y
for p r o t e c t i o n at b i r t h
parti-
1977) M H C
et a l . .
been confirmed many
to e x p l a i n w h y m a t e r n a l
ceptor-mediated mechanism fetus
et al..
b u t n o t for u n c o m p l e x e d or
trophoblast
technical
be
phe-
is the p r e s e n c e of r a t h e r u n u s u a l
trophoblast Fc-receptors
servations
(Faulk
(Sunderland
1 9 7 7 ) , b u t this s i t u a t i o n is q u i t e
since immune
The
I (Faulk 4 T e m p l e ,
t h o s e on B - l y m p h o c y t e s and m a c r o p h a g e s , complexes
odd
1983).
t r o p h o b l a s tic p l a s m a m e m b r a n e s
for i m m u n e
can p e r h a p s
they
evidence
tissue
.Another i m m u n o p a t h o l o g i c a l l y
receptors,
to p r e s e n t
is a f o r e i g n
findings which have
(for r e v i e w , see F a u l k
affinity
have failed
in
right
where
1 9 5 9 ) , w h i c h is
syncytiotrophoblast
^983),
the
& Toy,
lack of i m m u n e
villi
through
(Bardawil
the a b s e n c e of b o t h C l a s s
et a l . . normal
they c o u r s e
to f i n a l l y p a s s i n t o h e r lung
or r e j e c t i o n
syncytiotrophoblast
Lala et al..
chorionic
to e n t e r
the m o t h e r ' s
g e n s from
a w a y from
''964). T h e s e are c a r r i e d
from w h e n c e
veins
Goodfellow
break
(ikln,
multi-nucleated
the p l a c e n t a
s i d e of
ally explained
spaces
even
through
uterine
since
that normally
the i n t e r v i l l o u s blood
and s o m e t i m e s
that couples with
shared more histocompatibility
(1977)
were
repeated
antigens
than
145 did fertile firmed
couples,
and extended 1
Beer et al. .
to i n c l u d e o t h e r HLfl loci
98i; Mclntyre 4 Faulk,
Plclntyre 4 F a u l k , all f a i r n e s s
an o b s e r v a t i o n w h i c h has b e e n s e v e r a l
it does
couples
n o t seem
al. . 1983). N o n e t h e l e s s , sharing tive
is no m o r e
be a s s o c i a t e d w i t h
important
of
to s t u d y
in
some
( M o w b r a y e_t t h a t HLA
trophoblast-lymphocyte
significance
cross
reac-
performance
of w h y HLA
abortions, and
the r o l e of HLfl i n m a t i n g
the
should
possible
a n t i g e n s , i t is
couples under less
than r e c u r r e n t
the c o n s i d e r a t i o n s
ajpregnancy,
reproductive
the r e s u l t s
severe
spontaneous
clearly
life, and
show
h a v e b e e n the time
the h i s t o r y of p r e g n a n c i e s
of HLfl-fl or - B b e t w e e n
et al.. 1983). These
results indicate
to r e s u l t i n a s u c c e s s f u l
a b o v e f o r TLX r e s u l t s of
a circumstance antigens.
the H u t t e r i t e
compatibility
This appears patibility c a n be m o r e
clearly
relationship TLX
explained
of HLA w i t h TLX antigens
HLA in s u c h a w a y for the o t h e r
are
of the p r e d i c t e d immunity,
antigens
a brief
(Faulk
recognition.
in
the
e f f e c t s of
HLA
in-
immunity.
e f f e c t t h a t HLA a circumstance
com-
which
c o n s i d e r a t i o n of
the
et al. . 1978).
t h o u g h t to be i n l i n k a g e
that compatibility
HLA
described
as the n u m b e r of p r e g n a n c y
following
(Faulk 4 M c l n t y r e ,
l i t y of m a t e r n a l
to t h a t
the g e n e r a t i o n of m a t e r n a l
to g e n e r a t e m a t e r n a l
(Ober
t h a n is
important finding
s t u d y is t h a t the d e l e t e r i o u s
to be the o p p o s i t e
fails
pregnancy
w h i c h is v e r y s i m i l a r
a role for
and
t h a t HLfl d i v e r g e n c y i n a s e x u a l
The new and p o s s i b l y
becomes more obvious
suggesting
a
husband
p a t t e r n s of r e p r o d u c t i o n
u n i o n is m o r e l i k e l y compatibility,
re-
during
the n u m b e r of c h i l d r e n p r o d u c e d ,
that sharing
a n d w i f e is a s s o c i a t e d w i t h s u b o p t i m a l
creases,
sought
indicates
to the a l l o t y p i c s y s t e m of TLX
couples where
to a c h i e v e
couple's
in
T h i s has b e e n d o n e in a l a r g e p o p u l a t i o n of HLfl m a t c h e d
Hutterite quired
It m u s t
1983).
the b i o l o g i c a l
c o n d i t i o n s of r e p r o d u c t i v e abortion.
of
1981;
"'983;
19R2), although
thinking
recurrent spontaneous
this
1983b).
con-
h a v e f o u n d HLfl s h a r -
to h a v e b e e n d i l i g e n t l y
contemporary
(Faulk & H s i ,
Before examining
relationship
(Rocklin et al.,
than sharing
(TLX) a n t i g e n s
1983a;
t h a t n o t all i n v e s t i g a t o r s
ing b e t w e e n a b o r t i n g instances
(Taylor 4 Faulk,
1982; Unander 4 Dlding,
1933a; Mclntyre 4 Faulk,
be s a i d
times
disequilibrium
for o n e d e t e r m i n e s
1983), both disallowing
with
compatibility the
possibi-
T h i s is b o r n e o u t by p r e l i m i n a r y
HLfl
146 and TLX
typing
data obtained with
aborting
and fertile
tical m e c h a n i s m TLX
serves
couples
to e x p l a i n
as a m i n o r
the l e u k o c y t e s
(Mclntyre 4 Faulk,
this a s s o c i a t i o n is
histocompatibility
are a l l o t y p i c ,
and when appropriately
as b o n e m a r r o w
transplants
compatibility
complex
v/ersus-host d i s e a s e
into
recipients
as c o m p a r e d
only a major histocompatibility
underlying mechanism, clinical marker
it s h o u l d
to h e l p i d e n t i f y
m i g h t h a v e an i m m u n o p a t h o l o g i c a l the TLX
compatibility
pathophysiology. linkage
disequilibrium
indicate
chronic abortion in which partners,
1
(Mclntyre 4 Faulk,
9B2a,
Considerations maternal
be c l e a r
1982b,
s t i m u l a t i o n or the lack
stimulated,
the n a t u r e of
closely
the s a m e m a n )
(i.e., women who
though
cytes
(Faulk
4 Plclntyre,
to i n c r e a s e
rather
activity
the s a m p l e
of
the m a t t e r
titred
cytotoxic
immunologi-
to t h i s l i e s these
n o t f o u n d in
spontaneous
children
primary
reeven
cells,
sera with paternal
thought
no
aborters
enough,
they lympho-
have been
the c o m p l e m e n t - m e d i a t e d
! T h i s is p r e s e n t l y
and
b u t now s u f f e r
the h u s b a n d ' s
in
anti-
abortions
1983), and such absorptions
to
lymphocytes
been
by the s a m e m a n ) . O d d l y
than decrease
of
b u t i t is a l s o i m p o r t a n t
they are u s u a l l y
are c y t o t o x i c for
mating
studied
•'983b).
their husband's
c a n n o t be a b s o r b e d f r o m m a t e r n a l
of of
the
and
b u t are n o t u n c o m m o n in s e c o n d a r y
abortions
these a n t i b o d i e s
underlying
between
In the f i r s t i n s t a n c e ,
have had only
who
a n d i t is
be s o m e c a s e s
sharing
the
useful
the d y n a m i c s
been identified
thereof,
h a v e h a d one or m o r e
current spontaneous
sometimes
of
of
aborters
allied with
that there will
1983a and
was
(Hallo-
their problem,
they a b o r t ? The r e s p o n s e
and
there
1993). Regardless
women have very high
their antibodies.
( i . e . , w o m e n who
c h i l d r e n by
graft-
1981). These women have obviously so w h y do
b o d i e s are n o t a n t i - H L A , aborters
surpress
in which
considerations
a n t i b o d i e s w h i c h are o f t e n s p e c i f i c f o r (Faulk 4 Plclntyre,
histo-
thus f a r h a v e o n l y d e a l t w i t h
point o u t that some aborting
cally
and major
recurrent spontaneous
have already
complexes
t h a t HLfl is o n l y a
b a s i s for
genethat
transferred
inccmp atibility
t h e r e is no HLA
and s u c h c o u p l e s
for such
they s i g n i f i c a n t l y
complex
Another
c e l l s are
to t r a n s p l a n t s
w h i c h is m o r e
Indeed, simple
1983a).
incompatible minor
t9B 1 ; H a y e s & C l a m o n ,
Psnneko 4 Festenstein,
recurrent
the p o s s i b i l i t y
complex,
matched
from
known
cytotoxic
to be due
to
the
147 removal
of h i g h - a f f i n i t y
antibody
by a b s o r p t i o n w h i c h
ted the m o r e e f f i c i e n t c o m p l e m e n t f i x i n g c o m p e t i t i o n for
target sites and
Immunological
evidence
thereby
loui-affinity
anti-HLA
and
data.
t h a t the l y m p h o c y t o t o x i c
As d i s c u s s e d a b o v e ,
they c a n n o t be c o m p l e t e l y
secondary
aborters
tion with
the H L A - n e g a t i v e
can completely m o s t of
with
remove
completely
removed
monstrated
the s a m e
anti-trophoblast John Mclntyre that seminal
at Southern
that these absorptions
material
Ranta et al..
Illinois University
the s e r u m of
one
there
was
the
in S p r i n g f i e l d
again like
The i d e n t i f i c a t i o n of TLX a n t i g e n s
has
to TLX
shown
the
rabbit
reactive as
plasma
that
w i t h PP,_ from b
the
plasma
in s e m i n a l
s o u r c e of =>nt.ioenic e x o o s u r e
that this early s t i m u l a t i o n primes respond
Dr.
a c t i v i t y , anri
trophoblast cross
properties
de-
rabbit
In f a c t ,
a protein in seminal
be the i n i t i a l
ab-
preparations
that her anti-TLX
remove antibody
and immunological
t h a t this m a y
to s u b s e q u e n t l y
that
p l a s m a is n o t w i t h o u t p r e c e d e n t , i n a s m u c h
( 9 8 1 ) have identified
the w o m a n , a n d
amniochorion
indicating
cytotoxic antibodies
are s p n c i e s - s p e c i f i c ,
shares physicochemical
suggests
l a y e r of
activity,
e a r l i e r in this p a p e r .
1
human placenta.
absorp-
indicating
s e r a . The f i n d i n g of
in s e m i n a l
of
type of a l l o t y p i c v a r i a t i o n as d i d
sera discussed
not
the s e r a
a n d o n l y one of
the c y t o t o x i c i t y ,
are
However,
In a d d i t i o n ,
plasma but not sperm will
anti-trophoblast
antibodies
largely
from
cytotrophoblastic
ten d i f f e r e n t c h o r i o n s ,
antibodies comes
lymphocytes.
all l y m p h o c y t o t o x i c
aborter with husband-specific
sorbed with
these
absorbed
their husband's
the a n t i b o d i e s w e r e a n t i - T L X .
secondary
from
complement.
f o u n d i n the b l o o d of s o m e a b o r t i n g w o m e n are a n t i - T L X from s e r o l o g i c a l
libera-
antibody
antigens on
her i m m u n e
for
system
the s u r f a c e
of the
blasto-
regarding
w h y some
cyst. The q u e s t i o n h a s y e t to be a n s w e r e d orting women have antibodies b a s i s of r e p r o d u c t i v e
genic recognition. Whether but within several
to TLX
have been provided
Such antibodies
are usually
information
from c l i n i c a l
found in secondary
t e r s , a n d this c o u l d r e p r e s e n t a c o l l a p s e d
the
immunological
to be a f a i l u r e
this is an a n s w e r a b l e
the c o n t e x t of a v a i l a b l e
clues
antigens when
f a i l u r e is p u r p o r t e d
ab-
of
q u e s t i o n is it would
and basic
antidebatable,
appear
and not primary
or s h o r t e n e d
that
studies. abor-
time f r a m e
of
148 the n e g a t i v e
biological
performance
which
tive h i s t o r y , study
of HLA c o m p a t i b i l i t i e s
19P3).
s h o w n in the r e s u l t s
The o b s e r v a t i o n s
t h a t they are u s u a l l y
t h a t the n a t u r e of
restricted
the w o m e n ' s
t e r m i n e d by the m a n ' s
HLA
immune
tially appropriate
throughout pregnancy
clone
that was
a maternal
trophobias totoxic,
In c o n t r a s t , ternal
stimulation
to r e c o g n i z e
tainly
normal,
for
antigens
active
dren during
they o f t e n
aborters
down
suggests
presented
can c o n c e i v e
to b e g e t p r o g e n y . S u c h c l i n i c a l
to h e r T L X - c o m p a t i b l e from
compatibilities
she w o u l d
The a b o v e Taylor 4 Faulk latter group leukocytes phocytes
to TLX
receive
hypothesis
(19R1)
as w e l l
has e m p l o y e d
from
aborting
has now
unable
women's
HLA
cer-
plus
chil-
are
the bulk
prompted inertia
of
Faulk
to
by i m m u n i z i n g
respond
her
with
incompa-
would
elicit
the a l l o t y p i c
in-
"!981).
been successfully
tested
by
(1981), although
different approach
immunizations
de-
to
second,
they
(and thus T L X )
as by B e e r et a l . .
a conceptually
prob-
and
their
which
histories
by v i r t u e of
to be a s a t i s f a c t o r y
on
ma-
have had normal
(Faulk & M c l n t y r e ,
the f a t h e r . W h e t h e r
is g o i n g
measurable
that such immunizations
antigens
produ-
the c u r t a i n
abort during
c o u l d be o v e r c o m e
the i d e a b e i n g
response
particu-
T h e s e w o m e n are
and a n t i b o d i e s
erythrocyte-compatible,
tible l e u k o c y t e s , a protecting
mate
the
by a n o t h e r p a r t n e r
but only
r e s e a r c h on TLX
leukocytes
was
not without precedent
background
that a primary
HLA
ini-
stimulation
t h a t they are
and r e m a r r y f o l l o w i n g
antigens
that
de-
the
to them by t h e i r m a t e s ,
by m e n and w o m e n w h o
can divorce
to p r o p o s e
is
pregnancy.
again able
(19 01)
antigens
sex l i f e ,
of an i m m u n o l o g i c a l l y
their first m a r r i a g e s
and t h e s e p e o p l e
suggest
d r o v e o u t an a n t i b o d y
i n f a n t at t e r m . It is a l s o
l e a r n of s e c o n d m a r r i a g e s
ex-
aborters
response
antigenic
a b l y o n the b a s i s of a l l o t y p i c c o m p a t i b i l i t i e s .
liver a normal
reproduc-
Hutterite
could have been
bringing
of a s u c c e s s f u l
the lack
in p r i m a r y
the TLX
to TLX
primary
but with continuous
and a subsequently
the f u t u r e p o s s i b i l i t y
the
that such antibodies
aborter
lar c o m b i n a t i o n of HLA a n d TLX a n t i g e n s cing
reproductive
type w i t h w h i c h i t is p r e s e n t e d . T h u s
to p r o d u c e
protective,
of
to s e c o n d a r y
response
type of the m a l e p a r t n e r of a s e c o n d a r y
essentially
on
become more apparent late in a couple's
as f o r e x a m p l e
(Qber e t a l . .
i s t and
effects
by
with paternal
approach awaits
further
the
using lyminves-
149 tigation,
but Taylor 4 Faulk
unreported
groups
term b a b i e s
following
Taylor 4 Faulk
(1983)
as well
h a v e now d e l i v e r e d immunizations
(i903)
as s e v e r a l
with
have delivered
third party
n i n e o u t of
ers,
the o n e u n s u c c e s s f u l
case a b o r t e d a t the
only
appeared
at the
n o n e of bringing
therapy
abortions
or f e t u s
tenth week.
had a n y u n e x p e c t e d
some doubt into
spontaneous embryo
for
these infants
the h i t h e r t o
are d u e
o t h e r as
r e c u r r e n t a b o r t e r s of
leukocytes.
ten r e c u r r e n t
twelfth week,
to u n d e r l y i n g
abort-
having
It is n o t e w o r t h y
chromosomal
broadly
that
aberrations,
accepted idea
genetical
( B o u £ e t a l . . 1975; BouiS 4 B o u S ,
yet
normal,
that
d e f e c t s in
most the
1977).
References
flkle, G . A . ,
fldinolfi,
PI. , W e l s h , K . , L e i b o w i t z ,
Lancet 2 : 1003-1005
S. 4 M c C o l l ,
B a r d a u i l , W . R. 4 T o y , B . L . : A n n . N . Y . A c a d . S e i . 80 Barnstable,
stet. Gynec.
Boué,
: 197-267
C.a. 4 Bodmer, W.F.: Lancet I : 326-328
Beer, A.E., Quebbeman, 141
Boué, 0., Boué,
3.F.,
: 987-999
(1978).
12 : 11-26
(1975).
O b s t e t . B i o l . R e p r o d . 6: 5-21
The T r a n s m i s s i o n s
El se vier/l\lo rth H o l l a n d » B i o m e d i c a l Dallenbach-Hellweg, Berlin
of I m m u n i t y
from Mother
Press, Amsterdam
G.: Histopathology
Press,
of
to
Young.
(1970).
the E n d o m e t r i u m .
Springer-
(1971).
Faulk, W.P. 4 Temple,
A. N a t u r e
F a u l k , Id.P., S a n d e r s o n ,
262: 7 9 9 - 0 0 2
A. 4 T e m p l e ,
(1976).
A.: T r a n s p l a n t .
P r o c . 9:
1379-
(1977).
Faulk, U.P., Sei.
(1977).
(1970)
Brambell, F.W.R.:
1384
Ob-
(19B1).
A. 4 L a z a r , P . : T e r a t o l o g y
B o y d , 3 . D . 4 H a m i l t o n , W . O . : The H u m a n P l a c e n t a . M a c m i l l a n
Verlag,
(1959).
A y e r s , 3 . U I . 4 H a i n e s , R . R . : A m e r . J.
A. 4 B o u é , 3 . : 3. G y n e c o l .
London
I.:
(1981).
Temple,
(USA) 7 5 :
A.,- L o v i n s , R . 4 S m i t h ,
1947-1951
L'Académie
Acad.
(1978).
Faulk,W.P. 4 Johnson, P.m.: Recent Adv. Clin. Faulk, W.P.:
N.C.: Proc. Nat'l
Royale
Immunol.
de Flédécine de B e l g i q u e
2: 1-31 136:
(1980).
379-388
150 19 61. Faulk,W.P. 4 Mclntyre, 3.A.: Transplantation 32: 1-5 (19B1). Faulk, U.P., Hsi, B.-L., Mclntyre, 3. A., Yeh, C.-3. 4 Mucchielli, 3. Reprod. Fertil. (Suppl. 31) 18--199
(19B2).
Faulk, bJ.P. 4 Hsi, B.-L.: Biology of the Trophoblast. Whyte, A. eds) North Holland Press, Amsterdam
(Yoke, W. 4
(1983).
Faulk, U.P. 4 Mclntyre, 3.A.: Immunological Reviews Goodfellow,
A.
(in p r e s s ) ( 1 9 83).
P., Barnstable, C., Bodmer, U., Snary, D. 4 Crumpton,M.
Transplantation 22: 595-603
(1976).
Hallo-Penneko, 0. 4 Festenstein, H.: 3. Immunogenet. 8: 443-453(1981). Hamperl, H.: Klinische W o c h e n s c h r i f t 32: 665-668 Hayes, R. 4 Claman, H.: 3. Immunol. 130: 56-62
(1954).
(1983).
Hsi, R.-L., Yeh, C.-3. 4 Faulk, W.P.: Placenta 3: 1-12
(1982).
Hsi, B.-L.: Immunobiology of Human Amniochorion. Ph.D. Thesis, College Hospital Medical School, University of London Ikle, F.A.: Bull. Schweiz. Akad. Pled. Wiss. 20: 62-72
King's
(1983). (1964).
3ohnson, P.M. 4 Faulk, W.P.: In: 8. Boettcher (ed.) Immunological fluence on Human Fertility. Academic Press, New York, 161-169 3ohnson, P.M. 4 Brown, P.: Placenta 2: 355-37D
(1981).
Komlos, L., Zamir, R., 3oshua, H. 4 Halbrecht, I.: Clin. Immunopathol. 7: 330-335
Immunol.
(i977).
Lala, P.K., Chatterjee-Hasrouni, 15: 883-886
In-
(1977).
S. 4 Montgomery, B.:
Transplant.Proc.
(1983).
Matter, 3. 4 Faulk, U.P.: In: Hypertension in Pregnancy. Bonnar, 3., McGillivary, I. 4 Symonds, M. (eds.) MTP Press, Lancaster
357-369
(1980). Mclntyre, 3.A. 4 Faulk, W.P.: Placenta (Suppl. 4) 1-11 Mclntyre, 3.A. 4 Faulk, W.P.: Human Immunology 4: 27-36
(i982). (i9R2a).
Mclntyre, 3.A. 4 Faulk, U.P.: Prog. Clin. Biol. Res. 85A: 463-472 (1982b). Mclntyre, 3.A. 4 Faulk, W.P.: Amer. 3. Reprod. Immunol. ( in press) (i9R3a). Mclntyre, 3.A. 4 Faulk, W.P.: Trophoblast Research (in press)(1983b). Mowbray, 3.F., Gibbings, C.R., Sidgwick, A.S., Ruszkiewicz, M. 4 Beard, R.: Transplant. Proc. 15: 896-899
(19B3).
Ober, C.L., Martin, A.O., Simpson, 3.L., Hauck, UJ.U.f Amos, R.,
151
Kostyn, D., Fotino, M. & Allen, F.: flmer. J. Hum. Genet, (in press) (1983). Pijnenborg, R., Dixon, G., Robertson, Id, 4 Brosens, I.: Placenta 1: 3-19 (19B0). Pjinenborg, R., Bland, J.PI., Robertson, Id., Dixon, G. 4 Brosens, I.: Placenta 2: 303-316
(1981a).
Pjinenborg, R., Robertson, ' ., Brosens, I. 4 Dixon, G.: Placenta 2: 71-91
(1981b).
Ranta, T., Siiteri, R., Koistinen, R., Salem, H.T., Bohn, H., Koskimies, A. 4 Seppala, CI.: 3. Clin. Endocrinol. Metabol. 53: 10871095 (1981). Robertson, Id. 4 Warner, B. : J.Pathol. 112: 203-211
(1974).
Robertson, Ul., Brosens, I. & Dixon, G.: European J. Obstet. Gynecol. Reprod. Biol. 5: 47-65 (1975). Robertson, Id., Brosens, I. 4 Dixon, G.: In: van Assche, A. 4 Robertson, Id. (eds): Fetal Growth Retardation, Churchill Livingstone, London, 126-138 ( I98i). Rocklin, R., Kitzmiller, J. 4 Garroy, M.R.: Clin. Immunol. Immunopathol. 22: 305-315 (1982). Sunderland, C.A., Naiem, M., Mason, D.Y., Redman, C. 4 Stirrat, G.: 3. Reprod. Immunol. 3: 323-331 ( 19R1). Taylor, C. 4 Faulk, W.P.s Lancet 2: 6B-70
(19B1).
Taylor, C. 4 Faulk, Id.P.! Recurrent spontaneous abortions can be prevented by leukocyte transfusions.(Submitted for publication)(1983). Unander, 1*1. 4 Olding, L.: Amer. J.Reprod. Immunol, (in press)(19B3). Idood, G., Reynard, J., Knishnan, E. 4 Racela, L.: Cell. Immunol. 35: 191-204 (1978).
CHEMOTACTIC FACTORS
Herbert Reynolds
IN T H E A I R S P A C E S T H A T M A Y M O D U L A T E
INFLAMMATION
M.D.,
Pulmonary sections, Yale University School of 333 Cedar Street P.O. Box 3333 New Haven Connecticut 06510 USA
Catherine Roth-Fouret,
Medicine,
M.D.
Laënnec Hospital, 42, r u e de S è v r e s 75340 PARIS Cedex 07
1.
Introduction.
The c a p a c i t y to d e v e l o p a s e l e c t i v e
i n f l a m m a t o r y r e a c t i o n in l u n g
tissue
is p a r t o f t h e h o s t ' s o v e r a l l r e s p i r a t o r y t r a c t d e f e n s e s y s t e m a n d augment local cellular and humoral factors
in the a i r s p a c e s t h a t
ly c a n c l e a r o r i n a c t i v a t e p a r t i c l e s a n d m i c r o - o r g a n i s m s rated into the lungs
cipally polymorphonuclear neutrophils
i n s p i r e d or
(PMNs), a n d f l u i d c o m p o n e n t s
I n f l a m m a t i o n m a y b e g i n in s e v e r a l d i f f e r e n t w a y s , a s
f r o m t h e r e s p i r a t o r y t r a c t to p r e s e r v e h e a l t h ,
a r e a m o n g the m o s t c o m m o n o f f e n d e r s ,
prin-
from of
illustra-
alveolar-
surface. Many foreign particles and noxious substances must
removed daily
aspi-
is i n i t i a t e d a n d m o d u l a t e d f r o m t h e a i r s i d e
t e d in t h e f i g u r e , b u t u l t i m a t e l y a f f e c t s all l a y e r s o f t h e capillary
ordinari-
(1, 2). T h i s r e a c t i o n in w h i c h p h a g o c y t i c c e l l s ,
plasma enter the airspaces the lungs.
can
and
so t h e y p r o v i d e a c o n v e n i e n t
be
bacteria example.
A c k n o w l e d g e m e n t s . T h i s r e s e a r c h w a s s u p p o r t e d in p a r t b y G R A N T f r o m H L B I , N I H , B e t h e s d a , M a r y l a n d a n d by a r e s e a r c h f e l l o w s h i p f o r D r R e y n o l d s f r o m t h e I n s t i t u t N a t i o n a l de l a S a n t é e t de l a R e c h e r c h e M é d i c a l e , L a ë n n e c Hospital (UNITE 214), PARIS.
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in G e r m a n y
154 Bacteria, gram positive and gram negative species with aerobic or bic metabolism,
reside
in the n a s o - o r o p h a r y n x
anaero-
and can be aspirated
the airways or entrained with inspired air and airbourne
i n t o the
M o s t w i l l a d h e r e o r i m p a c t o n the a i r w a y m u c o s a a n d m u c o - c i l i a r y r e m o v e s t h e m , b u t s o m e r e a c h the a l v e o l a r s u r f a c e w h e r e m o b i l e
lungs. clearance
macrophages
ingest them and presumably kill or contain them. After deposition micro-organisms
or p a r t i c l e s o n t h e a l v e o l a r s u r f a c e ,
c r o p h a g e s p r o c e e d s q u i c k l y a n d is q u a n t i t a t i v e l y iary inflammatory or particularly
r e a c t i o n is u s u a l l y n e e d e d .
virulent,
and a more general
almost complete.
If the inoculum
then local alveolar mechanisms may not
may generate other chemotactic systems
is
inflammatory reaction must be generated. This
factors from macrophages,
of
p h a g o c y t o s i s by
c a n p r o c e e d in a t l e a s t t h r e e w a y s , w h i c h w e w i l l r e v i e w chemotactic
into
No
suffice reaction
: liberation
factors, and mobilization of other
s e c r e t e d by in v i t r o c u l t u r e d r e s p i r a t o r y c e l l s m a y b e c o m e
lung diseases
b r o s i s a n d s a r c o i d o s i s w i l l be
2. A l v e o l a r m a c r o p h a g e
; their status
mediator
important
in
(BAL) to a v a r i e t y
in i d i o p a t h i c p u l m o n a r y
fi-
chemotaxins.
occur after manipulating
in n o r m a l , n o n - i n f e c t e d a i r w a y s
the r e s p i r a t o r y t r a c t b y b r o n c h o s c o p y
(5). In m o n k e y s r e p e a t e d l a v a g e s
(4)
analysis of this fluid, two substances were
caused potent, directed migration of PMNs
area
(5).
From
identified
that
(into a m i c r o p o r e f i l t e r in B o y -
den chambers). One substance was a fragment of the fifth component of plement
(Cca) which was about 15,000 daltons molecular weight and
5 , 0 0 0 d) w a s n o t e d to be s e c r e t e d by n o r m a l m o n k e y a l v e o l a r
stimuli
intratracheal
injection of h e a t killed S t a p h y l o c o c c u s
(about
macrophages,
i n c u l t u r e b u t in e n h a n c e d a m o u n t s a f t e r v a r i o u s
( T a b l e 1). A l v e o l a r m a c r o p h a g e s f r o m g u i n e a p i g s ,
com-
promoted
m i g r a t i o n of m o n o c y t e s as well as PMNs. The other smaller s u b s t a n c e
spontaneously
will
and
in t h e s a m e a n a t o m i c a l
o f the l u n g , c a u s e d a s t r i k i n g r e c o v e r y o f P M N 1 s in l a v a g e f l u i d immunochemical
or
discussed.
An accumulation of inflammatory cells
lung lavage
lavage
of
that
(3). D e t e c t i o n o f p h l o g i s t i c f a c t o r s p r e s e n t in l u n g f l u i d s
of inflammatory
auxil-
large
complement pathway activation
the diagnostic application of broncho-alveolar
ma-
phagocytic
in s i t u a f t e r
aureus or in
an
cultu-
155 re, also secreted a rather similar, small molecular size chemotactic factor (6). This factor when purified and reinstilled into the
airways, pro-
duced a PMN exudate without alveolar hemorrhage. It is important to note that the macrophage derived chemotactic factor elicited a PMN response in the absence of erythrocyte leakage which may distinguish its biologic activity from some other inflammatory mediators, preformed immune complexes or active C,_a, that cause appreciable hemorrhagic injury to the alveolar5 capillary membrane when instilled in the airways.
COMPARISON OF ALVEOLAR MACROPHAGE DERIVED FACTORS
Origin
Monkey
Size
(5)
Stability
5,000 daltons
Characteristics
Heat labile
Attracted PMN3 but not monocytes or eosinophils
Guinea pig (6)
1,500 daltons
Heat stable
Generated after in vivo phagocytosis, had in
(600 d)
vivo chemotactic activity
Human
(7,8,9)
8,500
daltons
Sensitive to
PMNs attracted by PI
trypsin and
5.0 peak
heat stable
C1,000
daltons
(600 d)
Resistant to
PMNs attracted in prefe-
trypsin and
rence to monocytes and
proteases, h e a t
eosinophils
and pH stable
release of elastase and
; promoted
lysozyme from PMNs
Sensitive to serum PI 7.6 and 5.2, in part chemotactic inhibitor
factor lipid, but not HETE includes LTB„ 4
156 Human alveolar macrophages also produce chemotactic t i a l l y a t t r a c t PMfos. M e r r i l l a n d C o l l e a g u e s cells by b r o n c h o a l v e o l a r
(7) o b t a i n e d
( > 9 0 %) o f m a c r o p h a g e s .
preferen-
respiratory
lavage of normal smoker and n o n s m o k e r
which consisted principally in vitro culture,
factors that
volunteers,
After adherence
s u p e r n a t a n t f l u i d f r o m the c e l l s h a d
a c t i v i t y , b u t the l e v e l o f a c t i v i t y w a s v e r y d e p e n d e n t o n c e r t a i n manipulations.
The stimulus of cell adherence
chemotactic activity which was detectable
and
chemoattractant cellular
itself provoked release
in s u p e r n a t a n t f l u i d
specimens
a t 6 a n d 24 h o u r s , w h e r e a s s t i m u l a t i o n w i t h a n I g G o p s o n i n o r i m m u n e plex produced a maximal response within 3 hours. Tumbling the cells prevent adherence greatly
d i m i n i s h e d the o u t p u t o f c h e m o t a c t i c
of
comto
activity
f o r up to 22 h o u r s . C e l l s u p e r n a t a n t f l u i d w a s g e l c h r o m a t o g r a p h i e d to solate active chemotactic macrophage cultures guished by size,
components
for f u r t h e r c h a r a c t e r i z a t i o n .
The
(> 97%) produced two substances w h i c h c o u l d be
about 8,500 d and about 1,000 d on calibrated
G - 5 0 S F g e l c o l u m n s , a n d by p h y s i c a l c h a r a c t e r i s t i c s . p r o v e d to be c o m p l e x w h e n s e p a r a t e d b y i s o e l e c t r i c
distin-
Sephadex
The larger
focusing
substance
into a t
5 p e a k s b u t c h e m o a t t r a c t a n t a c t i v i t y w a s c o n f i n e d to j u s t o n e p e a k a p i o f 5.0. The s m a l l f a c t o r w a s n o t a n a l y z e d in d e t a i l b u t its release
into macrophage
c e l l s u p e r n a t a n t w a s d e c r e a s e d w h e n the
early lipoxyge-
A number of
genase products have chemoattractant activity
12-hydroxy
10, 1 4 - E i c o s t e t r a e n o i c
acid
(HETE) a n d l e u k o t r i e n e
duced by s t i m u l a t e d alveolar m a c r o p h a g e s Hunninghake
and colleagues
LTB^
; b o t h c a n be
(9) a l s o f o u n d t h a t a l v e o l a r m a c r o p h a g e s its
as a small 400-600 daltons sized factor. Although adherent, but
from source
activity stimuli
t h i s a c t i v i t y to be p r e s e n t a f t e r 3 h r . P a r t i c u l a r l y
tent were opsonized bacteria and IgG immune complexes
; selective
tion of c o m p l e m e n t r e c e p t o r s on m a c r o p h a g e s was n o t an effective A c t i v e c e l l c u l t u r e s u p e r n a t a n t s w e r e f r a c t i o n a t e d to i s o l a t e t h e t i c a c t i v i t y w h i c h r e s i d e d in a s m a l l s i z e f a c t o r . A s c o n t r a s t e d 1, it h a s d i f f e r e n t p r o p e r t i e s
po-
stimulamethod. chemotacin
Table
f r o m the l a r g e r m a c r o p h a g e c h e m o t a x i n .
partial extraction with organic solvents,
pro-
otherwise
cells would produce maximal amounts of c h e m o t a c t i c
i n s u p e r n a t a n t f l u i d a f t e r 18 h r o f c u l t u r e , v a r i o u s p h a g o c y t i c would accelerate
lipoxy5, 8,
(8).
nonsmoker normals produced chemotactic activity and identified
unstimulated,
least with
nase pathway of p r o s t a g l a n d i n metabolism was inhibited. including
i-
indicated that this factor
Its was
157 in part lipid and a lipogenase pathway
substance.
AIRWAY-ALVEOLAR SURFACE
CAPILLARY-ENDOTHELIAL SURFACE In s u m m a r y
( F i g u r e 1), v a r i o u s p a r t i c l e s a n d m i c r o - o r g a n i s m s
sited on the alveolar surface where they are scavenged cytic macrophages
can be
depo-
e f f i c i e n t l y by
a n d d e g r a d e d o r c l e a r e d by t h e s e c e l l s . H o w e v e r ,
phago-
macro-
p h a g e s are capable of secreting at least two factors that can produce
di-
rected migration of auxiliary phagocytes, principally PMNs. Although
much
o f the e x p e r i m e n t a l w o r k h a s b e e n d o n e w i t h in v i t r o c u l t u r e d c e l l s ,
the
chemotactic
factors when purified and instilled intratracheally
to h a v e b i o l o g i c a c t i v i t y a n d p r o d u c e a P M N - E x u d a t e
do
seem
without hemorrhage.
s e e m s p l a u s i b l e t h a t a l v e o l a r m a c r o p h a g e s c a n i n i t i a t e the i n f l u x o f into airspaces through liberation As y e t uninvestigated,
(by a c t i v e s e c r e t i o n )
of
chemotaxins.
a r e t h e i r m e c h a n i s m s o f a c t i o n to a l t e r
t y o f the a l v e o l a r e p i t h e l i u m o r i n t r a c e l l u l a r j u n c t i o n s a n d (membrane solubility) barrier.
permeabili-
diffusability
through layers of the a l v e o l a r - c a p i l l a r y
membraneous
A n i m p o r t a n t p o i n t o f a c t i o n w o u l d be o n the c a p i l l a r y
l i u m w h e r e c i r c u l a t i n g P M N s in the v a s c u l a t u r e
It
PMNS
are a t t r a c t e d f o r
endothesticking
158
(margination)
and cell polarization as a prelude for migration into
extravascular
location.
3. C o m p l e m e n t - d e r i v e d
an
chemotaxins.
The r o l e o f the c o m p l e m e n t s y s t e m
in h o s t d e f e n s e o f the a i r w a y s a n d
lar surface remains controversial.
P r o p e r d i n F a c t o r B (10) a n d a
of other complement components have been identified
alveo-
number
in lung lavage
fluids
(11) w h i c h s u p p o r t t h e c o n c e p t t h a t a l t e r n a t e p a t h w a y a c t i v a t i o n m a y i m p o r t a n t in t h e l u n g
( R e v i e w e d in R e f e r e n c e 2). I n t e r e s t f o c u s e s
ly o n C,_a a n d C^_a d e s arg, c o n s i d e r e d to be t h e m o s t p o t e n t mediators and chemotactic molecules
primari-
inflammatory
liberated by the c o m p l e m e n t
cascades.
T h e s e are c a p a b l e by t h e m s e l v e s o f c a u s i n g a c u t e a i r w a y h e m o r r h a g e exudation after of alternative
intratracheal
instillation
(12, 1 3 ) . If d i r e c t
complement pathway actually occurs
be
and
activation
in the a i r w a y s ,
then
i t is r e a s o n a b l e to p o s t u l a t e t h a t a v a r i e t y o f i n h a l e d o r a s p i r a t e d c l e s a n d m i c r o b e s t h a t g a i n a c c e s s to the r e s p i r a t o r y
tree can
parti-
trigger
the complement cascade
(C„ a n d C,_ p l u s o t h e r i n t e r m e d i a t e c o m p o n e n t s like o 5 t h e t r i m o l e c u l a r c o m p l e x C,._„ c o u l d b e l i b e r a t e d a n d p r o d u c e a n u m b e r o f 567 f r a g m e n t s w i t h c h e m o a t t r a c t a n t properties). Q u a n t i t a t i v e l y , derivatives 5 s e e m to b e the m o s t e f f e c t i v e a n d p o t e n t o f the c o m p l e m e n t g r o u p . A potential
complement derived chemotactic
factor,
s u c h a s C a, m i g h t 5
be
g e n e r a t e d through a c t i v a t i o n of the c o m p l e m e n t system or e x i s t as a
prefor-
med component
for
in l u n g f l u i d . T h e s i t u a t i o n
is n o t c l e a r a t p r e s e n t ,
s o m e o f the c o n f l i c t i n g r e s u l t s h a v e b e e n p r e s e n t e d o n l y form.
In n o n h u m a n p r i m a t e s
identified whereas,
in
preliminary
( b a b o o n s ) , C,_ w i t h f u n c t i o n a l a c t i v i t y b
in g e n e r o u s a m o u n t s
in c o n c e n t r a t e d l u n g l a v a g e f l u i d
in l a v a g e f l u i d f r o m n o r m a l n o n s m o k e r s ,
c a n be (14) ;
it is n o t p r o m i n e n t
(15).
M a c r o p h a g e s can secrete a number of c o m p l e m e n t components w h i c h c o u l d
pro-
v i d e a l o c a l s u p p l y w i t h i n the a i r s p a c e s .
com-
Two s t u d i e s t h a t i d e n t i f i e d
p l e m e n t c o m p o n e n t s s e c r e t e d by h u m a n alveolar m a c r o p h a g e s found different components
in c u l t u r e
: in o n e C„ a n d C w e r e d e t e c t e d 3 b
o t h e r n o t e d C^ a n d F a c t o r B a n d o c c a s i o n a l l y
C^
(16)
fluid
; the
(17).
T h e n e c e s s i t y o f h a v i n g a n i n t a c t c o m p l e m e n t s y s t e m to c l e a r b a c t e r i a
depo-
s i t e d in t h e a i r s p a c e s
of
is n o t w e l l e s t a b l i s h e d e i t h e r . W h e n a v a r i e t y
159 gram positive and gram negative bacteria were aerosolized
i n t o the
lungs
of mice, previously d e p l e t e d of c o m p l e m e n t activity by COBRA Venom ment or intact normal controls,
the c l e a r a n c e o f
was impaired about 25 per cent versus controls, proliferation quently,
Streptococcus and Pseudomonas
i n t h i s l u n g m o d e l w a s l e s s t h a n in c o n t r o l s
treat-
pneumoniae aeruginosa
(18).
Subse-
stronger evidence has been provided that Pseudomonas clearance
better w i t h an intact complement system
(19). O b v i o u s l y , m o r e r e s e a r c h
is is
n e e d e d to u n d e r s t a n d the r e l a t i o n o f the c o m p l e m e n t s y s t e m a n d l u n g h o s t d e f e n s e , b e f o r e a t t e m p t s a r e m a d e to m a n i p u l a t e c o m p l e m e n t - m e d i a t e d mation or opsonic phagocytosis
w a y s o r i n h i b i t i o n o f the a c t i v i t y o f i n d i v i d u a l
4. O t h e r i n f l a m m a t o r y o r c h e m o t a c t i c
As i l l u s t r a t e d
in F i g u r e
(20),
mediators.
triggered
i n c l u d i n g the c l a s s i c a l p a t h w a y
intrinsic coagulation,
fibrinolysis and kinin
It is n o t e s t a b l i s h e d t h a t H a g e m a n F a c t o r c o m p o n e n t o f the a i r s p a c e
(Factor XII)
is a n
lining fluid, nor that potential
these enzymatic systems must depend on this molecule.
important
is e s t a b l i s h e d
in the a i r s p a c e s ,
b e the r o l e o f m a c r o p h a g e c h e m o t a c t i c f a c t o r s o r c o m p l e m e n t .
may
perhaps
it a s m a y Protease
m e s t h a t c a n be r e l e a s e d by P M N s a n d f r o m p u r i f i e d l u n g m a s t c e l l s
the dependent systems.
enzy-
can
for triggering some
of
T h i s s e e m s to be t h e c a s e in a d u l t r e s p i r a t o r y
tress syndrome where a PMN inflammatory reaction can develop p a n i e d by p r o t e o l y t i c a c t i v i t y
in l u n g s e c r e t i o n s
in lung
(21) a n d l u n g
fluid that can cleave Hageman Factor, prekallikrein,
plasminogen,
(22). R e l e v a n t
our review are the various intermediate
factors that may have
include plasminogen activator and kallikrein,
kinin which has vasopermeability
activity
and could contribute
disaccom-
lavage
molecular weight kininogen and complement components
activity. These
a
contribute
to p e r p e t u a t e o r a u g m e n t the r e a c t i o n r a t h e r t h a n to i n i t i a t e
a c t i v a t e H a g e m a n F a c t o r a n d c o u l d be a m e c h a n i s m
of
It is, i n s t e a d ,
p r o d u c t s to the i n f l a m m a t o r y r e a c t i o n . A c t i v a t i o n o f t h e s e s y s t e m s inflammation
of
formation.
activation
c o n v e n i e n t w a y to g r o u p a n u m b e r o f r e l a t e d s y s t e m s t h a t m a y
be important once
path-
components.
1, a n u m b e r o f i m p o r t a n t s y s t e m s c a n b e
by the a c t i v a t i o n of H a g e m a n Factor complement
inflam-
through suppression of the complement
high to
chemotactic and
brady
to the
lea-
160 k a g e o f p l a s m a a c r o s s the c a p i l l a r y - a l v e o l a r t o r is o f s p e c i a l
interest because
membrane. Plasminogen
it c a n be g e n e r a t e d by
o r c a n be s e c r e t e d by a l v e o l a r m a c r o p h a g e s a n d , t h e r e f o r e , different
activa-
fibrinolysis could arise
in
ways.
The interaction between various Hageman Factor dependent pathways and p l e m e n t i n the a i r w a y s
is l a r g e l y a n u n e x p l o r e d n e t w o r k
i m p o r t a n t in i n i t i a t i n g o r e s t a b l i s h i n g
t h a t is
involved,
s i u m , a n d the o v e r a l l b i o l o g i c s i g n i f i c a n c e o f
in w h i c h c h e m o t a c t i c
fluids or cell culture
in t h i s
fibrosis
tic factor might participate
f a c t o r s m a y b e f o u n d in l u n g
(IPF).
in the i n f l a m m a t o r y r e a c t i o n
and colleagues
chemotac-
in h u m a n
(23) s o u g h t e v i d e n c e o f
lung
chemotaxin
s e c r e t i o n by a l v e o l a r c e l l s l a v a g e d f r o m p a t i e n t s w i t h I P F . T h i s w a s r e l e v a n t d i s e a s e to s t u d y b e c a u s e a l o w - g r a d e a l v e o l a r often present, especially sis of bronchoalveolar among the respiratory
Sympo-
them.
the concept that an alveolar m a c r o p h a g e - d e r i v e d
diseases, Hunninghake
re-
of
media.
a. I d i o p a t h i c p u l m o n a r y To s u b s t a n t i a t e
more
the i m p o r t a n c e
o t h e r a c u t e p h a s e r e a c t a n t s , d i s c u s s e d by o t h e r p a r t i c i p a n t s
5. E x a m p l e s o f D i s e a s e s
probably
inflammation. Obviously,
s e a r c h is n e e d e d to u n r a v e l t h e c o m p o n e n t s
com-
inflammation
in a n e a r l y , c e l l u l a r s t a g e o f d i s e a s e .
lavage fluid from IPF patients
that
PMNs
( m e a n a b o u t 30 %, 5 to 8 0 r a n g e
o f the c e l l s . A s m a l l p e r c e n t a g e o f e o s i n o p h i l s
is
Analy-
(11) r e v e a l e d
cells retrieved from untreated patients,
ted for a consistent percentage
a
accoun-
observed)
( a b o u t 4 %) a l s o w a s
cha-
racteristic . A g r o u p o f 1 5 p a t i e n t s w i t h IPF, c o n s i d e r e d to be in m i d s t a g e o f disease, were investigated derived chemotactic
for p o s s i b l e secretion of a l v e o l a r
macrophage-
factor and compared with 8 nonsmoker normal
(23). A f t e r B A L to r e t r i e v e r e s p i r a t o r y c e l l s f r o m b o t h g r o u p s , w e r e s u b m i t t e d to H y p a q u e - F i c o l l
their
volunteers the
the purified mononuclear cells, principally alveolar macrophages, cultured for 3 h after w h i c h supernatant fluids were h a r v e s t e d a n d ted for chemotactic cultures
cells
d e n s i t y c e n t r i f u g a t i o n to r e m o v e P M N s ;
a c t i v i t y . V a r i o u s s t i m u l i w e r e g i v e n to the
were evalua-
macrophage
in the f o r m o f c o n c e n t r a t e d B A L f l u i d f r o m I P F p a t i e n t s ,
Sepharo-
161 se 4B b e a d s , a n d I g G c o a t e d ox e r y t h r o c y t e s . R e s u l t s o f r e s p i r a t o r y
diffe-
r e n t i a l c e l l c o u n t s in t h e p a t i e n t s s h o w e d t h a t 9 o f 15 h a d g r e a t e r
than
10 % P M N s a m o n g t h e c e l l s
(approximately
t i e n t s h a d l e s s t h a n 10 %
; the n o r m a l n o n s m o k e r s d i d n o t h a v e P M N s .
in culture,
3 5 % ) , a n d t h a t the o t h e r
pa-
m a c r o p h a g e s f r o m I P F p a t i e n t s w i t h > 1 0 % P M N s in t h e i r
nal m i x t u r e of lavage cells spontaneously
released chemotactic
Once
origi-
activity
i n t o t h e c u l t u r e m e d i u m , w h e r e a s c e l l s f r o m t h o s e w i t h f e w e r t h a n 10 % PMNs generally
did not release activity, nor did the cells from
nonsmo-
kers. The IPF macrophages generated large amounts of chemotactic quickly
(by 3 h )
; when this activity was localized
( S e p h a d e x G - 2 5 g e l ) o f the s u p e r n a t a n t f l u i d ,
in the
activity
chromatogram
it w a s f o u n d in the 4 0 0
6 0 0 m o l e c u l a r w e i g h t r a n g e f r a c t i o n s e l u t e d f r o m the c a l i b r a t e d
to
column.
Further analysis of this material showed preferential chemoattractant vity for PMNs compared w i t h b l o o d monocytes, and this activity was extractable with organic solvents, n e n t to b e p r e s e n t .
largely
indicating a significant lipid
compo-
I g G i m m u n e c o m p l e x e s w e r e c o n s i d e r e d to be a n
impor-
t a n t stimulus for p r o d u c t i o n of this c h e m o t a c t i c ke a n d c o l l e a g u e s s u c c e e d e d lar weight, partially
factor. Thus,
Hunningha-
i n i d e n t i f y i n g the s a m e k i n d o f s m a l l
lipid-containing chemotactic
viously found from normal alveolar macrophages that a chemotactic
acti-
molecu-
factor they had
(9). T h i s s t u d y
pre-
indicated
factor was released from alveolar m a c r o p h a g e s of
pa-
t i e n t s w i t h I P F w h o w e r e in a n a c t i v e p h a s e o f a l v e o l i t i s w i t h P M N s
pre-
s e n t in b r o n c h o a l v e o l a r
l a v a g e f l u i d . I g G i m m u n e c o m p l e x e s a p p e a r to be
an important macrophage
stimulus.
Thus an endogenous,
airside
c a n b e r e l e a s e d q u i c k l y w i t h i n a few h o u r s a n d t h i s c a p a b i l i t y w i t h an e l e v a t e d PMN count
b.
( > 1 0 % respiratory
correlates
cells).
Sarcoidosis.
Sarcoidosis teristically
is a c o m m o n , m u l t i s y s t e m d i s e a s e o f u n k n o w n c a u s e t h a t
charac-
produces non-caseating epithelial-giant cell granulomas
a f f e c t e d t i s s u e . A l t h o u g h the r e s p i r a t o r y t r a c t is i n v o l v e d tients,
chemotaxin
pulmonary sarcoidosis
majority of them. However, is p r o g r e s s i v e
in m o s t
is u s u a l l y s e l f - l i m i t e d o r r e s o l v e s
i n a b o u t 2 0 p e r c e n t , the p u l m o n a r y
a n d c a n l e a d to a c h r o n i c s t a g e o f i n t e r s t i t i a l
and cystic airspace degeneration.
in pa-
in t h e
disease fibrosis
In recent onset or intermediate
stages
162 of lung disease,
the histologic response
lar i n f i l t r a t i o n w i t h l y m p h o c y t e s , in interstitial
tissue, bronchial
in t i s s u e
is a m i x t u r e
primarily, and granuloma and vascular structures.
of
alveo-
distributed Sampling
the
airspaces w i t h lung lavage yields an increased n u m b e r of r e s p i r a t o r y with many macrophages and a striking increase, usually,
in
(24). T h i s s a m p l e o f a i r s p a c e o r a l v e o l a r l u m i n a l c o n t e n t s a preponderance
of T-lymphocytes
is n o t a b l e
in w h i c h the s u b p o p u l a t i o n o f
c e l l s c a n b e i n c r e a s e d in v e r y a c t i v e p h a s e s o f a l v e o l i t i s not prominent
cells
lymphocytes for
T-Helper
(25). P M N s
are
in l a v a g e c e l l s r e t r i e v e d f r o m e a r l y a n d a c t i v e p h a s e s ,
but
w i t h p r o l o n g e d d i s e a s e a s s o c i a t e d w i t h f i b r o s i s , P M N s c a n be i n c r e a s e d l a v a g e f l u i d in s o m e p a t i e n t s
(26). C l i n i c a l l y ,
it w o u l d be d e s i r a b l e
have some marker that might distinguish those patients who will have gressive disease. Moreover, excessive,
P M N s in t h e a i r w a y s c o u l d be a s s o c i a t e d
local concentrations
of p r o t e o l y t i c enzymes and
which could foster the fibrotic process. tic substances litis,
in a m a n n e r a n a l o g o u s to I P F p a t i e n t s
From the clinical
s i s as p a r t o f d i a g n o s t i c including
evaluation
inflammatory
(n = 5), a n d l o n g d u r a t i o n d i s e a s e
sarcoi-
and lung lavage for cellular
(n = 5), r e c e n t o n s e t
(n = 4 ) , r e c e n t o n s e t b u t o n t r e a t m e n t w i t h
fluid and respiratory
(i* 2 y r )
disease
corticosteroids
(n = 5). T h e a c e l l u l a r
lavage (direc-
ted m i g r a t i o n of b l o o d PMNs) u s i n g a leading front m i g r a t i o n assay (7). C e l l s w e r e f r a c t i o n a t e d b y
tion o n discontinuous albumin-density tes from macrophages
density
to s e p a r a t e
( w i t h a b o u t 90 p e r c e n t e f f e c t i v e n e s s )
te a l v e o l a r m a c r o p h a g e s dient
gradients
in
centrifuga-
lung
lymphocy-
and to
separa-
i n t o s e v e r a l p o p u l a t i o n s a c c o r d i n g to s i z e a n d g r a -
(28). M a c r o p h a g e s w e r e e s t a b l i s h e d
t e d f o r 6 a n d 16 h o u r s to o b s e r v e tances into cell supernatant, lenge with zymosan.
analy-
defined
cells were assessed for chemotactic activity
blind well diffusion chambers
alveo-
(23).
(24, 2 7 ) . S e v e r a l g r o u p s w e r e
: normal non smoker volunteers
(«5;6 m o n t h s )
chemotac-
service at Laennec Hospital, patients w i t h lung
dosis underwent fiberoptic bronchoscopy
prowith
inflammation
T h i s l e d u s to l o o k f o r
in l u n g f l u i d t h a t m i g h t be s t i m u l a t i n g
in c u l t u r e a n d
incuba-
s p o n t a n e o u s release of c h e m o t a c t i c
subs-
and t h e r e a f t e r s t i m u l a t e d by p h a g o c y t i c
Lung lavage fluid and cell culture supernatants
(organic solvent)
Results are summarized.
elution
chal-
were
gel filtered through calibrated columns or chromatographied w i t h high sure liquid
in to
pres-
gradients.
Bronchoalveolar
lavage fluids, with cells
removed
163 by centrifugation,
and concentrated at 4° C with an Amicon UM-05
h a d no detectable chemotactic activity for PMNs, except several
membrane, specimens
from long duration sarcoidosis patients. W h e n these active BAL fluid ples were chromatographied vity monitored
sam-
through Sephacryl G-300 SF and chemotactic
in t h e e l u a n t f r a c t i o n s ,
it w a s o n l y d e t e c t a b l e
tions that eluted at about 95 per cent of gel bed volume,
in
acti-
frac-
corresponding
to a s m a l l m o l e c u l e o f s e v e r a l t h o u s a n d d a l t o n s s i z e . T h i s r e a s o n a b l y cluded several other possible chemotactic C^a 5
(15,000 d), neutrophil chemotactic
or lipopolysaccharide
(endotoxin)
factors of larger size
factor of asthma
percentages patients
flect an elevated For macrophages
However,
the
perPMNs
so t h e p r e s e n c e o f c h e m o t a c t i c a c t i v i t y d i d n o t
in c u l t u r e , n o r m a l c e l l s d i d n o t s p o n t a n e o u s l y Macrophages
secrete from
onset sarcoid patients and those receiving corticosteroid therapy did not spontaneously
lation w i t h zymosan did n o t induce activity either.
recent
also
make chemotactic activity, but, surprisingly,
these cells were unresponsive,
It is u n c e r t a i n
stimuwhy
f o r s a r c o i d m a c r o p h a g e s are g e n e r a l l y
In c o n t r a s t m a c r o p h a g e s f r o m l o n g d u r a t i o n p a t i e n t s
were spontaneously
re-
count.
c h e m o t a c t i c a c t i v i t y , b u t d i d so w i t h s t i m u l a t i o n .
make
(29)
in t h e r e s p i r a t o r y c e l l c o u n t s w e r e n o t v e r y e l e v a t e d in t h e s e
(up to 4 % ) ,
vated cells.
including
( 6 0 0 , 0 0 0 d)
from contaminating bacteria added
h a p s f r o m the t r a n s n a s a l p a s s a g e o f the b r o n c h o s c o p e .
ex-
secreting activity or could
acti-
either
be readily stimulated
to
it.
Cell supernatants were collected from active macrophage cultures, w i t h o u t c o n c e n t r a t i o n o r e x p o s u r e to f r e e z i n g t e m p e r a t u r e w e r e to a calibrated Sephadex G - 2 5 SF column and gel filtered with buffered saline, pH 7.2. Chemotactic activity
and
applied phosphate
f o r P M N s w a s a s s a y e d in the
e f f l u e n t c o l u m n fractions and two peak areas of activity were one centered about 50-60 per cent of gel bed elution volume,
identified corresponding
to a 5,000 daltons marker protein, and another peak about 90 per cent
elu-
tion volume which was less than 1,000 daltons size. This pattern of
chemo-
tactic activity
cells
in m a c r o p h a g e
that were spontaneously
supernatants was the same for sarcoid
s e c r e t i n g a n d f o r t h o s e s t i m u l a t e d to s e c r e t e
m o t a c t i c a c t i v i t y . A n a l y s i s o f the a c t i v e c o m p o n e n t s ve p e a k s
in t h e s e t w o
respecti-
is in p r o g r e s s a n d r e q u i r i n g u s e o f u l t r a s e p a r a t i o n m e t h o d s .
expect the larger size chemotactic
che-
f a c t o r to be a c o m p l e x m i x t u r e o f
We pro-
164
t e i n s as w a s f o u n d by M e r r i l l a n d c o l l e a g u e s
(7) w h e n a s i m i l a r s i z e
fac-
t o r w a s s u b m i t t e d to i s o e l e c t r i c f o c u s i n g s e p a r a t i o n . W i t h t h e r e c e n t
inte-
r e s t in a r a c h i d o n i c a c i d m e t a b o l i t e s p r o d u c e d by a l v e o l a r m a c r o p h a g e s
(7,
8, 9, 30, 3 1 ) , a n a l y s i s o f t h e s m a l l e r c h e m o t a c t i c
factor has
t a k e n t h i s d i r e c t i o n , w i t h t h e c o l l a b o r a t i o n o f B. A r n o u x
ry b i o l o g i c a l c h a r a c t e r i z a t i o n h a s n o t detected any p l a t e l e t factor or slow reacting substance of anaphylaxis. been extracted
Prelimina-
aggregation
When the substance
u s i n g a m e t h a n o l gradient a c o m p l e x e l u t i o n
15 d i s t i n c t p e a k s e m e r g e s
; chemotactic
is p r e s e n t i n a t l e a s t t h r e e o f the peaks. L e u k o t r i e n e one, but other leukotrienes,
activity L T B ^ is
for
from the
active sarcoid macrophages than was found with calcium tion of ostensibly normal alveolar macrophages
PMNs
probably
stimula-
(8). small
factor correlated amazingly well w i t h the degree of
t r o p h i l i a in l u n g l a v a g e c e l l s
(23) a n d s e e m e d to r e l a t e
stimulation. We have not found such a relationship
spaces
are
spontaneously
ionophore
T h e c a p a c i t y o f a l v e o l a r m a c r o p h a g e s f r o m I P F p a t i e n t s to s e c r e t e a size chemotactic
prespat-
LTC^, LTD^ and LTE^ which comprise SRS,
n o t p r e s e n t . T h e p a t t e r n a p p e a r s to be m o r e c o m p l e x
dosis patients,
has
in e t h a n o l a n d t h e n f r a c t i o n a t e d by r e v e r s e p h a s e h i g h
sure liquid chromatography tern with some
naturally
(31).
to i m m u n e
neu-
complex
in long d u r a t i o n
sarcoi-
f o r m o s t p a t i e n t s do n o t h a v e e x c e s s i v e P M N s in t h e i r
; p r o g r e s s i o n to a f i b r o t i c s t a g e o f l u n g d i s e a s e
is t h e
air-
outcome
in a m i n o r i t y o f p a t i e n t s a n d m a y n o t be i n d u c e d in a n a n a l o g o u s w a y .
Yet,
alveolar macrophages from these sarcoid patients can p r o d u c e
chemotactic
s u b s t a n c e s w h i c h m i g h t r e l a t e to a g e n e r a l s t a t e o f e n h a n c e d
macrophage
a c t i v a t i o n a n d t h u s b e a p h e n o m e n o n t h a t is m e a s u r a b l e f e s t e d by a n in s i t u c o r r e l a t i o n . solvent soluble components
although not
The secretion profile of p r o t e i n
is c o m p l e x a n d c h e m o t a x i s as a s s e s s e d
maniand
with
P M N s a n d o t h e r i n f l a m m a t o r y c e l l s m i g h t n o t b e the c o r r e c t b i o l o g i c to c h a r a c t e r i z e
6•
these macrophage
assay
products.
Summary.
A selective
i n f l a m m a t o r y r e a c t i o n in l u n g t i s s u e
tory host defense that can augment local cellular and humoral defense against micro-organisms
is a m e c h a n i s m o f (alveolar
and particles
respira-
macrophages)
that reach
the
165 alveolar surface.
T h i s r e a c t i o n in w h i c h p h a g o c y t i c c e l l s ,
polymorphonuclear neutrophils,
principally
immune effector cells, and fluid
components
f r o m p l a s m a a r e a t t r a c t e d to t h e a l v e o l i a p p e a r s to be i n i t i a t e d a n d trolled from the airside chemotactic
of the lung. In the early phase of
inflammation,
f a c t o r s m a y b e g i n the i n f l u x o f a s s e s s o r y p h a g o c y t e s .
factors can be l i b e r a t e d by alveolar m a c r o p h a g e s teins
con-
Such
in the f o r m o f s m a l l
(about 5,000 d mole, wt. ) and lipogenase pathway derived
o f a r a c h i d o n i c a c i d o f w h i c h l e u k o t r i e n e B ^ is a n e x a m p l e o r c o u l d be plement components. alternative
complement pathway
(C,_a) or, p o s s i b l y , s e c r e t e d l o c a l l y 5
Other mediators with chemotactic and/or
from bacteria must be considered,
by
vaso-
a c t i o n s m a y a r i s e f r o m the f i b r i n o l y t i c o r k i n i n
Soluble exo-products
systems.
too. When
inflamma-
t i o n is e s t a b l i s h e d a n d e x u d a t i v e f l u i d f i l l s t h e a i r s p a c e s , c e l l u l a r zymes released from injured or dying cells may help perpetuate tion. Thus, factors from several sources can individually or be involved in modulating lung inflammation. feature
interstitial and alveolar
the
s u c h as i d i o p a t h i c macrophages
a source of c h e m o t a c t i c activity that may r e f l e c t p a r t of a poorly reaction.
en-
reac-
collectively
In c e r t a i n l u n g d i s e a s e s
inflammation,
ry fibrosis and s a r c o i d o s i s of long d u r a t i o n , a c t i v a t e d
ted inflammatory
com-
A c t i v a t e d complement fragments are g e n e r a t e d by the
alveolar macrophages. permeability
pro-
metabolites
that
pulmonaare regula-
166 REFERENCES. 1.
Reynolds, H.Y., C h e s t 75
(suppl.), 239-242
2.
Reynolds,
3.
R e y n o l d s , H . Y . , Am. Rev. Respir. Dis. 1 2 7 , 5 1 6 - 2 5 ,
H.Y., Merrill W.W.
(1979).
: iji C u r r e n t P u l m o n o l o g y
D . H . ) H o u g h t o n M i f f l i n , B o s t o n , 2, 2 9 9 - 3 2 3
1983.
C o h e n , A., B a t r a , G. A m . R e v . Respir. Dis. 1 2 2 , 2 3 9 - 2 4 7
5.
Kazmierowski,
6.
7.
G.W., Gallin J.I., Fauci, A.S., Am Rev R e s p i r Dis
Merrill, W.W., Naegel, G.P., Matthay, R.A., Reynolds, H.Y., J.
Fels, A.O.S.,
Hunninghake,
Pawlowski, N.A., Cramer, E.B., King,
G.W. , Gadek, J.E., Fales, H.M., Crystal,
Invest. 66, 473-483
117, 9 0 0 - 9 0 3
(1982).
R.G., J.
Clin.
Immunol.
(1976).
, M.M., Crystal,
12. D e s a i , U., K r e u t z e r ,
13. S h a w , J . O . , H e n s o n ,
J.A., Roberts,
R . G . , J. C l i n . I n v e s t . ,
D.L., Showeil,
Amer. J. Pathol. 96, 71-83
W.C.,
59, 1 6 5 - 1 7 5
B.S., Arroyave,
(1977).
C.V., Ward,
P.A.,
(1979).
P.M., Henson, G., Webster,
R.O., Lab.
Invest.
42,
(1980).
14. K o l b , W . P . , K o l b , L . M . , W e t s e l , R . A . , R o g e r s , W . R . , S h a w , J . O . , Rev. Respir.
D i s . 123, 2 2 6 - 2 3 1
Am Rev. Respir.
D i s 1 2 5 , 53 (Abstr)
16. S c h e r z e r , H . H . , K r e u t z e r , A m R e v . R e s p i r D i s 1 2 1 , 92 17. P e n n i n g t o n ,
D . L . , V a r a n i , J . , D e s a i , U., S e n i o r , (abstr)
H.R., Clin.Res.29,
18. G r o s s , G . N . , R e h m , S . R . , P i e r c e ,
R.G.
(1982). R.M.
(1980).
G.E., Matthews, W.G., Rössing,
F.S., Colten,
Am.
(1981).
15. R o b b i n s , R . A . , G a d e k , J . E . , R e n n a r d , S . I . , C h e n , Y . F . , C r y s t a l ,
(1978).
Z.A.,
(1980).
11. R e y n o l d s , H . Y . , F u l m e r , J . D . , K a z m i e r o w s k i ,
547-548
Clin.
T.K.C., Cohn,
10. R o b e r t s o n , J . , C a l d w e l l , G . R . , C a s t l e , G . , W a l d m a n , R . H . , J.
Frank
117,
(1980).
Scott, W.A., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sei, U.S.A., 79, 7866-7870 9.
59,
(1978).
Invest. 65, 268-276 8.
(1980).
J . A . , G a l l i n , J . I . , R e y n o l d s , H . Y . J. C l i n . I n v e s t .
(1977).
Hunninghake, 15-23
Simmons,
(1980).
4.
273-281
(Editor
450
T.H., Gash, D.J.,
(abstr)
Cole,
(1981).
A . K . , J. C l i n . I n v e s t . 6 2 ,
373-378
167 19. Larsen, G.L., Mitchell, B.C., Harper, T.B., Henson, P.M., Am. Rev. Respir. Dis.126, 306-311
(1982).
20. Ghebrehiwet, B., Randazzo, B.P., Dunn, J.T., Silverberg, M., Kaplan, A.P. J. Clin. Invest. 71, 1450-1456
(1983).
21. Lee, C.T., Fein, A.M., Lippmann, M., Hottzman, H., Kimberly, P., Weinbaum, G., N. Engl.J. Med. 304, 192-196
(1981).
22. Mc Guire, W.W., Spragg, R.G., Cohen, A.B., Cochrane, C.G. J. Clin. Invest. 69, 543-553
(1982).
23. Hunninghake, G.W., Gadek, G.E., Lawley, T.G., Crystal, R.G., J. Clin. Invest.68, 259-269
(1981).
24. Reynolds, H.Y., Lung 155, 225-242,
(1978).
25. Hunninghake, G.W., Crystal, R.G., N. Engl J Med. 305, 429-434
(1981).
26. Roth, C., Huchon, G.J., Arnoux, A., Stanislas-Leguern, G., Marsac, G., Chretien, J., Am. Rev. Respir Dis 124, 9-12
(1981).
27. Roth-Fouret, C., Reynolds, H.Y., Laval, A-M., Sandron, D., Huchon, G., Chretien, J., Rev. Fr. Mai. Respir 11, 347 (Abstr)
(1983).
28. Sandron, D., Reynolds, H.Y., Laval, A-M., Venet, A., Roth-Fouret, C., Huchon, G.J., Chretien, J. Rev. Fr. Mai. Respir. 11, 348 (abstr) 29. Nagy, L., Lee, T.K., Kay, A.B., N. Engl. J. Med. 306, 497-501 30. Rankin, J.A., Hitchock, M., Merrill, W., Bach, M.K., Brashler, Askenase, P.W., Nature 297, 329-331
(1982).
31. Joseph, M., Tonnel, A-B., Torpier, G., Capron, A., Arnoux, B., Benveniste, J., J. Clin. Invest. 71, 221-230
(1983).
(1983)
(1982). G.R.,
SECTION PROTEASE
III ANTI-PROTEASE
INTERACTIONS AND LUNG DISEASES
HUMAN
cyANTICHYMOTRYPSIN
SOME SERINE
: PURIFICATION,
PROPERTIES
AND
REACTIONS
WITH
PROTEASES
Anne Laine, Annette Hayem, Monique Davril Unité INSERM N°16, Place de Verdun 59045 Lille Cédex, France
Introduction
Q-l-antichymotrypsin fically
(a^Achy)
is a plasma protease
inactivates chymotrypsin-like
enzymes
inhibitor which
(1,2).
It represents one of
the major acute phase proteins (3). It appeared that a-|Achy was ly concentrated tis
in the bronchial
lumen
speci-
selective-
in patients with chronic
(4). On the other hand, a^Achy which has been shown to be
bronchiidentical
to the protein termed 64 DP (5) has a high affinity for DNA-cel1ulose and it
has
role
been
in
diagnosing
antibody
response
inhibitory and till
suggested
its now
that
malignant and
capacity
reaction
(6)
this
(7).
little
diseases.
with
the inflammatory nule
contents
medium
; thus
Moreover
seems
biological
the
serine
between
it
is
elastase
of
interest
a-|Achy to
be
We present
enhances
related
significance
proteases
prominent
it
of
its
Q-jAchy
inhibits
here a simpler
the
to
have
purifica-
one we previously published (8) and some a^Achy
and leukocyte enzymes
process, polymorphonuclear
including
not
the
attention.
tion procedure than the original studies about the reaction
64 DP would have a quite
property
In fact
mechanism
received
this
and to
leukocytes release their gra-
cathepsin know
: during
how
G into the a^Achy
extracellular
reacts
with
these
enzymes, or how these enzymes react upon a^Achy. Immunochemical led
us
to
studies
conclude
we
that
carried
out
quantitation
using three different of
such
a component
procedures
which
under different molecular forms must be very carefully exploited.
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in Germany
can
be
172 Results 1)
Purification
procedure.
a^Achy was prepared
the procedure p r e v i o u s l y graphy
steps
were not
equilibrated NaN 3
0.02%
loaded
an
described glycine 7.4
by d i a l y s i s .
(8).
The
0.5
concentrated present
tion
Sephacryl
on
a
After
centrifugation,
by
M NaCl
S
fraction
200
column.
The s l i g h t
pure
inhibitor
Purity.
In SDS-PAGE
(Fig.
with
:
25
Diaflo
apparatus.
remaining
filtracontami-
to
PI
Sepharose
30
mg of
columns.
a-jAchy
as s i n g l e
are
procedure.
1) p u r i f i e d a^Achy g i v e s a s i n g l e band of
M^ : 58,000 with or w i t h o u t p r i o r r e d u c t i o n . A s p a r a g i n e was fied
0.2 M
a d j u s t e d t o pH
(a^ P i ) , were removed
and a n t i - a - |
a^Achy
o b t a i n e d from 100 ml normal serum u s i n g t h i s
2)
a
previously
f r a c t i o n were e l i m i n a t e d by gel
anti-albumin is
in
as
eluted
immediately
ultrafiltration
in t h i s
successively
Unbound
chromato-
the serum was
prepared
fraction
was
serumalbumin and a ^ - p r o t e a s e
using
of
human pooled serum was
column
containing
c^Achy
pH 2 . 8 ,
Aggregates nants,
: the two c o v a l e n t
anymore. Normal
anti - a ^ A c h y - S e p h a r o s e
buffer
and
(8)
a modification
i n 0.01 M sodium phosphate b u f f e r pH 7 . 4 , 0 . 3 M NaCl, (PBS)
on
described
used
by
amino a c i d i n N - t e r m i n a l
position
identi-
by Edman d e g r a d a -
tion. 3)
Properties. (8),
Chemical
further
tryptophan,
composition
studies both
c o n t e n t , a^Achy
of
is
indicate them
a very
has that
represent labile
been
previously
concerning about
1%
determined
half-cystine of
the
and
amino-acid
component which has t o be kept
in
PBS pH 7.4 at 4°C or f r o z e n i f s t o r e d f o r a long p e r i o d . 4)
Interactions purulent formation and
with c a t h e p s i n G. C a t h e p s i n G was i s o l a t e d from human
sputum of
cathepsin
(9).
In
an equimolar G
occurred c^Achy
modified
form
of
Moreover
when
active
fragment,
migrating
as
a
previous complex
paper
cathepsin a peptide
we
(M^ near 78,000)
concurrently which
(10),
had G of
no
with
inhibitory
reacted M
the
near
with
noticed
between formation capacity a^Achy
5-6,000
was
a
that
a^Achy of
a
left. small
released
173
and
observed
in
SDS-PAGE.
More r e c e n t l y
complex was not s t a b l e with time Spectrophotometry (12)
using
amounts of amount
of
enzymatic
enzyme
10 ^M), a q u i t e
(final
as
enzyme
performed
substrate.
equimolar
according
When
to
increasing
5 min at 25°C w i t h a f i x e d
concentration
inhibition
in
the
assays
: 3 x
curve was o b t a i n e d and e x t r a p o l a -
p a r t gave an I/E molar r a t i o equal t o 1.76/1 f o r
inhibition.
A time c o u r s e study i s a-jAchy with various
were
were incubated f o r
linear
t i o n of the l i n e a r complete
assays
Suc-Ala2-Pro-Phe-NA inhibitor
we showed t h a t
(11).
cathepsin
times.
performed on s e v e r a l G (molar
ratio
Spectrophotometric
I/E
identical = 2/1)
mixtures
kept at 25°C
enzymatic a s s a y s on a l i q u o t s
of for sho-
wed no reappearance of a c t i v i t y when the i n c u b a t i o n time i n c r e a s e d . After
PMSF
addition
to
each
s t u d i e d by e l e c t r o p h o r e t i c that
the
increases are
the
equimolar
methods.
complex
: transient
incubation
mixture
the
samples
In SDS-PAGE ( F i g . 1) we observe
dissociates
when
the
incubation
components appear then and the f i n a l
m o d i f i e d a^Achy having a M
were
equal
fragment ( i n d i c a t e d by the arrow on F i q .
time
products
t o 55,000 and the
small
1). i
94,000 67,000 43.000
+
30 000
20,100
^
14,400
M
I
E
C
1 10 min min
1h
3h
6h 24h 48h
8 days
I
F i g . 1. SDS-PAGE on a g r a d i e n t gel (5 to 30% acrylamide) of samples withdrawn from i d e n t i c a l m i x t u r e s of a , A c h y with c a t h e p s i n G (molar r a t i o I/E = 2/1) kept f o r v a r i o u s i n c u b a t i o n times at 25°C. M : M markers ; I = n a t i v e a-,Achy ; E = c a t h e p s i n G ; C = c o n t r o l m i x t u r e , i n which c a t h e p s i n G has been p r e v i o u s l y i n a c t i v a t e d w i t h PMSF.
174
F i g . 2. Characterization of chymotrypsin inhibit o r s (13) after a l k a l i n e PAGE (10% aery1 amide at pH 8.3) of samples w i t h drawn from identical mixtures of a,Achy with cathepsin G (molar ratio 2/1) kept for various i n cubation times at 25°C. I = native a,Achy 1/2 = half d i l u t i o n of I .
+6 (1983).
81. Putnam, C.W., Porter, K.A., Peters, R.L., Ashcavai, M., Redeker, A.G., Starzl, T.E.: Surgery 8^, 258-261 (1977). 82. Hood, J.M., Koep, L.J., Peters, R.L.: (1980).
N. Engl. J. Med. 302, 272-275
ON THE INTERACTION BETWEEN HUMAN LIVER CATHEPSIN L AND THE TWO CYSTEINE PROTEINASES INHIBITORS PRESENT IN HUMAN SERUM.
Maurice Pagano, Robert Engler L a b o r a t o i r e des Protéines de la Réaction Inflammatoire Faculté de Médecine - 45 rue des S a i n t s - P è r e s - F 75270 P a r i s Cédex 06 F r é d é r i c Esnard, and F r a n c i s
Gauthier
L a b o r a t o i r e de B i o c h i m i e , Faculté de Médecine 2, b i s Boulevard Tonnellé - F 37032 Tours Cédex
Introduction Human serum contains two d i f f e r e n t c y s t e i n e - p r o t e i n a s e s - i n h i b i t o r s
: a
high molecular weight i n h i b i t o r named aCPI which appears under two d i f f e r e n t molecular forms a f t e r p u r i f i c a t i o n (HMr aCPIl molecular weight 90.000 and HMr aCPI2 molecular weight 175.000) ( 1 - 3 ) , and a low molecular weight one (LMr CPI molecular weight 12.000) ( 4 - 5 ) . The former
inhibits
s t r o n g l y papain and f i c i n but i n h i b i t s Cathepsin B only weakly ( 1 - 3 ) . The l a t t e r e x h i b i t s a low d i s s o c i a t i o n constant ( K i ) a g a i n s t Cathepsin H and B and p l a y s probably a p h y s i o l o g i c a l proteinases
r o l e in the control of these
(5).
I n a previous paper (6) we have described the i n h i b i t i o n of human l i v e r Cathepsin L (E.C. 3 . 4 . 2 2 . 1 5 ) by HMr C P U and 2. A q u a n t i t a t i v e study of the i n t e r a c t i o n of t h i s enzyme with the two s p e c i f i c i n h i b i t o r s i s reported here.
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
204 Material and methods The assay of human liver Cathepsin L was carried out by using Benzyloxycarbonyl-L-phenylalanine-L-arginine-4-methyl-7-coumarylamide
(Zphe-Arg-N-
Mec) as a substrate. Active site titration of cysteine proteinases was made up with L trans epoxy succinyl-leucyl amino (4 guanidino) butane (E 64). All proteinase and inhibitor concentrations given in this paper refer to "active" concentrations.
Results and discussion Table 1 Kinetic constants for the interaction of the specific cysteine proteinases inhibitors with Cathepsin L.
Inhibitor Ki M
k : M- 1 S- 1
Delay time Sec.
k
l
s-i
Stabi1i ly time min. 4
5
3
1.3
HMr CPI
3.0I0- 9
S.OIO- 4
12.5
6 8IO-
LMr CPI
1.510- 8
7.010- 4
70
2 .410-
Io/ Ki
I 600 66
In this study, we have found that the two varieties of cysteine proteinases inhibitors can play a physiological function in the regulation of Cathepsin L activity. This enzyme has a high proteolytic activity (7), degrades collagen (8) and would be identical with the "col.lagenolytic" Cathepsin (9). The high molecular weight inhibitor seems to be the most efficient : it has the lowest Ki value and there is three order of magnitude between the plasma concentration of this inhibitor and the Ki value. For the low molecular weight inhibitor, the kinetic data are more unfavorable than for
205 the high molecular weight one. By electroimmuno assay, we have also investigated the plasma concentration of HMr CPI : it ranged between 0.4 g/1 - 0.8 g/1 (5.0 I0- s M - I.I0- 5 M on the basis of a molecular weight of 90.000 which corresponds to HMr aCPIl, the only molecular form present "in vivo"). These assays were carried out with thirty sera of known haptoglobin content (0.50 to 6.50 g/1) : the differences observed in the plasma concentration of HMr aCPI are not related to the inflammatory state estimated by the haptoglobin concentration. On the contrary, in the rat, this inhibitor is identical with the al acute phase globulin (10). On the other hand, with both inhibitors, a2 Macroglobulin was able to remove the free enzyme from the enzyme-inhibitor equilibrium. This latter inhibitor would play a role in the plasma elimination of Cathepsin L.
References 1. Sasaki, M., Minakata, K., Yamamoto, H., Niwa, M., Kato, I., and Ito,N.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 76, 917-924 (1977). 2. Ryley, H.C.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 89, 871-878 (1979). 3. Jarvinen, M.: FEBS Letters J08, 461-464 (1979). 4. Lenney, J.F., Liao, J.R., Sugg, S.L., Gopalakrishnan, V., Wong, H.C.H., Ouye, K.H., and Chan, P.W.H.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Comun. J08, 15811587 (1982). 5. Gauthier, F., Pagano, M., Esnard, F., Mouray, H., and Engler, R.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. jJO, 449-455 (1983). 6. Pagano, M., and Engler, R.: FEBS Lettets J38, 307-310 (1982). 7. Barrett, A.J., and Kirschke, H.: In methods in enzymology vol.80 (Lorand L. ed.) 535-561. Academic Press. London (1982). 8. Kirschke, H., Kembhavi, A.A., Bohley, P., and Barrett, A.J.: Biochem.J. 201, 367-372 (1972). 9. Mason, R.W., Taylor, M.A.J.,and Etherington, D.J.: FEBS Letters 146, 33-36 (1982). 10. Esnard, F., and Gauthier, F.: accepted for publication.
MODULATION OF HUMAN LYMPHOCYTE RESPONSES BY GLOBULIN
ai
ANTITRYPSIN AND a 2 MACRO-
Jean-Pierre Revillard, Geneviève Cordier, Jacqueline Bata, Mireille Latour Laboratoire d'Immunologie, F- 69374 Lyon Cedex 08.
INSERM U.80 CNRS-ERA 782, Hôpital E. Herriot
Summary Several lines of evidence indicate the role of proteinases and of their natural inhibitors in the regulation of lymphocyte responses. A proteolytic activity can be demonstrated at the surface of intact living cells, including lymphocytes. Two major serum anti-proteinases, ajAT and a 2 m were shown to bind to lymphocyte subpopulations and to modulate proliferative or cytotoxic lymphocyte responses. 012m may serve as carrier molecule for various lymphokines. Therefore proteinase-antiproteinase systems are likely to contribute to the regulation of the immune response, especially at the site of inflammatory reactions.
Since the work of Grassmann and Dyckerhoff in 1928 (1) peptide hydrolases or proteases have been classified in two distinct groups: the exopeptida^ ses (aminopeptidases, carboxypeptidases and dipeptidylpeptidases) and the endopeptidases or proteinases. The latter comprise four main groups defined according to the chemical nature of the groups responsible,for catalytic activity : serine proteinases, thiol or cysteine proteinases, carboxyl or aspartic proteinases and metalloproteinases (2, 3). The activities of the proteinases in vivo are controlled by two systems. One is represented by the fact that most of the serine proteinases are synthetized as inactive precursors that require limited proteolysis to activate them. This provides a convenient inactive form of the enzyme for storage, but also allows complex control system with positive feedback, such as activation of trypsinogen by trypsin, or cascades of enzymes each activating the next, a system most highly developped amongst the blood coagulation factors. The
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
208 second form of control of the serine proteinases activity is the system of protein inhibitors. About 10 % of the human plasma protein consists of serine proteinase inhibitors, the most abundant beinga2-macroglobulin (012M) and aj-proteinase inhibitor or aj,-antitrypsin (ctjAT), on a weight basis.
1)
Proteinase activity of lymphocyte surface.
Many inactive zymogens
for serine proteinases can be found in plasma, including enzymes of the blood coagulation and fibrinolysis cascades, the complement system and the interconnected kinin-generation system.Other proteinases are located in cells and tissues, among which two cell types were shown to contain large amounts of active enzymes : the polymorphonuclear leukocytes and the mast cells. The enzymes are located in the cytoplasmic granules. The presence of proteinase on the cell surface has not been extensively studied so far. Hatcher and coworkers (4) extracted a proteinase from human lymphocytes, the cytotoxicity of which was demonstrated at neutral pH using human bladder carcinoma target cells. This protease may be involved in lymphocyte mediated cytotoxicity but its precise localization in the cytoplasm or on the membrane has not been investigated. Similarly a cytotoxic substance was isolated from human lymphocyte membrane
though
its possible protease nature has not been investigated (5). Tokes and Kiefer have designed a method allowing the demonstration of proteolytic activity at the surface of lymphocytes (6). Radioiodinated casein covalently linked to polystyrene beads was found to be hydrolyzed when put in contact with mouse viable lymphocytes in the absence of serum. Proteolytic activity was higher in spleen than in lymph nodes. No difference was found between preparations of thymus and bone-marrow lymphocytes (7). Using the same technique we were able to demonstrate a proteolytic activity on blood and tonsillar human lymphocytes. Also, a significant proteolytic activity was observed dn erythrocytes, but little or no protease was released from these cells. No major difference in surface protease activity appeared between T-enriched and T-depleted cell suspensions (8). A nearly complete inhibition of protease surface activity was achieved by addition of purified ct j AT at a concentration of 0.2 mg/ml. Proteolytic activity of lymphocyte surface has also been demonstrated by Grayzel et al. (9). More recently Zucker-Franklin and coworkers studied the bin-
209 ding and hydrolysis of serum amyloid A by leukocytes (10). By using specific inhibitors, they could demonstrate a-naphtyl-acetate-esterase activity on the surface of monocytes and a subpopulation of 8-15 % lymphocytes. 2)
Binding of proteinase inhibitors to lymphocyte surface.
The binding
of proteinase inhibitors provides indirect evidence for the presence of a proteinase activity of the cell cytoplasmic outer membrane, assuming that the binding is specific. Trasylol, a low molecular weight polypeptide obtained from bovine lung, is a broad spectrum antiproteinase. It was shown to bind to human peripheral blood lymphocytes and polymorphonuclear neutrophils (11). Four independent studies have shown the binding of ajAT to human lymphocytes. Incubation of highly purified ajAT with human tonsil cells in serum-free medium resulted in a transient decrease of ajAT activity in the supernatant (12). More direct evidence of the binding of ajAT was brought by Moreau et al. (13) and by our own studies (14) using iodinated ajAT. We reported that the binding was fast and reversible, that the cells could be saturated. Each lymphocyte can bind a maximum of approximately 1.2 x 10^ molecules of ajAr with an association constant of 0.7 x 10^ M
1. The binding was inhibited by addition of cold ai AT » Soybean
Trypsin inhibitor, and partially by ci2M- lodination by a ] A T which results in the oxidation of the methionine group of the active site with a loss of functional activity, did not allow to demonstrate any binding of a jAT, suggesting that the integrity of the functional site of the inhibitor was necessary. Finally the addition of cell-free supernatants from lymphocytes incubated at 37°C was foumd to decrease the binding of ajAT, suggesting that the proteinase receptor was released from the cell surface. The radiolabelling method, however, brings no information on the possible heterogeneity of a^AT distribution among the cell populations nor does it indicate the presence of ajAT on untreated lymphocytes. We therefore investigated these two points using indirect fluorescence and flow cytometry analysis (15). The presence of a^AT was revealed on a variable percentage of untreated peripheral blood and tonsillar lymphocytes. The percentage of labelled lymphocytes was increased by preincubation with purified ajAT and inhibited by TPCK and by EDTA (3 mM) which could also displace OjAT initially bound to the lymphocyte surface (15). Two other studies have shown
210 the presence of ajAT on the surface of RAJI cells (16) and on concanavalin A stimulated lymphocytes whereas no such binding was found with unstimulated lymphocytes cultured for 72 hrs (17). These experiments does not demonstrate that the antiprotease is actually synthetized by the cells rather than taken up from the serum containing culture medium, through a proteinase receptor at the cell surface. The association of a 2 M with 'lymphocyte surface was first demonstrated by Mc Cormick et al. (18) and confirmed by other reports (19, 20, 21). By indirect fluorescence, a 2 M was detected mostly on a subpopulation of lymphocytes bearing surface Ig. Since a 2 M i s synthetized by monocytes but not by T lymphocytes and quite unlikely by B lymphocytes (22), the most likely explanation for its presence on lymphocyte surface is its binding to a surface receptor. In conclusion, proteinases associated with the external surface of lymphocyte cytoplasmic membrane can be demonstrated by a variety of techniques. Such enzymes are responsible for the binding of antiproteinases like cijAT and a 2 M - Proteinase- ajAT complexes are released in the extracellular environment whereas new enzymatic sites are expressed. The binding of ajAT, although specific and saturable, is characterized by a low affinity and a great capacity. The distribution of proteinases and antiproteinases on the cell surface may depend greatly on the mode of separation of lymphocytes and the concentration of serum and plasma in the medium. 3)
Effect of proteolytic enzymes on lymphocyte responses.
The role of
proteolytic enzymes in the triggering and regulation of lymphocyte activation was suggested by experiments showing that lymphocyte transformation could be inhibited by antiproteases and triggered by neutral proteases (table 1). Trypsin, thrombin and pronase were shown to stimulate DNA synthesis in mouse B cells in the absence of other stimulating agents (23, 24, 25). The stimulating effect was usually not demonstrable on T cells, except with pronase (24). Similar results were reported in other species including hamster (26), rabbit (27) and man (28, 29). Human lymphocytes however, seem less susceptible to activation by proteases than those of other species (30, 31). Human B lymphocytes were slightly more activated than T cells (24, 32). In addition to its own mitogenic effect, pronase,
211 Table 1.
Effect of neutral proteases on lymphocyte transformation.
Species
Proteases
Mouse
Trypsin Thrombin Pronase
Hamster Rabbit
Trypsin, chymotrypsin
Man
Trypsin, chymotrypsin Elastase,, cathepsin G Trypsin, pronase Trypsin Elastase,, chymotrypsin
Lymphocyte transformation Ref. + + +
0 0 + + (Í)
26 27
+ +
++
+ 0 0
23, 24 25 24
28 29 24, 32 30 31
but not trypsin, was shown to enhance the proliferative response to PPD (32). The potentiation of the response to phytohemagglutinin (PHA) was less readily demonstrable (27, 32). However, Havemann and coworkers (31) clearly demonstrated a marked potentiation of PHA-induced.lymphocyte stimulation by two granulocyte neutral proteases, elastase and chymotrypsin, especially if low and medium protease concentrations, short time incubation with the enzymes, and sub-optimal amounts of mitogen were employed. This potentiating effect was no longer demonstrable after removal of monocytes from the culture. These results suggested that potentiation of lymphocyte responses was mediated by an indirect effect via activation of monocytes. Such activation was paralleled by changes in other functional parameters such as inhibition of monocyte migration and chemotaxis, and increase of phagocytosis (31). Several hypotheses has been put forward postulating a role for proteases in lymphocyte triggering by antigens or mitogens. Vitteta and Uhr proposed that binding of multivalent antigens to specific IgD receptors on B cells could expose a critical site in the hinge region of the molecule to the proteolytic activity in the membrane of B cells or adjacent accessory cells (33) . A second signal might be mediated by proteolytic conversion of macrophage derived B lymphocyte bound C3 to C3b (23, 26,34) . These two mechanisms account for a preferential effect of proteases on B cells. However it should be stressed that lymphokines as well as a number
212 of factors of inflammation known to modulate the immune response, are dependent upon protease activity for their synthesis, release and/or activity (35). Therefore the modulating effect of proteases may well be not restricted to certain forms of immune responses, thus making the effects of natural antiproteinases rather unpredictable. 4)
Immunomodulatinq effect of otiflT.
Although Vischer et al. (36) could
not demonstrate a significant inhibitory effect of aj AT on the proliferative response of Balb/c spleen cells to various polyclonal activators, Arora et al. showed that the primary in vitro antibody response to sheep erythrocytes was inhibited by addition of ajAT at concentration of 0.1 to 1 mg/ml (37). Inhibition was achieved by pre-incubation of ajAT with B cells but not with adherent nor with T cells. Injection of ajAT in vivo also depressed the primary response and appropriate controls showed that inhibition could not be attributed to antigenic competition, despite the fact that human ajAT was used in these experiments (37). Using human and mouse lymphocytes, we have found that ajAT inhibits DNA synthesis triggered by several mitogens or by allogeneic cells, and that the effect could be demonstrated with T cells as well as B cells (38, 39, 40). The inhibitory activity of cijAT appeared to be related to its protease inhibitory capacity since ajAT preparations which had lost their anti-trypsin activity during purification were not inhibitory (39). Inhibition of PHA response byajAT was also reported by Baranova et al. (41) . Finally, ctjAT was shown to decrease antibody-dependent cell cytotoxicity and natural Killer activity in a dose-dependent pattern (42). The demonstration of various immunosuppressive activities of ajAT at concentrations below those found in normal plasma is of great importance in view of the possible therapeutic use of this molecule (see Crystal, this volume). It would be of great interest to monitor primary antibody responses, natural killer activity and antibody-dependent cell cytotoxicity in patients treated with ajAT as well as in those with deficient ajAT phenotypes.
213 5)
Modulation of lymphocyte responses by a-,H.
The inhibitory effect of
a 2 M on PHA-induced proliferation of homologous lymphocytes has been observed in man (43) and hamster. Hamster a 2 M
was
reported to depress the pro-
liferation of a B lymphoma cell line as shown on morphological or isotopic grounds (44, 45). a 2 M prepared from human plasma inhibits the proliferative responses of human lymphocytes to PHA and Con A at concentrations of 1 mg/ml (46). In contrast to these observations, Vischer was unable to observe an inhibitory effect of a 2 M »
at a
concentration of 1.4 mg/ml, on
the proliferative response of mouse lymphocytes cultured in a serum-free medj-um (36) . The effect of additional a 2 M present in fetal calf serum may have contributed to some extent to the inhibition reported by other authors (47) . The inhibitory effect of ct2M
was
extended to other mitogens
including LPS on hamster lymphocytes (45) and PWM on human lymphocytes (43). The possibility for inhibition to be due to a direct interaction between mitogen and Q 2 M that prevents the binding of the mitogen to the lymphocyte surface was discussed for PHA (48, 49). The inhibitory effect of a 2 M on proliferative responses is not restricted to mitogen-induced responses but has been observed in mixed lymphocyte culture as well. Doses showing inhibitory effect were 1,000 to 10,000 times lower than those required to prevent mitogen-induced proliferation (46). Moreover, a 2 M exerted an inhibitory effect only when added during the early phase of the reaction, suggesting an effect at the recognition stage (50). This was further supported by experiments showing the decreased production of macrophage slowing factor by lymphocytes incubated with antigen and a 2 M (51). None of these observations considered the relation between the effects of
&2M
preparations and their biological activity. Some discrepan-
cies between different authors might be due to variations in biological activity. However, it was reported that denaturation of a 2 M by ammonium sulfate with a loss in the esterase-inhibitor activity resulted in increasing the inhibitory effect of the a 2 M on proliferative response in mixed lymphocyte cultures (46). Finally the regulatory role of fr2M itself remains questionable since other factors carried by a 2 M might account for some of the reported results. Hence small inhibitory peptides (2,000 to 5,000) daltons) were extracted from ct2M by acid dialysis. Other
aglobu-
lins with documented immunosuppressive effect, such as the pregnancy zone protein, might be antigenically related to a 2 M.
214 The immunomodulating effects of a 2 M may be mediated by the many substances that can be carried by a 2 M (52) . For instance, a 2 M from plasma of patients with rheumatoid arthritis was shown to induce polyclonal activation of B cells (53) . This effect was recently attributed to an a 2 M bound lymphokine produced by T cells in crowded cultures. The lymphokine is associated with a protease activity (54). a 2 M is also a potent inhibitor of aarious cytotoxic reactions including antibody dependent cell cytotoxicity mediated by neutrophils (55) or by lymphocytes (38, 42, 56). The a 2 M subunits were shown to be more potent inhibitors than native a 2 M (56) .
Conclusion Proteolysis is part of many biological reactions especially in inflammation and the immune response. Proteolytic activity can be demonstrated on the outer membrane of lymphocytes, but the enzymes have not been characterized as yet. Natural antiproteinases including ajAT and
a 2 M are
therefore involved in the regulation of lymphocyte responses. Since these antiproteinases are produced by monocytes and macrophages, proteinaseantiproteinase systems may represent one of the regulatory pathway of interaction between lymphocytes and accessory cells.
215 References 1.
Grassmann, W., Dyckerhoff, H: Hoppe-Seyler1s, Z. 41 (1928).
2.
Barrett, A.J.: Proteolysis in health and disease. Ciba Foundation symposium N° 75. Evered, D. and Whelan, J., eds. Excerpta Medica, Amsterdam.
3.
Barrett, A. J. : Fed. Proc. 39^ 9 (1980).
4.
Hatcher, V.B., Oberman, M.S., Lazarus, G.S., Grayzel, A.I.: J. Immunol 120, 665 (1978).
5.
Kahn-Perles, B., Golstein, P.: Eur. J. Immunol. 8, 71 (1978).
6.
Tökes, Z.A., Kiefer, H.: J. Supramol. Struct. 4, 507 (1976).
7.
Tökes, Z.A.: Fed. Proc. 3£, 533 (1975).
8.
Bata, J., Martin, J.P., Revillard, J.P.: Experientia 37, 518 (1981).
9.
Graizel, A., Hatcher, V.B., Lazarus, G.L.: Cell. Immunol. JJ3, 210 (1975) .
Physiol. Chem. 179,
10.
Zucker-Franklin, D., Lavie, G., Franklin, E.: J. Histochem. Cytochem. 29_, 451 (1981) .
11.
Thomson, A.W., Pugh-Humphreys, R.G.P., Tweedie, D.J., Hörne, C.H.W.: Experientia 34, 528 (1978).
12.
Bata, J., Deviller, P., Colobert, 1499 (1977).
13.
Moreau, P., Dornand, S., Kaplan, J.G. : Can. J. Biochem. (1975) .
14.
Bata, J., Deviller, P., Revillard, J.P.: Biochem. Biophys. Res. Com. 98, 709 (1981).
15.
Bata, J., Cordier, G.: Ann. Immunol. 133D, 263 (1982).
16.
Dierich, M.P., Landen, B., Schmitt, M.: Z. Immun. Fursch. 156, 153 (1979) .
17.
Lipsky, J.J., Berninger, R.W., Hyman, L.R., Talamo, R.C.: J. Immunol. 122, 24 (1979) .
18.
Mc Cormick, J.N., Tunstall, A.M., James, K. : Nature New Biol. 146, 78 (1973) .
19.
Gelder, F., Hurtubise, P., Scillian, J., Murphy, S.: Clin. Res. 23, 291A (1975).
20.
James, K., Tunstall, A.M., Parker, A., Mc Cormick, J.N.: Clin. Exp. Immunol. _19, 237 (1975).
21.
Jakab, L., Pozsonyi, T,, Feher, J., Papp, G.: Protides of the Biological Fluids. Peeters, H. Ed. Pergamon Press, Oxford, p. 767 (1977).
22.
Hovi, T., Mosher, D., Vaheri, A.: J. Exp. Med. 145, 1580 (1977).
23.
Vischer, T.L.: J. Immunol. 113, 58 (1974).
L.: C.R. Acad. Sei. Paris 285D, 1337
216
24.
Kaplan, J.G., Bona, C.: Exp. Cell. Res. 88, 388 (1974).
25.
Chen,L.B., Teng, N.N.H., Buchanan, J.M.: Exp. Cell. 101, 41 (1976).
26.
Hart, D.A., Streilen, J.S.: Exp. Cell. Res. 102, 246 (1976).
27.
Goodall, D.M., Pardoe, G.I., Gregory, J.K. : Clin. Exp. Immunol.9^, 645 (1971) .
28.
Mazzei, D., Novi, C., Bazzi, C.: Lancet 2, 232 (1966).
29.
Vischer, T.L., Bretz, U. , Baggiolini, M. : J. Exp. Med. 144, 863 (1976)
30.
Algom, D. , Graham, B., Fyson, R. , Richter, M.: Immunol. Coram. 5_, 145 (1976).
31.
Haveman, K., Schmidt, W., Bogdahn, U., Gramse, M.: Neutral proteases of human polymorphonuclear leukocytes. Haveman, K., Janoff, A., eds. p. 306 (1978).
32.
Girard, J.P. , Fernandes, B.: Europ. J. Clin. Invest. 6_, 347 (1976).
33.
Vitetta, E.S., Uhr, J.W.: Science 189, 964 (1975).
34.
Gisler, R.H., Vischer, T.L., Dukor, P.: J. Immunol. 116, 1354 (1976).
35.
Becker, E.L., Herrson, P.M.: Adv. Immunol. YJ_, 94 (1973).
36.
Vischer, T.L.: Immunology 36, 811 (1979).
37.
Arora, P.K., Miller, H.C., Aronson, L.D.: Nature 274, 589 (1978).
38.
Bata, J., Cordier, G., Kevillard, J.P., Bonneau, M., Latour, M.: Transplantation and Clinical Immunology 59 (1981).
39.
Bata, J., Deviller, P., Vallier, P., Revillard, J.P.: Ann. Immunol. 132C, 275 (1981) .
40.
Bata, J., Revillard, J.P. : Agents and Action
41.
Baranova, F.S., Bermann, A.A., Zarestskaya, Y.M.: Bull. Exp. Biol. Med. 8£, 44 (1981).
42.
Ades, E.W., Hinson, A., Chapuis-Cellier, C., Arnaud, P.: Scand. J. ^5, 105 (1982).
43.
Goutner, S., Simmler, J.T. , Rosenfeld, C. : Differentiation (1976).
44.
Streilein, J.S.: Ph.D. Thesis, University of Texas, Health service Center, Dallas (1976).
614 (1981).
171
45.
Stein-Streilein, J., Hart, D.A. : Fed. Proc. y]_, 2042 (1978).
46.
Johannsen, R., Haupt, H., Bohn, H., Heide, K., Seiler, F.R., Schwick, H.G.: Z. Immunit. Forsch. 152, 280 (1976).
47.
Streilein, J.S., Hart, D.A.: Infect. Immun. J.4, 463 (1976).
48.
Chase, P.S.: Cellul. Immunol. 5_, 544 (1972).
49.
Amlot, P.L., Unger, A.: Clin. Exp. Immunol. 25, 520 (1976).
50.
Johannsen, R., Carlsson, A.B., Haupt, H., Heide, K.: Behring. Inst. Mitt. 54, 33 (1974).
217
51.
Ford, W.H. , Caspary, E.A. , Shenton, B.: Clin. Exp. Immunol. _15, 169 (1973).
52.
James, K. ; TIBS JJ5, 43 (1980).
53.
Teodorescu, M., Chang, J.L., Skosey, J.L.: Int. Arch. Allergy Appl. Immunol. 66, 1 (1981).
54.
Chang, J.L., Ganea, D., Dray, S., Teodorescu, M.: J. Immunol. 130, 267 (1983).
55.
Cordier, G., Revillard, J.P.: Experientia 36, 603 (1980).
56.
Gravagna, P., Gianazza, E., Arnaud, P., Neels, M., Ades, E.W.: Scand. J. Immunol. 15, 115 (1982).
M E D I A T O R S OF
INFLAMMATION
Moderators
: R.G.CRYSTAL
Th-is Aound
table, pAovided
between gists, most
clinicians, since The
AeseaAch. paAt
hoA
next
symposium.
summaAy
discussion and
alveolitis oh the
paAticipants
The
AeadeA
texts
will
in the
oh R.G. CRVSTAL
lung
interstitial
structures,
includes a c c u m u l a t i o n
chemotactic
and
H.
REyfJOLPS
the p r o c e s s of a l v e o l i t i s . the major They
factors
origin
consist
of immune and
is
hoA
of such
effector
O n e or more
can
release injury.
of cells
alveolar
Alveolar
factors
of small p r o t e i n s
in
these cells
into a i r s p a c e s .
take a part spaces
Other
to the increase
: plasminogen
(at least
or
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
is
side of
2 diffe-
chemotactic
in cellular
activator,
will
macrophage
in the air
have been i d e n t i f i e d ) p r o d u c i n g an influx
polymorphonuclears
of
to alveolar
factors a t t r a c t i n g
initiate
of a l v e o l a r
gAeateA
bAieh
they
contributing
probably
will a l s o
a
in the.
a
structures.
types are a c t i v a t e d , and of i n f l a m m a t i o n
Since a l v e o l i t i s
rent
that
discussion,
and
is defined a s a c c u m u l a t i o n
t h e s e cell
uAge
the
diseases
be AeseAved
^-¿nd theAeahteA
appAoache.d
one. oh
oh pulmonary
should
moApholo-
data.
cells w i t h i n
the lung.
i.6 pAobably
inteAest
to the
complementaAy
mediators
constAuctive
iield
themes
(Lyon)
immunologists,
in the
inhlammation
ALVEOLITIS
J.F.CORDÏER
subjects
oh the
Alveolitis
a veAy
biochemists,
pulmonaAy
AeheAAed
( B e t h e s d a ) and
inhlammatoAy
exciting
IN INFLAMMATORY
of
factors
populations
fragments
220 derived
from
diseases are
the
or i m m u n e
examples
tactic
of
substances,
Oxydant s are which are vation,
highly
cellular
of
membranes. of
lung
direct
infectious
pulmonary of
fibrosis
these
chemo-
extracellular
Oxygen
by
nization,
will
deficiency),
region part
injury
mechanism
of
still
of
and
taken the
lung
the lungs
no-
inacti-
is
of an
There are
enzymes.
enzy-
: superoxyde Apart
susceptible structures
to
from lower
can derange
if a n t i p r o t e a s e
inactivated
or w h e n
collagen
proteases,
oxydants is s t i l l
of
and
activity are
I),
collagen
is
and
im-
elastase, the
orga-
types,
connective
proteases
debated,
in
the
also
for a b o u t
4 0 X of
turns the
to
the
cells
f i b r o b l a st. of
lung
This
cell
inter stitium,
and
matrix.
intersmajor
underterminated.
Attention
is
absent
release
will alter
to t h e
the
(functional
proteases
attachment
by
enzyme
peroxydation
of o x y g e n
distribution
cell
of
metabolism
when antiproteases
or
neutral
source
oxygen
such as
(directed against
activator,
relative
occur
both
antiproteases.
in a l v e o l a r
deficiency)
repartition
the
oxydants are
This
Collagenase
plasminogen
of
for
radicals
the lung,
of
structures.
to f i b r o s i s .
inactivating
(which
to i n j u r y
first
lipid
and glutathione
of
"CI a n t i t r y p s i n portant.
derange
free
matrix
antitrypsin
and
toxicity
leading
present
not s u f f i c i e n t .
the
cells
proteases,
toxic activities
catalase,
when
as
products
with DNA,
injury
defences
Proteases
contribute in e x c h a n g e
considered
toxic activity,
alveolar
titial
in
alveolitis
oxydants and
defences against
dismutase,
will
matrix
reactive
interactions
example
The
are i.e.
capable
spaces,
state)
extracellular
Polymorphonuclears
(s^l
in i d i o p a t h i c the p r o d u c t i o n
in a l v e o l a r
in an a c t i v a t e d
matic
for
Bacteria
factors.
cells and xious
system.
complexes
stimuli
Whai a c c u m u l a t e d are
complement
account and
it
221 produces
most
Alveolar
macrophage
alveolar
fibroblasts
factor
for
part
of
connective
may
modulate
by
fibroblasts.
which
blasts.
The
of
bolic
colJagen After
takes a part
functions and
of
its
reviewing
the
discussion
focused
in c l i n i c a l
predicting
those
is d i f f i c u l t
cells
on the
lable. Actually,
both
gallium
together
and
¿7
scan,
pathologic
evaluating
the
risk
The
with
findings,
are of
of
enzyme
for
fibro-
as
the
meta-
both
collagenase).
is
the
data
X-ray,
the m o s t a c c u r a t e
that
fibrosis
indicator
lavage
alveolitis.
wall
inflammatory
of d e v e l o p i n g
clinical,
of growth
research,
conclusion
no d e f i n i t e
bronchoalveolar
intensity
as well
of l u n g
evaluation at
a
macrophages
of p r o d u c i n g
degrading
subjects
since
rate
in t h e a l v e o l a r
(capable
practice.
patients
to a s s e s s
alveolar
in f i b r o g e n e s i s ,
specifically
alveolitis
replication
is a c h e m o a t t r a c t a n t
fibroblasts
the a b o v e
matrix.
(when activated)
Furthermore,
fibronectin,
probably
the
releasing
produce
increase
extracellular
is
avai-
and
functional methods
for
222
IDIOPATHIC PULMONARY FIBROSIS. MULTIPARAMETRIC EVALUATION OF ALVEOLAR LYMPHOCYTE AND MACROPHAGE ACTIVATION.
JF MORNEX, G CORDIER, B LAHNECHE, J PAGES, P CHAUVOT, JM VERGNON, T WIESENDANGER, R LOIRE, M VINCENT, JF CORDIER, F MORNEX, JP REVILLARD, and J BRUNE.
Centre de Cytofluorométrie, UER de Biologie Humaine & INSERM U 80, ERA CNRS 782, Pavillon P, Hôpital Edouard Herriot, 69374 Lyon Cedex 08,France Service de Mëdecine Nucléaire, Centre Léon Bérard. Laboratoire d'hématologie, d 1 anatomo-pathologie & d'exploration fonctionnelle respiratoire, and service de Pneumologie, Hôpital Louis Pradel.
Idiopathic pulmonary fibrosis (IPF) is a chronic disease of the lung of unknown etiology. It includes inflammation of the alveolar structure, and interstitial fibrosis. The alveolitis of IPF is characterized by a combination of mononuclear phagocytes, lymphocytes and neutrophils (1). The neutrophil component of the alveolitis can mediate the alveolar derangement of IPF and is considered to play a major role in the pathogenesis of the disease. But some IPF patients have a predominantly
lympho-
cytic alveolitis and a better response to corticosteroid treatment (2). As it is the case in sarcoidosis and hypersensitivity pneumonitis, IPF lymphocytic alveolitis can be critical in the development of lung fibrosis. In order to estimate the intensity of alveolitis in IPF patients we studied in parallel lung lymphocyte and macrophage activation.
Patients and methods
Eleven patients (5 women, 6 men, mean age 61.9 /_ 37 - 76 _ / ) were studied. The diagnostic criteria of IPF (2) were : breathlesness, widespread end respiratory rales, diffuse reticular or reticulo-nodular pattern on the chest Xray and consistent physiologic features with a low diffusing capacity and exercice hypoxia (FVC = 92.5 + 22.8 % predicted, FEV 1 =
M a r k e r Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
224 89.6 + 25.0, DLCO/AV = 84.3 + 20.7, exercise Pa 02 = 7.8. + 1.3) and a decrease compliance in 3/8 patients. Other known causes of chronic lung shadowing, such as inhaled inorganic or organic dusts, sarcoidosis or medications mere excluded. Histological confirmation was obtained by transbronchial lung biopsy from 5 patients (including the 3 patients with normal Xray). The follow up of the patients revealed reversal of the disease and improvement under corticosteroid treatment in 5 of them. 2) Lung lymphocyte activation was measured on cells from bronchoalveolar lavage as previously described (3). The criteria (4) were
of T cell activation
presence of large T cells, expression of HLA DR antigens on
T lymphocytes, labelling by monoclonal antibodies directed against in vitro activated lymphocytes (MLR 1-3), the study was performed by flow cytometry using immunofluorescence labelling with monoclonal antibodies (5). Various cell types were identified by their light scattering properties. Simultaneous measurement of DNA and RNA content by acridine orange staining was used for cell cycle analysis. Lymphocyte proliferation was evidenced by an increased percentage of cells in S + G2 + M phases of the cell cycle (6). 3) Lung macrophage activation was assessed by in vivo Ga 67 uptake (1,7). Each patient received 2 m Ci of Ga 67 citrate intravenously 48 or 72 H prior to scanning. A whole body imaging was obtained with an Angers' tomoscintigraphic camera. A semi-quantitative index was computed according to Line and Crystal (1).
Results. 1) Patients with IPF were characterized by an increase percentage of BAL lymphocytes (50.6 + 24.7) that were mainly T cells (38.9 + 10.4 % of total cells). Blood lymphocytes showed a decreased percentage of cells identified byt 0KT4 and 0KT8 markers, respectively 36.4 + 16.7 and 20.0 + 15.3, US 54.6 +.9.6 and 30.9 + 7.8 in 34 healthy controls, and an increased 0KT4/0KT8 ratio(3.9 + 4.3, US 1.9 + 0.7). Conversely
225 these values in BAL lymphocytes were not significantly different
from
control blood (0KT4 : 45.6 + 12.3, 0KT8 : 30.0 + 9.2, 0KT4/0KT8 : 1.6 + 0.5).
2) Activated T lymphocytes mere identified in the BAL of 3 patients by the presence of large T cells (1 case), MLR positive cells (2 cases) and HLA DR positive T cells (1 case). Lymphocyte proliferation was observed in two of these three patients
: up to 10 % of the lymphocytes were in
the S + G2 + M phases. In one patient lymphocyte proliferation was no longer detectable after 6 months of corticosteroid
treatment.
3) Macrophage activation was demonstrated in 10/11 patients by an index over 50 (117.3 + 6 3 . 9 / 5
investigated
- 230_/ . Comparison between lym-
phocyte and macrophage activation revealed no discrepancy within IPF patients.
Comments
From a series of 16 IPF patients (excluding collagen vascular
disease
associated IPF) admitted in a two year period, 11 had a lymphocytic alveolitis. Lung gallium scanning demonstrated macrophage activation in all cases but one. Activation of alveolar T cells was demonstrated in all cases available for bronchoalveolar lavage lymphocyte studies. It was associated with lymphocyte proliferation in two patients. These investigations are presently extended to a larger group of patients. The preliminary results reported here suggest that macrophage
activa-
tion may be associated with T lymphocyte activation. Whatever the yet unknown triggering signal, interactions between these two cell types are likely to play a critical role in the development of the disease. Measurement of lymphocyte and macrophage activation allows to monitor the alveolitis of patients. Since assessing the effect of treatment according to physiologic data is difficult over a short period of time the monitoring of the alveolitis would have to be useful (8). A combination of lymphocyte and macrophage activation measurements can be per-
226 formed routinely and sequentially in the course of the disease.
Aknowledgments
: we thank G. Corte, L. Moretta and J. Brochier for mono-
clonal antibodies and C. Quintin for secretarial
assistance.
References
1. Crystal,R.G, Gadek, J.E., Ferrans, V.J., et al : Am. J. Med. 70 542-568 (1980) 2. Rudd, R.M., Haslam, P.L., Turner-Warwick, M. : Am. Rev. Respir. Dis. 124, 1-8 (1981) 3. Mornex, J.F., Cordier, G., Pages, J. et al : Monographs in allergy in press 1983 4. Mornex, J.F., Cordier, G., Revillard, J.P. 11, 293-300 (1983)
: Rev. fr. Mai. Resp.
5. Cordier, G., Mornex, J.F., Lefebvre, R. et al : in Poncelet Ed. Cytofluorometrie et anticorps monoclonaux dans le suivi des therapeutiques. In press 1983 6. Pacheco, Y., Cordier, G., Perrin-Fayolle, M., et al : Am. J. Med. 73, 82-82 (1982) 7. Mornex, J.F., Lahneche, B., Mary, P., et al : Lyon Med. in press 1983 8. Keogh , B.A., Bernardo, J., Hunninghake, G.W., et al : Am. Rev. Respir. Dis. 127, 18-22 (1983)
THE ALPHA1] PROTEINASE INHIBITOR OF THE LOWER RESPIRATORY TRACT. EFFECT OF CIGARETTE SMOKING
A.Pelletier, M.B., C.Boudier PH.D., G.Pauli M.D., J.G.Bieth PH.D. Service de Pneumologie (Prof.E.ROEGEL), C.H.U., B.P. 426 67091 STRASBOURG and INSERM Unité 237, Faculté de Pharmacie, U.L.P., B.P.10,67048 STRASBOURG CEDEX (France)
Cigarette smoking is an important risk factor of pulmonary emphysema. In vitro experiments document on cigarette smoke-induced inactivation of alpha-] proteinase inhibitor (djiPl) (1), a protein which is thought to protect the Lung against neutrophil elastase as shown by the association between emphysema and inherited ^1PI deficiency (2). Neutrophil elastase itself is able to induce pulmonary emphysema in animals models (3). We studied the in vivo effect of cigarette smoking ont^-|PI activity of the lower respiratory tract fluid collected by bronchoalveolar lavage (BAL).
Methods The studiedpopulation consisted of twenty healthy volunteers divided in two equal groups : ten smokers (8 ± 5 pack years) and ten non smokers (mean age 28 ± 9 years). To the best of our knowledge, the smokers did not smoke for at least 24 hours before BAL. BAL was performed as usually described using five 60 ml aliquots of sterile 0.9 X saline for each BAL. The fluid recovered was centrifuged and the supernatant frozen at -30°C until concentration ca five-times by Amicon UM2 ultrafiltration at +4°C. In 17 volunteers, serum was obtained by venous punction just before BAL. Porcine pancreatic elastase isolated by us (4) was 95-98% active as assessed by active site titration (5,6). The elastase inhibitory capacity of serum and lavage fluid was measured using the kinetic method described in the figure Legend.
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
228 Serum and Lavage fluid levels ofc^iPI and albumin were determined by radial
immunodiffusion.
Results
Reaction of increasing amounts of serum with constant amounts of porcine pancreatic elastase yields a straight inhibition curve up to at least 80% inhibition (see the figure). Since oj-]PI is the only porcine pancreatic elastase inhibitor present in human serum (7), elastase can be used to titrate serum ¿ ^ P I , if the association betweenojiPI and elastaseiias gone to completion i.e. if serum + elastase mixtures have been preincubated long enough prior to addition of substrate (8). The preincubation time we used is 90 minutes. For the sake of clarity, we have expressed the serum and lavage fluid concentration in reaction medium in mole of immunoreactiveC^iPI per mole of elastase
(see the figure). As expected for a 1 : 1 c ^ P I
: elastase
stoichio-
metry (8), the serum inhibition yields an equivalence point of 1.03. By contrast the lavage fluid curve yields an equivalence point of 2.33. This indicates that 58% of the immunoreactiveo'ilPI
is inactive on elastase.
The table lists the results obtained for the twenty healthy
subjects.
We use albumin as reference protein. There is no difference in immunoreactivec\lPI between smokers and non smokers. The last column lists the number of moles of elastase inhibited per mole of
of the table immunoreactive
0^-|PI. This is the fraction of functionally activedy|PI. It can be seen that the lavage fluid non smokers and smokers contains 38% and 54% of activeC^qPI respectively
(this«, f i gures are not significantly
different).
Discussion
Our data are at variance with those published by GADEK et al (9) and CARP et al (10) who claim that non smokers have fully activeC^iPI in their vage fluids whereas smokers have significantly reduced levels of
la-
functio-
nal(^iPI. The use of completely different methodologies may account for the
229 FIGURE
MOLEodPl/MOLE
ELASTASE
Inhibition of porcine pancreatic elastase by the serum and the BAL fluid from a subject. Increasing amounts of fluid were added to constant amounts of elastase contained in a spectrophotometer cuvette. After 90 minutes, the time required for complete association of elastase w i t h d ^ P I ,
constant
amount of succinyl-Ala3-p-nitroanilide was added to measure the activity of non inhibited elastase
(12).
TABLE IMMUNOREACTIVE ALBUMIN A N D ^ P I AND ELASTASE INHIBITORY CAPACITY OF BAL FLUIDS AND SERUM (MEAN ± SD) .
MOLE cV]PI/M0LE ,M0LE OF ELASTASE ALBUMIN x 1 0 2 INHIBITED PER MOLE OF «t-jPI
ALBUMIN (pM)
LAVAGE FLUID
0.64 ± 0.28
9.3 ± 3.1
0.38 Í 0.14
SERUM
590
i
30
5.9 Í 0.76
0.94
0.45
t
0.16
9.3 ± 2.6
0.54 ± 0.15
600
t
40
6.0 Í 0.9
0.98 ± 0.08
NON S M 0 K E R S
LAVAGE
FLUID
SMOKERS SERUM
t
0.08
230 divergent results. Another explanation may be that our smokers did not smoke 24 hours before lunglavage whereas in one of the reports
(10)they
were "permitted to smoke up to the time of the Lavage". It would suggest that oxydi zed 0I1PI is rapidly regenerated by in vivo reducing systems (11) We do not know yet why, in our hands, 50% of immunoreactive
has
its functional activity and why other investigators find100%
lost
active
This work was supported by grants from INSERM (CRL 815021, CRL 815030 and CP 810121) and Fondation pour La Recherche
Médicale.
References
1. CARP H., JAN0FF A. : Amer. Rev. Resp. Pis.,118, 617-621
(1978)
2. LAURELL C.B., ERIKSSON S. : Scand. J. Clin. Lab. Invest.,J_5, (1963)
132-140
3. JAN0FF A., SLOAN B., WEINBAUM G., DAMINA0 V., SANDHAUS R.A., ELIAS J., KIMBEL P. : Amer. Rev. Resp. Dis., 115, 461-478 (1977) 4. SH0TT0N D.M. : Methods. Enzymol., _19, 113-140
(1970)
5. WINNINGER C., LESTIENNE P., DIMIC0LI J.L., BIETH J.G. : Biochim. Biophys. Acta, 526, 227-234 (1978) 6. POWERS J.C., GUPT0N B.F. : Methods. Enzymol., 46, 208-216,
(1977)
7. MEYER J.F., BIETH J.G., METAIS P. : Clin. Chim. Acta, 62, 43-53
(1975)
8. BEATTY K., BIETH J.G., TRAVIS J. : J. Biol. Chem., 2^5, 3931-3934 9. GADEK J.E., FELLS G.A., CRYSTAL R.G. : Science, 206, 1315-1316
(1980)
(1979)
10. CARP H., MILLER F., HQIDAL J.R., JAN0FF A. : Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci . (USA) 79, 2041-2045 (1982) 11. ABRAMS W.R.,. WEINBAUM G., WEISSBACH L., WEISSBACH H., BROT N. : Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. (USA), 78, 7483-7486 (1982) 12. BIETH J.G., SPIESS B., WERMUTH C.G. : Biochem. Med., 11, 350-357
(1974)
COLLAGENOLYTIC
Jean Jean
ENZYMES AND
FIBROSIS
François CORDIER, Odette BRUNE, Roger TOURAINE
Centre
Hospitalier
OF
THE
BENZERARA,
Universitaire
LUNG
Yves
de Lyon,
LASNE,
France
Introduction Interstitial the
pulmonary
heterogeneous
Alveolitis,
group
cells
event
sequence
of
least
the
clear,
mic processes GADEK
et al
of
thic pulmonary this
found
but
of
they
lavage
fibrosis,
fluid
But of
respiratory
to
lung
fibrosis.
and
collagenase of
postulated
distress
of
was
patients syndrome
release and
not
in the
dyna-
collagens. present with
it c o u l d activity with
initial
cells
still
patients
collagenolytic
certain
are
the
and
; proteases
disturbances
degradation
fluid
is
for
(1).
immune
These
injury
fibrogenesis
and
diseases of
structures,
tissue
include
(BAL)
denominator
and activation
early
synthesis
condition.
in BAL
and acute
of
(2) d e m o n s t r a t e d
bronehoalveolar for
interstitial
leading
The m e c h a n i s m s
completely
is a c o m m o n
in the a l v e o l a r
two m e d i a t o r s
oxydants.
of
i.e. a c c u m u l a t i o n
inflammatory at
fibrosis
be
in
specific
(CA) w a s
sarcoidosis
(4).
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
the
idiopaalso (3)
232 Patients and
methods
We various usual
studied 40
origin
and
people
(table
lavage
was
and
(1).
; the cell
BME
collagen
supernatant
labelled by
gradient
gel
agarose.
CA
was
was
done
of
I).
carried
out
fluid was frozen
after
diseases using
the
immediately
for C A
suspension
analysis of
the
pellet
medium.
6 0 jil of
analyzed
The a s p i r a t e d
count
Analysis
with
pulmonary
normal
centrifuged in E a g l e
with
Bronchoalveolar procedure
later,
patients
of CA in B A L 1 25 with
I were
unconcentrated
SDS
electrophoresis, was detected
of
tracings,
and measured
collagen
by
: 700
gel and
fluid.
human
37°C The
for
isoelectric
visualization
of
TLC linear
type I 2
samples
electrophoresis,
on a u t o r a d i o g r a p h i e s by
ng of
i n c u b a t e d at
alveolar
polyacrylamide
fractions
fluid
hours were
SDS
focusing
in
degradation
of
analyzer
the LB
gel 2832
Berthold.
Results 1) C A
was
present
2) C A
was
complex.
since a p
to
collagenase ments
at
in
o( f r a c t i o n s
the
weight
fragments
was
with
not
by
shown
at l e a s t
conversion
times
of
was
other with
differential
t h a n 5 X of
is
in
neutral was
characteristic
collagen
correlated
in BAL
more
f l u i d ).
the
initial
Finally,
clears
It i n c l u d e d
(giving
tion). 3) C A
17 p a t i e n t s a s
kinetic degraded
table
I.
proteases,
present, 3/4 a n d
studies
and
1/4 of
in small
frag-
degrada-
molecular
proteases. the cell
presence count
of
(11
polymorphonuclears
polymorphonuof
had
17
patients
no CA
in
BAL
233
P a t i e n t s w i t h CA i n BAL
fluid
P a t i e n t s w i t h o u t CA i n BAL
fluid
R e s u l t s e x p r e s s e d i n jjg c o l l a g e n d e g r a d e d / h o u r / m g a l b u m i n i n BAL f l u i d Interstitial
fibrosis
:
I d i o p a t h i c pulmonary
(7/7)
Control healthy patients
fibrosis
76.1 11.3 486
A s s o c i a t e d with scleroderma
21.6
Associated with hypersensitivity pneumonitis
10.1 1.3
Apical
55.9
fibrosis
Radiation pneumonitis
Sarcoidosis
: (4/4)
4.2 5.0 3.2 2.0
: (4/15)
Eosinophilic
Sarcoidosis
(11/15)
C h r o n i c pneumonia
(3/3)
V a r i o u s pulmonary d i s e a s e s
(6/6)
neoplastic lymphangitis, a s b e s t o s i s , emphysema, mycobacterial infection, bronchiectasis, i a t r o g e n i c cyclophosphamide pneumonitis.
6.3 20.5 5.8 5.8
pneumonia
:
10.9 13.6
Table I - C o l l a g e n o l y t i c a c t i v i t y
D
(3/3)
i n BAL
fluid
iscussion
CA
was
present
in
diseases
of
dered
specific
tures, is
as
exceeding
probably
although the In
which
of
for the
one
of
CA
to
of
patients
and
aetiology.
of
of
interstitial
was its
always
radiation
CA
in
not
alveolar
matrix
fibrosis
fibrosis and
in
proteases
and
interstitial
should
antiproteases
present
origin,
sarcoidosis
of
connective
part
with
therefore
capacities
mechanism
whatever
leads
cases
fluid
origin
respective
study,
fibrosis
few
a
the
development our
BAL
various
in ;
in
is
oxydants
of
radiation it
was
struc-
protection,
still
also
eosinophilic
consi-
derangement,
and
cases
be
in
debated
(5).
pulmonary pneumonitis present
pneumonia,
in
a
those
234 diseases and
being
sometimes
Thus occur
capable
of d e r a n g i n g
including
fibrosis.
collagenolytic in v a r i o u s
specific
mentaux
pulmonary
mediator
(Supported
enzymes of
by a g r a n t
contre
la
interstitial
release
in a l v e o l a r
diseases,
inflammation of C o m i t é
tuberculose
et
in
and
they
structures structures,
are a
non-
alveolitis.
National
et C o m i t é s
les m a l a d i e s
Départe-
respiratoires).
References 1. C r y s t a l RC, Hunninghake
G a d e k JE, F e r r a n s V J , F u l m e r JD, L i n e G W : A m . J . M e d , 70, 5 4 2 - 5 6 8 ( 1 9 8 1 )
BR,
2. G a d e k JE, K e l m a n JA, F e l l s G, W e i n b e r g e r SE, H o r w i t z R e y n o l d s H Y , F u l m e r JD, C r y s t a l RG : N . E n g l . J . M e d , 301, 7 3 7 - 7 4 2 ( 1 9 7 ? )
AL,
3. C o r d i e r J F , L a s n e Y, G r i m a u d JA, T o u r a i n e R : In C h r e t i e n M a r s a c J, S a l t i e l JC, Eds, I X t h I n t e r n a t i o n a l C o n f e r e n c e on S a r c o i d o s i s a n d O t h e r G r a n u l o m a t o u s D i s e a s e s P a r i s , P e r g a m o n Press, 204-208 (1982) 4.
F e i n A M , C h r i s t n e r P, G o l d b e r g SK, L i p p m a n M, A b r a h m s W R , W e i n h a u n G : A m . R e v . R e s p i r . D i s . J_27 ( s u p p l ) , 95 ( 1 9 8 3 )
5.
Snider
GL
: Am.
Rev.
Respir.
D i s . J_27, 5 3 5 - 5 3 9
( 1 983 )
J
ELASTOLYTIC ACTIVITIES AND PROTEINASE INHIBITORS IN SPUTUM FROM PATIENTS WITH CYSTIC FIBROSIS
Jean-Marie Tournier, Jacky Jacquot, Edith Puchelle, Paul Sadoul INSERM Unité 14, Plateau de Brabois, F-54511 Vandoeuvre-1es-Nancy Jean-Pierre Chazalette Hôpital Renée Sabran, Bd Edouard Herriot, F-83406 Giens
Introduction Cystic fibrosis (CF) is characterized by progressive pulmonary impairment associated with purulent sputum, very often contaminated by aeruginosa
Pseudomonas
(Ps aer). As leukocytes and Ps aer are important sources of
proteinases (1, 2), an imbalance between proteinases and their inhibitors in sputum may be an important factor in the pulmonary pathogenesis of this disease. In this study, we attempted to analyse in CF sputum 1) the main elastolytic activities : human leukocyte elastase (HLE) and Ps aer elastase and 2) the main proteinase inhibitors : c^-antitrypsin (aiAT^ derived from serum, and the locally produced bronchial inhibitor (brl).
Materials and methods Patients and bronchial secretions : Bronchial secretions were collected from 8.30 to 9.00 am in 15 CF patients aged 8 to 18, using a method avoiding salivary contamination (3). All subjects were in-patients hospitalized in hôpital Renée Sabran, Giens. The leukocytic and bacteria content of sputum was performed as previously described (4). The remaining sputum was homogenized (5) and a protein extract was obtained using the method of Harbitz et al. (6). Elastases and proteinase inhibitors assays : The total elastolytic
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
236
a c t i v i t y was measured using an elastin agarose diffusion plate (7) containing human lung elastin. Succinyl-trialanine-pNA and elastin-remazol were used as substrates of HLE (8) and Ps aer elastase respectively. For the l a t t e r , the complete inhibition of HLE and cathepsin G was previously obtained by an excess of aiAT. aiAT concentration was measured by rocketimmunoelectrophoresis (9). The electrophoretic mobility of aiAT was compared to a standard serum aiAT using crossed Immunoelectrophoresis. Immunoreactive brl was assessed using an ELISA test (10). The active fraction of brl was determined after dissociation of brl-proteinase complexes by acidification and was expressed as the ratio of brl which inhibited HLE to the immunoreactive brl.
Results and discussion Principal origins of proteinases in sputum are from leukocytes and bacteria such as Ps aer. In our study, leukocyte and Ps aer numerations ranged respectively from 0.4 x 10® to 31.2 x 10^/ml and from 0 to 6.2 x 109/ml. In 8/15 cases, leukocyte numeration was higher than 5 x 106/ml. Ps aer was present in 11/15 sputa and sputum culture yielded Ps aer as the sole isolate from 9 patients. All sputum samples showed a free e l a s t o l y t i c a c t i v i t y on human lung e l a s t i n which was closely correlated to the HLE a c t i v i t y (r = .85, p < .001). That means that the elastase was i n s u f f i c i e n t l y inhibited and that leukocytes played an important part in the local secretion of elastase in CF sputum.Ps aer elastase was detected in 9/11 sputa contaminated by Ps aer. The higher the Ps aer numeration, the higher the a c t i v i t y of Ps aer elastase (r = .85, p < .001). In spite of the generally high numeration of Ps aer, the concentration of active Ps aer elastase was always lower than the concentration of active HLE (0.14 + 0.15 yM and 11.9 + 9.9 yM, respectively). aiAT concentration ranged from 0.037 to 14.8 pM and was closely correlated with the leukocyte numeration (r = .83, p < .001) confirming that a ^ T w a s a
good marker of bronchial inflammation. In all sputum samples, aiAT
was observed as a multiform arc of precipitation and i t s electrophoretic mobility was always less than that of standard serum aiAT, indicating that
237
all aiAT was present either in complex form with different proteinases or in an inactive form, brl i s the main proteinase inhibitor in bronchial lavage f l u i d s obtained from non-infected individuals (12). I t s concentration in CF sputum ranged from 0.76 to 3.47 yM and was not s i g n i f i c a n t l y correlated to leukocyte or Ps aer numeration. The active fraction of brl was very high (124 + 17 %) and did not depend on Ps aer elastase concentration. These results mean that, although in v i t r o experiments demonstrated that brl i s inactivated by Ps aer elastase (13), this inactivation does not necessarily occur in vivo. In summary our results show that, in CF sputum : 1) there i s a marked free e l a s t o l y t i c a c t i v i t y , mainly due to leukocyte elastase. 2) aiAT i s present in complex
or inactive forms. 3) The presence of Ps aer
elastase does not necessarily imply, in vivo, a loss of brl a c t i v i t y . (Supported by grant from AFLM 2.81/3).
References 1.
Morihara, K., Tsuzuki, H.: Infect. Immun. 15, 679-685 (1977).
2.
Ohlsson, K.: B u l l . Europ. Physiopath. resp. 16 (suppl.), 209-222 (1980).
3.
Beck, G., Puchelle, E., Laroche, D., Mougel, D., Sadoul, P.: Bull. Europ. Physiopath. resp. 18, 885-892 (1982).
4.
Puchelle, E., Beck, G., Thevenin, F.: Respiration, 34, 220-231 (1974).
5.
Girard, F., Tournier, J.M., Polu, J.M., Puchelle, E., Beck, G., Sadoul, P.: Clin. Chim. Acta 113, 105-109 (1981).
6.
Harbitz, 0 . , Jenssen, A.O., Smidsrod, 0.: Europ. J. resp. Dis. 6^, 84-94 (1980).
7.
McGi11ivray, D., Burnett, D., Afford, S.C., Stockley, R.A.: Clin. Chim. Acta, 111, 289-294 (1981).
8.
Bieth, J.G., Spiess, B., Wermuth, C.G.: Bioch. Med.lU 350-357 (1974).
9.
Laurel 1, C.B.: Analyt. Biochem. 10, 21-37 (1965).
10.
Tournier, J.M., Jacquot, J . , Sadoul, P., Bieth, J.G.: Anal.Bioch. 131, 345-350 (1983).
11.
Tegner, H.: Acta Otolaryngol. 85, 282-289 (1978).
12.
Johnson, D.A., Carter-Hamm, B., Dralle, W.M.: Am. Rev. respir. Dis. 126, 1070-1073 (1982).
SERUM DERIVED PROTEINS AND ANTIBACTERIAL PROTEINS IN CYSTIC FIBROSIS SPUTUM
Jacky Jacquot, Jean-Marie Tournier, Edith Puchelle, Paul Sadoul Unité de Physiopathologie Respiratoire INSERM U. 14 54511 Vandoeuvre-les-Nancy, France Jean-Pierre Chazalette Hôpital
Renée Sabran, Bd Edouard Herriot
83406 Giens, France
Introduction In cystic f i b r o s i s (CF), the exact factors responsible for the frequent bronchial superinfections are unknown. They could be related to either the rheological abnormalities of sputum due to an abnormal protein content, or to the local
d e f i c i t of antibacterial a c t i v i t y proteins in the
bronchial lumen. The purpose of this study was to investigate the protein composition of sputum in CF patients. The total protein content, the concentration of main proteins with antibacterial
activity
(immunoglobulins A, G, M, bronchial lysozyme and lactoferrin) and serum derived proteins (serumalbumi n and aj antitrypsin) were measured in CF sputum. Results were analyzed taking into account 1) the degree of bronchial superinfection estimated by a quantitative cytobacterial study and 2) the severity of the disease assessed by the Shwachman score.
Materials and Methods 1) Patients : In 17 CF patients aged 8 to 18, sputa were collected from 8.30 to 9.00 a.m. by a protected method avoiding the salivary contamination (1). The c l i n i c a l status of each patient was estimated by the Shwachman score (2).
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
240 2) Technics Cytobacteriological
analysis
: Immediately after their collection, sputum
samples were homogenized with a sterile solution of 2.3 di hydro 1.4 dithiobutane. Bacteria and leukocytes were identified and numerated (3). Protein
analysis
: The protein extract was obtained by centrifugation
(17000 x g, 30 min) of sputum sample previously homogenized by ultra sonic treatment (4) and solubilized by shaking at +4° C for 12h in 0.5 M Nacl in a phosphate buffer (0.07 M pH = 6.0) (5). The total protein content in each extract sputum was determined according to Lowry et al. (6). The concentrations of IgA, lysozyme (LZM), lactoferrin (LF), serumalbumin (SA) and aj antitrypsin (aiAT) were measured by rocket immunoelectrophoresis (7) and IgG, IgM by radial immunodiffusion (8).
Results 1)
Cytobacteriology : All 17 CF sputum samples were found infected. A high bacterial numeration (3.1 + 3.4 x 10^/ml) was generally associated with a high leukocyte numeration (9.2 + 9.0 x 10 3 /yl). aeruginosa,
Pseudomonas
identified in 14 cases out of 17 (82 %) was in mucoid form
in 10 cases (71 %). 11 CF sputa out of 17 were severely superinfected as judged by a leukocyte numeration > 5000/ul associated with a bacterial numeration > 10 8 /ml. 2)
Proteins : In the group of the 11 CF superinfected sputa, the average concentration of total proteins (30.0 + 13.6 g/1) was significantly greater (p < 0.01) than in the group of the CF infected sputa (15.9 + 5.3 g/1). No significant difference was found between the infected and superinfected CF sputa for the main proteins with antibacterial activity except for IgG as shown in fig. 1,(a).
241
Fig. 1 . — Antibacterial activity proteins @ and serum derived proteins in CF infected sputa (I) and CF superinfected sputa (SI) **p < 0.01, NS : not significant.
(b)
On the other hand, the average concentration of serum derived proteins used as markers of bronchial
inflammation (SA and c^AT) in the SI group
was significantly higher (p < 0.01) than that of the group I (fig. 1, High molecular weight proteins such as IgM (PM = 900 000) were found in all CF sputa.
9 /l
Fig.2.- Relationship between the Shwachman score and the concentration of aiAT in CF sputum.
242
The Shwachman scores ranged from 40-76 (mean + SD, 62 + 18). A s i g n i f i c a n t negative c o r r e l a t i o n (r = -0.56 p < 0.01) was observed ( f i g . 2) between the Shwachman score and the concentration of axAT i n CF sputum.
Discussion Our r e s u l t s show that in CF, the bronchial i n f e c t i o n i s not associated i n sputum with marked changes in the concentration of proteins with a n t i bacterial a c t i v i t y . O n the other hand, the bronchial i n f e c t i o n i s accompanied by a severe local inflammation reflected by very high concent r a t i o n of serum derived proteins present i n sputa. The p o s i t i v e c o r r e l a t i o n between the sputum protein content and the s e v e r i t y of the disease suggests that t h i s marked bronchial inflammation may be of c r i t i c a l importance in the pathogenesis of c y s t i c
fibrosis.
References 1. Beck, G., Puchelle, E . , Laroche, D., Mougel, D., Sadoul, P.: B u l l . Europ. Physiopath. resp. 18, 885-892 (1982). 2. Shwachman, H., Kulczychi, L . L . : Am. J. D i s . C h i l d . 96, 6-15 (1958). 3. Beck, G., Puchelle, E . , Polu, J.M.: Rev. frang. Mai. Resp. 8, 357-366 (1980). 4. G i r a r d , F . , Tournier, J.M., Polu, J . M . , Puchelle, E . , Beck, G., Sadoul, P.: C l i n . Chim. Acta 1_13, 105-109 (1981). 5. Harbitz, 0 . , Jenssen, A.O., SmidsriSd, 0 . : Europ. J. Resp. D i s . 61, 84-94 (1980). 6. Lowry, O.H., Rosebrough, N . J . , F a r r , A . L . , Randall, R.J.: J. B i o l . Chem. 193, 265-275 (1951). 7. Laurel 1, G.B.: Analyt. Biochem. 10, 21-37 (1965). 8. Mancini, G., Carbonara, A.O., Heremans, J . F . : Immunochem. 2, 235-254 (1965). 9. Brogan, T . D . , Ryley, H.C., Lynne, N., Janet, Y.: Thorax 30, 72-79 (1975).
ALVEOLAR FIBRONECTIN AND INTERSTITIAL LUNG DISEASES
N. Biot, D. Gindre, R. Harf, F. Maréchal, B. Vercoustre, M. Perrin-Fayolle Service de Pneumologie, C.H.U. Lyon-Sud, F-69230 Saint-Genis-Laval
Introduction Fibronectin (FN), a high molecular weight glyco-protein, plays a major role in cellular homeostasis. FN i s present as well in the extracellular compartment in the plasma (where i t i s also called the cold insoluble protein CIG) as in the c e l l u l a r compartment where i t can be found at the surface or included in the basal membrane of most i n t e r s t i t i a l c e l l s . The question to know i f CIG derives from c e l l u l a r FN is controversory. FN i s synthetized by various types of c e l l s but principally by f i b r o b l a s t s , vascular endothelial c e l l s and macrophages (1). Numerous biological functions have been described : 1) In the i n t e r s t i t i a l t i s s u e , FN represents mainly the f i b r i l l a r matrix between the c e l l s and the connective tissue (specific binding structures to collagen, fibrinogen and c e l l s - especially to macrophages, have been described) (2). Animal experiments have shown that paraquat was able to increase the amount of FN within the alveolar structures and i t s production by the alveolar macrophage. Cancerous cell membranes exhibit a loss in FN, which could explain reduced adhesivity and thus metastatic a b i l i t y FN at least seems necessary in fibroblast replication. 2) Circulating FN acts as a non specific opsonic signal for macrophages by increasing their phagocytic capacity (3). From these data showing that FN was essentially implicated in non specific host defence mechanisms and f i b r o t i c processes, we investigated the possible
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
244
v a r i a t i o n s of FN concentrations within the a l v e o l a r structures during various i n t e r s t i t i a l
lung disturbances ( a l v e o l i t i s and f i b r o s i s ) .
Material and Methods Investigated populations were the following : - 20 young (mean age = 24 years) healthy volonteers, 40 % (8) of which were smokers. - 33 patients with h i s t o l o g i c a l l y proven s a r c o i d o s i s , mean aged of 40 years including 7 smokers. - 14 e x t r i n s i c a l l e r g i c a l v e o l i t i s patients (mean age = 46 y e a r s , 5 smokers). - 15 pneumoconiosis (mean age = 50 y e a r s , 8 smokers). - 8 women undergoing thoracic radiotherapy following breast cancer exerese (mean age = 46 y e a r s , 2 smokers). FN was determined in both serum and broncho-alveolar lavage (BAL) supernatant. BAL was performed as u s u a l l y by f i b r o p t i c method. All
sarcoidosis
patients - except 2 ) underwent a double lavage procedure i . e . a total of 64 supernatants. These 64 samples were divided in two groups : - 24 corresponding to absent a l v e o l i t i s were characterized by a low proportion of lymphocytes ( hydroxyapatite metamorphosis in vitro (11), Because of these features, it is tempting to speculate that BGP plays a role in mineralization of bone. Such a role, however, needs to be demonstrated. Experimental models in vivo have used vitamin K antagonists that induce the production of decarboxylated BGP. Thus, dicumarol treatment decreases the level of BGP in chicken bone, but without alteration of the calcium and phosphorus content of the bone ash (30), Warfarin, an other vitamin K antagonist, can reduce the BGP content of rat bone to 2% of control values, probably because the decarboxylated BGP
285 cannot bind to the mineral phase of bone (31). When rats were maintained from birth to two months of age on this protocol, no impairment of growth, bone structure and mineralization was found (31). More recently however, excessive mineralization characterized by complete fusion of the tibial growth plate and cessation of longitudinal growth have been reported in rats maintained on warfarin from birth to eight months of age (32). A new exciting aspect of the putative function of BGP has been provided by the demonstration of the role of vitamin D in BGP secretion. Where osteosarcoma cells are cultured with physiologic doses of l,25-(OH)2D2 - the most active metabolite of vitamin D - both intracellular and secreted levels of BGP are elevated 6 - to 10 - fold (33) ; this response is due to specific regulation of BGP synthesis since there is no general increase in protein synthesis. Also, the level of serum BGP increases 3 - to 4 - fold following intravenous administration of 1,25(OH)„D- to either young or old rats (34). Rats weaned onto a Ca 2+ - deficient diet exhibit marked increases in serum BGP and in serum 1,25 (OH)^D, while serum BGP is not elevated if the 2+ diet is deficient in vitamin D as well as Ca (35). BGP concentrations in bones from vitamin D - deficient rachitic chickens is decreased (50%) (36), These results emphasize the relationship between vitamin D and BGP in vivo. Finally, BGP has a chemotactic activity. BGP evokes a dose-dependent chemotactic response in human monocytes (37). Osteoclasts derive most likely from circulating monocytes, and there is growing evidence that the recruitment of monocytes for osteo clast development occurs by chemotaxis ; because BGP is directly produced by the osteoblasts, this chemotactic activity of BGP shed a new light on the coupling between bone resorption and bone formation. More recently it has been shown that BGP is also chemotactic for breast cancer cells as well as osteoblast like osteogenic sarcoma cells and causes their unidirectional migration (38).
286
IV. BGP circulates in serum, a) Radioimmunoassay for BGP, Sensitive and specific radioimmunoassays have been developed for bovine (7, 39) and rat (25, 39) BGP. In these animals, serum BGP levels range from 25 ng/ml in the adult cow to 200 ng/ml in the fetal calf and in rats. Because antibody directed against calf BGP crossreacts with purified human BGP (7), measurement of serum BGP in human uses a radioimmunoassay system developed with bovine BGP (7, 40, 41). Price has shown that the molecular weight of plasma BGP is identical to that of BGP extracted from bone, and that both plasma and bone BGP bind to hydroxyapatite with the same affinity, indicating that plasma BGP is fully carboxylated (7, 39, 42). A bovine antibody has been shown to cross react with human, horse, monkey, baboon and cat BGP, but not with dog and mouse BGP (39). We have developed a radioimmunoassay system for measuring serum BGP (40). BGP was extracted from bovine bone in 0.5 M EDTA and purified by gel filtration over Sephadex G-100 and subsequent gradient elution from DEAE-Sephadex A-25. This purified bovine BGP was used for standard and tracer. Tracer was prepared by chloramine-T radioiodination and antiserum to bovine BGP was raised in rabbits. Rabbit antiserum was precipitated by adding goat antiserum to rabbit -globulin. Previous studies have shown that purified bovine BGP and human BGP displace BGP tracer from antibody with equal effectiveness (7). We verified that the presence of BGP in human plasma causes the displacement of tracer from our antibody by demonstrating that standard curves obtained with bovine BGP and with dilutions of human serum were strictly parallel (Fig.l). We also verified that gel filtration of human serum showed a single immunoreactive peak that coeluted with pure bovine BGP (40). With our system, the intra- and inter-assay variations are less than 10% and 7% respectively, the sensitivity of the assay is 0.1 to 0.2 ng of BGP and the concentration of BGP can be determined in > 99% of normal subjects (40).
287
Plasma (ml/tube) 1
5
10
25
5 0 100
200
300
10 08
B/B 0 06 04
0 2
0 Bovine BGP (ng/tube) o-o
Fig, 1 - Standard curve for BGP radioimmunoassay. Dilutions of human plasma and bovine BGP standard show similar reactivity , b) Serum BGP levels in normal subjects. In adults, circulating BGP is lower in females than in males, with mean concentrations ranging from 5 to 10 ng/ml (7,39,30). Values are higher in children (10-30 ng/ml), reach a peak at puberty (up to 40 ng/ml), and then decline to the adult levels (39) . We measured serum BGP in 174 women, 30-94 yr of age, who were randomly selected from the population. We found that serum BGP increased linearly with aging (p 0.75 or it can be normal. The albumin ratio is < 0.65%. In addition to bacterial meningitis, this pattern is found most often in subacute sclerosing panencephalitis, encephalitis, foetal diseases, and multiple sclerosis. An interesting profile which combines the features of the transudative and IgG profiles is observed frequently in Herpes encephalitis. Fig. it:
Degenerative profile [ 31 •
A: serum; B: CSF
This profile, which is often found in children, has not yet been assigned to a specific syndrome [5]. Three major causes can lead to an erroneous interpretation: - The presence in the gamma globulin region of beta traces or of post gamma bands due to a degenerative profile. - The contamination of CSF by blood which will lead to the presence of bands corresponding to hemoglobin A2 and carbonic anhydrase. - A monoclonal or oligoclonal pattern due to serum IgG. Doubtful patterns can be solved by performing an immunofixation with an anti IgG antiserum.
373 In conclusion: In the IgG profiles, the high resolution electrophoresis is more sensitive than the IgG index. In the transudative profiles, the albumin ratio is more significant than the electrophoretic pattern. The simultaneous analysis of the serum is absolutely necessary. In doubtful cases, an immunofixation needs to be performed.
CEREBROSPINAL FLUID FERRITIN : INTEREST AS BIOLOGICAL MARKER OF CENTRAL NERVOUS SYSTEM TUMORS.
Pierre ANTOINE, Roger LATER, Jean-Christophe EYNARD, Françoise DURAND, Bruno MARECHAL, Claude QUINCY Laboratoire de biochimie, Hôpital Neurologique 6 9 003 - Lyon - France
Introduction Many compounds have been proposed as biochemical markers of central nervous system (CNS) tumors and measured in cerebrospinal fluid (CSF) (1, 2, 3). They have been widely investigated and their utility in the diagnosis of tumors and in the monitoring of the treatment is well defined. More recently, ferritin has been investigated in CSF of patients with cerebral infarction or haemorrhage (4), in various neurological disorders with only a few cases of tumors (5) and in lymphoproliferative disorders with CSF infiltration (6). In this study, we have determined blood and CSF ferritin concentration, of control subjects, patients having various neurological disorders and patients having CNS tumors. Then, we have compared ferritin with four other biological markers.
Material and methods Cerebrospinal fluid is obtained by lumbar puncture, blood is collected on the same day. After centrifugation, aliquots are kept frozen at -20°C until analysed. Patients are assigned to one of these three groups : group I is constituted from 22 patients having various minor
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
376 neurological disorders and normal CSF regarding total protein content (< 0,40 g/1) determined by a turbidimetric method with benzethonium chlorid (7), number of cells per liter (< 2.106/1), glucose (3 to 4 mmol/1) and qualitative cytology. They are regarded as control subjects. Group IX is constitued from 98 patients having various neurological disorders and abnormal cerebrospinal fluid. Five classes are distinguished : multiple sclerosis (21), nerve diseases (26), subarachnoidal haemorrhage and haematoma (14), degenerative disorders (8) and other neurological diseases (29). Group III included 44 patients having central nervous system tumors. Ferritin is determined before any surgery or treatment. Four classes are distinguished : primary leptomeningeal tumors (12), primary parenchymal tumors (14), other primary tumors (3) and metastases of carcinoma (15). The assay of ferritin is performed with a sandwich-type enzyme immunoassay method. We have used NEIA Ferritin Kit from New England Immunology Associates^ and each determination has been done in duplicate, including standards and controls. Individual values in each group are shown in figure 1. A 300 »UO
H0"
m;2s
OOOO^AA o O O à&AAA • f l o o o o o AAAAA 0 0 •••••(OOOOOAAAAA
o o o ODO
Figure
.V W
1
Control subjects
2
Neurological disorders :
. multiple sclerosis ( ° ) . nerve diseases (» ) . subarachnoidal haemorrages and hematoma ( » ) . degenerative disorders ( °) . others ( ' ) 3 CNS tumors : . parenchymal Primary tumors ( » ) . Leptomeningeal Primary tumors ( ' ) . Other primary tumors ( • ) . metastases of carcinoma ( • )
377
Results For ferritin, we have determined the mean (4,5 jag/1) and the standard deviation (3,2 /ig/1) for control subjects. Assuming the upper normal limit is mean + 2 SD (10,9 yug/1) ; specificity (fraction of group II patients giving negative results), sensibility (fraction of group III patients giving positive results) and efficiency (fraction of all results that are correct) are calculated. Values are given in table I. Then, we have made a comparison
between ferritin and four
other biological markers determined in our laboratory : Beta glucuronidase (Fluorimetry (8), carcinoembryonic antigen p (CEA - EIA from Abbott ) and polyamines : putrescine and spermidine (HPLC (9)). But for these four markers, the populations are subgroups of those analysed for ferritin (group II : 65 amongst 98 ; group III : 32 amongst 44). Results are given in table I. Specificity
Sensibility
Efficiency
Ferritin
79,6
45,5
69
Putrescine
68,9
60,7
65,8
Spermidine
84,4
55,6
72,6
Beta glucuronidase
85,9
37,8
68,3
C.E.A.
90,7
21,6
65,4
In no case blood levels could explain CSF levels. TABLE I
Discussion Ferritin in CSF seems to be a new biological marker of CNS tumors. Specificity is good except in the case of haemorrhage but we found no correlation between cells count, CSF total proteins content and CSF ferritin concentration ; Halgreen describes the same phenomena. In order to precise our study, specificity should be determined for subjects with bacterial
378 or viral infection of CNS. Sensitivity is weak but better for primary tumors considered as a whole. Performances of ferritin and all of the other markers do not make it possible to recommend any one of them in particular as an absolute tumor marker ; but it seems presently we must use all markers together for the greatest aid in the diagnosis of CNS tumors.
Acknowledgement The authors wish to thank J. SALANDRE and S. DUNAND for their excellent technical assistance.
References 1.
Seidenfeld, J., Marton, L. J. : J.N.C.I. 63, 919-931 (1979)
2.
Schold, S. C., Bullard, D. E. : J. H. Woods : Neurobiology of cerebrospinal fluid. Plenum Press, 539-559 (1980)
3.
Wasserstrom, W. R., Schwartz, M. K., Fleisher, M., Posner, J. B. : Am. Clin. Lab. Sei. 11, 239-251 (1981) Hällgren, R., Terent, A., Wide, L., Bergström, K., Birgegard, G. : Acta Neurol. Scandinav. 61, 384-392 (1980)
4. 5.
Syndic, C. J. M., Collet-Cassard, D., Cambiaso, C. L., Masson, P. L., Laterre, E. C. : J. Neurol. Neurosurg. psychiatry 44, 329-333 (1981)
6.
Vincente, V., Gonzalez, M., Lopez Borrasca, A. : Acta Paediatr. Scand. 71, 325-326 (1982)
7.
Iwata, J., Nishikaze, 0. : Clin. Chem. 25, 1317-1319 (1979)
8.
Gehler, J., Cantz, M., Tolksdorf, L., Spranger, J. : Human Genetik 23, 149-158 (1974)
9.
Seiler, N., Knodgen, B. : J. Chromatogr. 221, 227-235 (1980)
CLINICAL RELEVANCE OF BETA 2 MICROGLOBULIN LEVELS OF THE CEREBROSPINAL FLUID IN CHILDREN WITH ACUTE ENCEPHALITIS Elie Jean Raynaud, François Deméocq, Philippe Vanlieferinghen, Georges Malpuech, Ginette Gaillard. Clinique médicale infantile - Hôtel-Dieu - C.H.U. and Centre Jean Perrin 63000 - Clermont-Ferrand, France
Introduction In acute brain disorders of childhood, clinical, biological and electroencephalographic data do not always allow one to distinguish between non inflammatory encephalopathy which requires a symptomatic treatment and encephalitis which some times requires an antiviral therapy. In a prospective study in children who had miscellaneous neurological disorders, we have found that the cerebroscpinal fluid (CSF) Beta 2 microglobulin (/32m) was significantly increased in acute encephalitis (1). Moreover we have observed an increase in the /32m levels in CSF after prophylactic cranial irradiation in children with hemopathies. This increase of the /32m is correlated to the outbreak of the early post irradiation encephalopathy (3). These findings have led us to study the CSF /32m in children with either encephalitis or non inflammatory encephalopathy in order to differentiate between these two kinds of cerebral disorder. The other biological markers of the cerebral disorder (CSF enzymology and cytomorphology) were also recorded (4, 5). Material and methods The study involved 22 children. 11 of whom (7 males, 4 females average ages 6.5 years) had biologically proved acute inflammatory disorders of the CNS : measles (3), herpetic (2), indetermined viral (1), eosinophilic (2), legionella pneumoniae (1), chiken-pox (2) encephalitis. The other 11 patients (6 males, 5 females average age 3.5 years) had acute ischemic encephalopathy : status epilepticus (4), long lasting severe seizures with transient hemiplegia (7). There were 10 controls, matched for age, admitted for diseases without any neurolo- gical disturbance. The CSF and serum samples were collected once during the periods, between D1-D3, again between D5-D8, and lastly between D12-D15. The /32m was measured using a radio-immunologic assay (phadebas /32 microtest). Lacticodeshydrogenase (LDH) and aspartate amino transferase (ASAT) activities determined by ultra violet spectrophotometry. A cytomorphologic study was performed in the CSF after
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in Germany
380
1000 r.p.m. cytocentrifuging (Shandon centrifuge) by May Grumwald Giemsa staining. Results In the group of patients with encephalitis, we have observed (fig) a clear rise of the CSF 02m at the onset of the disease (3.20 nq/ml ± 0.96 ; p < 0.001 ; controls mean : 0.81 ± 0.35). The levels of the CSF /32m slowly returned to the normal range (D5-D8 : 2.40 ± 0.77 ; D12-D15 : 1.29 ± 0.46). These variations of the CSF /32m levels were not related to the blood levels which remained normal. The LDH and ASAT activities in the CSF were slightly disturbed. For the first three days, the levels increased marginally : LDH : 51.6 ± 15.6 UW (normal mean : 26 ± 5) ; ASAT : 18.1 ± 5 mUI/ml (normal mean : 12 ± 5). They decreased thereafter to their normal levels. These variations were not related to the blood levels which were nomal. The CSF cytology showed a statistically significant cellular reaction which progressively dicreased from D1-D3 to D12-D15, with the lymphocytosis remaining greater than 50 % of the sample during the whole follow up period.
Table : Qualitative cytology < the CSF Encephalitis Encephalopathies D1 to 3 D5 to 8 D12 to 15 D1 to 3 D5 to 8 D12 to 15 Leukocytes count (mm3) Lymphoid cells % Histiomonocytoid cells %
72
34
16
9
14
3
56 27
54 16
50 42
30 52
30 60
20 75
In the group of patients with encephalopathy, we have noticed (fig) no significant changes of the CSF and blood /32m levels. On the other hand, a clear increase of the enzymatic activities was statiscally significant, especially at D5-D8 (LDH : 68.% ± 16.5 ; ASAT : 26.8 ± 5.4 ; p < 0.05). This increase of enzymatic activities was not related to the blood levels. The cellular reaction in the CSF was mild and mainly composed of histiomonocytic cells whose relative percentage was progressively raised from 52 % at D1-D3 to 75 %at D12D15. In both groups, there was a statistically significant linear correlation between the number of leucocytes per mm3 and the level of the CSF (32m (R = 0.64 ; p < 0.0001). Comments These results indicate that the CSF /32m is significantly increased in children with ence-
381
LEUKO/ ß 2M MM 3
L
LDH
4
ENCEPHALITIS
U.W.
60 50
75 40 50
25
30
l
20
10
60 50 75 40 50
30 20
25 10
CONTROL '
DAY I to 3
' DAY 5 to 8
' DAY 12 to 15
Variations of p 2m ( T), LDH (•) and leukocytes count (•) in CSF during encephalitis and encephalopathies.
382 phalitis. The increase of the CSF (32m could be used to diagnose true encephalitic states in the child. In children with encephalopathy no noticable change of the CSF /32m levels was observed during the follow up period. The increase of the CSF /32m probably represents a type of cerebral disturbance different from the one involved in the increase of the enzymatic activities. The increase of the/32m should beattribued to a localized synthesis which is supported by to arguments : first, the CSF /32m rise is not related to the blood levels ; on the other hand, there is a correlation between the levels of the /32m and the cell reaction. Thus, the localized synthesis could have a lymphocytic source. The increase of the CSF enzymatic activities in encephalopathy reinforces the already known concept that is represents a cellular release of enzymes due to a plasma membran injury or due to a cell necrosis, whatever the site of the cell disorder. The /32m molecule seems to be a marker protein, in inflammation of the CNS, useful for the diagnosis of true encephalitis in the large group of acute cerebral disorders in children. References 1 - Deméocq, F., Debost, M., Malpuech, G. and Al. (Abstracts) Archives F. Pédiatrie, 901, 38,1981 2 - Deméocq, F., Malpuech, G., Raynaud, E.J. and Al. N. Engl. Jour, of Medicine, 304, 1366,1981 3 - Deméocq, F., Malpuech, G., Raynaud, E.J. and Al. In pediatric oncology X I I I ^ meeting of the international society of pediatric oncology, Marseille, C. Raybaud. Editors Excepta Medica, 3 5 5 - 3 5 6 , 1 9 8 2 4 - Viallard, J.L., Gaulme, J., Dalens, B. and Al. Clin. Chim. Acta, 89, 4 0 5 4 0 9 , 1978 5- Dalens, B., Bezou, M.J., Raynaud, E.J. and Al. Acta pediatr. Scand., 70, 161-166, 1981
ELECTROPHORETICAL PATTERNS CEREBROSPINAL FLUID.
J.C.
FROT,
F . MÜLLER,
HopiLal Ambroise 9 Avenue Charles
P.
OF A C E T Y L C H O L I N E S T E R A S E
IN
GIRAUDET.
P a r é , L a b o r a t o i r e C e n t r a l de B i o c h i m i e , de G a u l l e , 9 2 1 0 0 B o u l o g n e , F r a n c e .
Introduction. In previous work, we studied the different forms of cholinesterases in human brain during the development of embryo and in adults (acetylcholinesterase, AChE, E.C. 3.1.1.7. and butyrylcholinesterase, BChE, E.C. 3.1.1.8.) The
distribution of molecular forms of enzymes in brain areas was signifi-
c a n t l y different between adults (1,2). One of the factors which could be involved is a specific neurological pathology, and, in this work, we try to demonstrate that a relationship exists between electrophoretical pattern of cholinesterases in cerebrospinal fluid (CSF) and some specific neurolo-gical disorders.
Material and 1)
Methods.
One hundred CSF samples, obtained
by lumbar puncture were collected
from ninety nine patients, and stored at -20°C. Patients' ages start from one day old to 91 years old with 4 newly borns, 31 children and 64 adults. Diagnosis was unquestionably assessed in 70 patients. 2)
Qualitative assay of CSF cholinesterases. Polyacrylamide gel electro-phoresis was carried out using B.5% gels in a LKB Multiphor apparatus with a Tris-glycine pH 8.9 buffer. Gels were preelectrophoresed at 50 mA for 30 minutes. Five ^il CSF were layered in each slit and runs were carried out at 15 V/cm for three hours. Gels were pre-incubated at room temperature in a phosphate buffer pH 7j after 15 minutes they
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in Germany
384 were stained according to the method of Karnovsky and Roots (3),modi-fied as follows: gels were immersed in a phosphate buffer pH 7 contain i n g 0.005 mol/L potassium ferrycyanure, 0.003 mol/1 copper sulphate, and 0.007 mol/1 sodium citrate. After 30 minutes, 0.003 mol/1 of either acetylthiocholine iodine or butyrylthiocholine iodine were added and gels were left overnight. To inhibit BChE activity, tetra isopropyl-pyrophosphoramide (iso 0MPA) was included in the incubation mixture at a concentration of 0.001 mol/1. To inhibit AChE activity, 1.5 bis (4 allyldimethylammonium) pentan 3 one bromide (BW 284C51) was includ e d in the incubation mixture at 0.01 mol/1. The gels u/ere dried and passed through a densitometer to determine the number and density of each band.
3)
Quantitative assay of CSF cholinesterases. Activity of cholinesterases u/as estimated by the photometric method of Ellman et al. (4) applied to the V.P. Abbott apparatus. Inhibitors u/ere used at the same concent r a t i o n . In each sample, proteins were dosed by the method of Lowry and cells counted as to remove hemorragic CSF.
Results. (Figure 1) In general we found two bands: one slow migrating band, not very dense and a second faster moving band which was more dense. But above all we noted a great variability from one band to four bands with large differences in density. The density of bands correlated well with the activity, but corre-lation is weak with total CSF proteins. This variability has no relationship with either age and sex of the patient or any disorder, neurological and non neurological. In one case we found no band at all, but a sample of this patient's serum showed an absence of two bands in comparison to normal serum. Activity in the presence of inhi-bitors confirmed the specificity of CSF
with AChE since bands are totally
inhibited by BW 284C51 and activity remained identical with or without iso 0MPA added to the solution.
385
Figure 1. This picture clearly poi nts out the great variability of CSF cholinesterases ; from one band to three bands at the far right.
Discussion. Despite a relatively large population of common neurological disorders, we are not able to establish a relationship between electrophoretical patterns of cholinesterases and a specific neurological disorder. Numerous facts
for this result have to be noted: the collection of samples by
lumbar puncture could be a source of error if not performed by the same person at the same time on a patient at rest for hours; another difficulty is to define a "normal" CSf. If this is eventually possible for children since a lumbar puncture is easily performed even in the absence of neurological signs, it is quite impossible in a population of adults. Besides these problems, we must also point out that the population studied came from a general hospital and that none of the patient had an illness of the cholinergic pathways, such as Huntington disease. Finally it is known that the brain contains several iso-enzymes of acetylcholinesterase (1,5) and are the methods used in this work precise enough to detect these different forms7 It would be therefore more appropriate to find out if the great variability in our results were not due to the presence of such isoenzymes and we are now continuing our work in that direction. To conclude, and despite of other work in which
electrophoresis of CSF
cholinesterases exhibits a large, unique and diffuse AChE band (6), we found in general, two AChE bands completly inhibited by BW 284C51. Whatever the neurological disorders are, we cannot find any relationship between the illness and AChE bands. We think that CSF obtained by lumbar puncture represents a mixture of AChE secreted by the nervous system
386 from different areas and the only way to demonstrate a specific pattern, if any, is to study the different iso-enzymes.
References. 1. MULLER, F. : Cholinesterases et développement chez 1'homme.Thèse Paris Uli, 1982. 2. VALETTE, F.M., MARSH, D.J., MULLER, F., MASSOULIE, 3. :Comparative affinity chromatography of acetylcholinesterases from five different species. J. Chromatogrphy 257,285-296 (1983). 3. KARNOVSKY, M.J., ROOTS, L. : A direct coloring thiocholine method for cholinesterases. J. Histochem. Cytochem. 12, 219-221 (1964). 4. ELLMAN, G.L., COURTNEY, K.D., ANDREAS, \l., FEATHERSONE, R.M. : A new rapid colorimetric method of acetylcholinesterase activity. Biochem. Pharmacol. 7, 88-95 (1961). 5. CHUBB, I.W., GOODMAN, S., SMITH, A.D.,: Is acetylcholinesterase secreted from central neurons into the cerebrospinal fluid? Neuroscience 1, 57-62 (1976). 6. GUIBAUD, S., SIMPLOT, A., MERCATELLO, A. : CSF Cholinesterase and Guillain-Barré syndrome. Lancet, _2, 1456 (1982).
CHOLINESTERASE ISOENZYMES OF CEREBROSPINAL FLUID AND GUILLAIN-BARRE SYNDROME
A. S i m p l o t , S . Guibaud L a b o r a t o i r e de Biochimie ( S c e Pr Reboud) Hôpital de l a C r o i x Rousse 69317 Lyon France A. M e r c a t e l l o , D. Robert S e r v i c e des I n s u f f i s a n t s R e s p i r a t o i r e s , H ô p i t a l de l a C r o i x Rousse 69317 Lyon France 0. Robert S e r v i c e de N e u r o l o g i e , Hôpital Neurologique Lyon
France
Introduction The d i a g n o s i s o f Gui 11 a i n - B a r r e syndrome r e s t s on c l i n i c a l electromyography and a l b u m i n o - c y t o l o g i c a l
dissociation in
observations, cerebrospinal
f l u i d (CSF) but the causes of t h i s syndrome, the c e l l u l a r and molecular mechanisms i n v o l v e d , remain unknown and the d i a g n o s i s i s not easy. Working on c h o l i n e s t e r a s e isoenzymes, we have observed a s p e c i a l
pattern
i n the cerebrospi nal f l u i d o f these p a t i e n t s .
Material and methods Cerebrospinal
f l u i d specimens - 181 - are obtained by standard lumbar
puncture techniques from 152 p a t i e n t s the r e p a r t i t i o n o f which i s : . m e n i n g i t i e s - 25 . v a r i e d n e u r o l o g i c desorders - 48 (cerebral
v a s c u l a r deseases 5, tetanus 4 , m u l t i p l e s c l e r o s i s 8, me-
t a s t a t i c tumors 3, H o r t o n ' s desease 1, cerebral a t r o p h i e s 3, s e i z u r e s 7, metabolic encephalopathies 3, coma a f t e r cardiac a r r e s t 6, s e p t i c
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
388 encephalopathies
2, P a r k i n s o n ' s desease 1, t r i c y l c i c
cephalopathy 1, p o s t s u r g e r y 1, v i r a l . peripheral
encephalities
antidepressants
en-
3)
n e u r o p a t h i e s - 19 -
( s p i n a l c o r d compression 1, m y e l i t i s suspected p o l y r a d i c u l o n e u r o p a t h i e s
1, p o l y r a d i c u l o n e u r o p a t h i e s
2, p o l y n e u r o p a t h i e s
13,
2)
. o t h e r s - 60(fewer o f undetermined o r i g i n ) Only u n c o l o r e d specimens w i t h o u t b l o o d c o n t a m i n a t i o n are
selected.
C h o l i n e s t e r a s e isoenzymes are s e p a r a t e d by e l e c t r o p h o r e s i s
on 6 p e r cent
p o l y a c r y l a m i d e g e l s by a m o d i f i c a t i o n o f the method o f C l a r k e (1)
: 40 ul
o f CSF mixed w i t h 10 ul o f 40 p e r c e n t s u c r o s e s o l u t i o n are a p p l i e d to each tube which i s run a t 1 mA u n t i l
the albumin-dye marker
(bromophenol
blue) band has m i g r a t e d towards the anode. A f t e r s e p a r a t i o n , the bands o f c h o l i n e s t e r a s e a c t i v i t y appear on the e x t r u d e d g e l s as dense t a t e s a f t e r i n c u b a t i o n o v e r n i g h t i n a medium c o n t a i n i n g iodide
, sodium
precipi-
acetylthiocholine
m a l e a t e , sodium c i t r a t e , s u l f a t e copper and p o t a s s i u m
f e r r i c y a n i d e as p r e c e d e n t l y d e s c r i b e d ( 2 ) . Two i n h i b i t o r s are used w i t h a good degree o f s p e c i f i c i t y cholinesterase
: L y s i v a n e (ethopropazine)
(nS Ch) ( E C . 3 . 1 . 1 . 8 )
methy 1 ammonium p h e n y l - p e n t a n - 3 - o n e )
f o r non s p e c i f i c
and BW 284 C 51 (1-5 b i s - 4 a l l y l d i for acetylcholinesterase
(A ChE)
(EC 3 . 1 . 1 . 7 )
Results On 162 specimens - see Table I - we o n l y observed one l a r g e , d i f f u s e band w i t h a c h a r a c t e r i s t i c m o b i l i t y . but L y s i vane r e s i s t a n t ,
side
T h i s band i n h i b i t e d by BW 284C51
corresponds to the A ChE a c t i v i t y .
On 19 specimens - see Table II - we observed w i t h the A ChE band, an additional
slow band i n h i b i t e d by L y s i v a n e but BW 284C51 r e s i s t a n t
ponding to the nSCh a c t i v i t y .
the Gui 1 l a i n - B a r r e syndrome ( p o l y r a d i c u l o n e u r o p a t h y w i t h gical
dissociation).
corres-
These specimens c o r r e s p o n d to p a t i e n t s
with
albumino-cytolo-
389 Table I : Patient r e p a r t i t i o n and CSF isoenzyme pattern.
Pathologies
n . . Protein (5; - g . r i )
CSF
Patients
Bands » rKr
A
ChE
nSCh
Meningitis
25
33
0,67
+
0
Varied neurologic disorders
48
56
0,54
+
0
Peripheral
19
30
4,25
+
See Table
60
62
0,41
+
0
neuropathies
Others
Table I I
: Peripheral neuropathies and CSF isoenzyme pattern
Patients
CSF
Spinal cord compression
1
3
55
10,03
+
0
Myelitis
1
1
2
0,14
+
0
Polyradiculoneuropathies (with albumino-cytological d i s s o c i a t i o n )
10
18
4
2,38
+
+
Polyradiculoneuropathies (with low increased CSF proteins)
2
3
2
0,44
+
0
2
2
12
1,5
+
1+ lo
Polyradicul oneuropathy (4 monthes later)
1
1
2
0,53
+
0
Polyneuropathies
2
2
2
+
0
Pathologies
Suspected p o l y r a d i c u l o neuropathies ?
Leuk. Protein (Mega T 1 ) ( x - g l " l )
25,6
Bands A ChE nSCh
II
390
An uninterpretable pattern i s obtained in case of blood contamination see photo 1. Photo 1 Cholinesterase
isoen-
zyme pattern i n CSF. From l e f t to r i g h t : .two "standard" CSF .CSF from Guillain-Barre .blood contaminated CSF
We have observed the nSCh band only in the cases of polyradiculoneuropathy with high level of CSF proteins and albumino-cytological
dissociation.
This band does not appear neither for the unfortunately alone patient punctured 4 monthes l a t e r when the c l i n i c a l
symptoms are normalized,
nor for the polyradiculoneuropathies with low increased CSF p r o t e i n s . This band i s not only related to high level of CSF proteins since i t i s not observed in the cases of polyneuropathies and spinal
compression
with very high level of CSF p r o t e i n s . Now, no mechanism explanation may be proposed but A ChE isoenzyme separation might be a help in d i f f i c u l t c l i n i c a l
context.
References 1. Clarke, J.T. : Ann. N. Y. Acad. S c i . , 121, 428-436
(1964).
2. Guibaud, S . , Simplot, A . , Bonnet, M., Thoulon, J.M., Guibaud, P . , Robert, J.M. : J. Genet, hum., 30, 119-134 (1982).
LYMPHOCYTOTOXIC AND MONOCYTOTOXIC ANTIBODIES IN MULTIPLE SCLEROSIS
1 2 1 Lucien Rumbach , Marie-Marthe Tongio , Jean-Marie Warter , 1 1 2 Christian Marescaux , Maurice Collard , Simone Mayer 'clinique Neurologique, Hospices Civils de Strasbourg 2
Institut d'Hematologie, Hospices Civils de Strasbourg et Centre de Transfusion Sanguine, 67091 Strasbourg Cédex,France
Introduction Terasaki et al (3) demonstrated cold lymphocytotoxic antibodies (LCA) in the serum at 15°C of patients suffering from disseminated lupus erythematosis. This cytotoxic activity was different from that of the HL-A allo-antibodies ; since then it has been reported in many conditions which have often as a common factor a disturbance of the immune system (1). We have recently studied warm and cold lymphocytotoxic and monocytotoxic antibodies in the serum and cerebrospinal fluid (CSF) in multiple sclerosis (MS) (2).
Materials and methods This study comprised 21 patients with "clinically definite" form of MS. For controls, serum of 32 healthy blood donors, and serum and CSF of 6 patients suffering from diseases other than MS were studied. Detection of antibodies in serum and CSF was done by a modified microlymphocytotoxic technique of Terasaki and Mc Clelland (2). Serum and CSF of each MS and
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
392 non-MS patient were tested at 15 and 37°C with their total lymphocytes (TL), B lymphocytes (BL), monocytes (M) autocells and then with fresh TL, BL, M alio cells of healthy blood donors. Tests were performed before and after absorption on platelets. If more than 20 % of the cells were stained with eosin, the reaction was considered to be positive.
Results 1) patients with MS. - serum : results are summarized in Table 1. Table 1 Cytotoxic
activity
In the. ie.Jiu.rn o{
MS
tested in the presence of following allocells 15°C
sera TL
The
37 °C M
BL
TL
BL
M
9 cases
-
-
-
-
-
-
4 cases
+
+
+
-
-
-
3 cases 4 cases 1 case
+
+
+
-
-
+
+
+
+
-
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
itiength
+ positive
ofi the reaction,-
reaction negative
Ii
not
Indicated
In thli
table.
reaction.
The search for cytotoxic antibodies was negative in 9 cases, at 15 and 37°C. The sera of the other 12 MS reacted positively at 15°C but there were differences at 37°C : 4 patients reacted negatively to TL, BL and M, 3 reacted negatively to TL, BL but positively against M, 4 negatively to TL and positively against BL, M and one serum reacted positively against TL, BL and M. After absorption on platelets, the number of positive reactions was reduced. Only 6 of the 21 MS
393 sera contained autoantibodies. - CSF : results were very different. The reactions were positive against autocells and allocells in all the samples tested, at 15 and 37°C. 2) patients with other diseases : no cytotoxic activity was detected in 5 sera. However the CSF cytotoxic activity of all 6 patients was strongly positive to alio- and autocells. In the absence of complement, the reaction against M was positive at 37°C, the tests against TL and BL were negative. 3) healthy controls : 5 of the 32 sera tested were positive. No auto antibodies were found in the serum. 4) clinical and biological parameters : no relation was established between cytotoxic activity and various clinical parameters. We noted no correlation between CSF albumin, CSF immunoglogulin and HL-A typing and the cytotoxic activity.
Discussion Cold lymphocytotoxic antibodies are found mainly when there is some alteration of the immun system, but their role is still unknown and their site of cellular action is also controversial. They have been observed in the serum of 30-67 % of MS patients ; our work confirmed this occurence. However this study demonstrated that : 1) the cytotoxic activity was directed not only against total lymphocytes but also, and predominantly, against monocytes ; 2) some of these antibodies were detected not only at 15°C but also at 37°C ; 3) tests were positive with allocells but in certain patients with autocells ; 4) reactions were strongly positive in all
394 CSF studied. As this activity is directed against 3 cellular populations, it involves probably not one type of antibody. These antibodies may play a role in immunomodulation ; further investigation of antibody effects on MS lymphocyte subpopulations is warranted.
References 1. Mayer, S., Falkenrodt, A., Tongio, M.M. : Ann. Immunol., 126 C, 621-627 (1975) . 2. Rumbach, L., Tongio, M.M., Warter, J.M., Marescaux, C., Mayer, S., Rohmer, F. : J. Neuroimmunol., 3, 263-273. 3. Terasaki, P.I., Mottironi, V.D., Barnett, E.V. : N. Engl. J. Med., 283, 724-728 (1970).
INTEREST OF A HIGH RESOLUTION AGAROSE GEL ELECTROPHORESIS SYSTEM (PANAGELR) WITH A SILVER STAINING REVELATION IN THE STUDY OF CEREBROSPINAL FLUID (C. S. F.) IMMUNOGLOBULIN G
Elisabeth Plan, Jean-Bernard Seneterre, Claude Quincy Laboratoire de biologie - Hôpital Neurologique - 59,boulevard Pinel - 69 003 LYON
Introduction Demonstration of oligoclonal bands by CSF proteins
electro-
phoresis (1) is an important aid in establishing the diagnosis of chronic inflammatory diseases of central nervous system (C.N.S.). In this report, we compare two systems : - high resolution agarose gel system (Panagel ) with silver staining - polyacrylamide disc gel electrophoresis.
Material 150 CSF samples were studied from : - 85 patients with multiple sclerosis (M.S.) 5 patients with subacute sclerosing panencephalitis (S.S.P.E.) 3 patients with neurosyphilis -
and 57 reference patients with various non inflammatory
other neurological diseases. CSF were stored at + 4°C ; it is known that keeping samples longer than one week may alter oligoclonal pattern : generally the bands become diffuse or disappear.
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
396
Methods . Polyacrylamide (P.A.A.) disc gel electrophoresis : Electrophoresis, using a discontinuous system, is carried out in vertical gels according to the method described by Ornstein (2) and Davis (3). It requires 0,6 ml of unconcentrated C.S.F., concentration occuring in situ during electrophoresis. Because of the high power of resolution of P.A.A., electrophoretic patterns, stained with amido black, give many informations. But their interpretation is difficult due to many bands which are not immunoglobulins but migrate in the gamma zone (haptoglobin polymers ; carbonic anhydrase). . High resolution agarose gel electrophoresis : Agarose gel electrophoresis using Panagel out as described by Johanson
system is carried
(4).
Due to the high sensitivity of the silver staining (5) , this method requires only 7 ul of unconcentrated C.S.F. This technic presents several advantages versus P.A.A. : - easiness of handling - speed of realisation - smaller initial volume of sample - high resolution power in the gamma globulin area which makes agarose a useful supporting medium to demonstrate gamma bands. Electrophoretic patterns, obtained by the two methods, were examined in simple blind to search the presence of oligoclonal bands without knowledge of the patients' identity or the result given by the other system. For each system, we calculated sensitivity and specificity (6): . Sensitivity : was defined at 100 times the number of patients with M.S. who had positive tests (presence of oligoclonal bands) divided by the sum of this number plus the number of patients who had negative results (absence
397
FIGURE
:
-C.S.F.
electrophoretic
-Multiple
-Non
Sclerosis
inflammatory
patterns :
from
A
Agarose
C
P.A.A.
other
patients gel gel
neurological
B
Agarose
D
P.A.A.
with
. diseases
gel gel
.
:
:
398
of oligoclonal bands). . Specificity : was defined at 100 times the number of patients having no M.S. who had negative tests divided by the sum of this number plus the number of patients without M.S. who had positive tests .
Results High resolution agarose gel system revealed oligoclonal bands for 57 of the 85 patients with M.S. (sensitivity : 67 %) ; P.A.A. gel revealed bands only for 43 of them (sensitivity : 50,5 %) . For the 57 reference patients, agarose gel demonstrated extra bands in the gamma region for 9 of them (specificity : 77 %) ; with P.A.A. gel in 13 cases (specificity : 73 %). We did not include in our calculations cases of S.S.P.E. and neurosyphilis which are known for their local production of IgG. Oligoclonal aspect was found in all the C.S.F. from S.S.P.E. (5 cases) and neurosyphilis (3 cases) when agarose gel was used. P.A.A. showed oligoclonal bands in all the cases of neurosyphilis, but only in 3 out of 5 cases of CSF from S.S.P.E. patients.
Discussion We evaluated the performance of 2 electrophoretic methods to reveal the presence of oligoclonal bands in demyelinating diseases as M.S. The high resolution agarose system is more sensitive : 67 % (P.A.A. : 50,5 %) and more specific : 77 % (P.A.A. : 73 %).
399
The apparent "false positives" should not be viewed as diminishing the value of the test. Oligoclonal bands represent locally produced immunoglobulins of restricted heterogeneity which are known to occur in the electrophoretic patterns from CSF of patients with bacterial and viral encephalitis, Guillain Barré syndrome, etc... (7,8,9,10) P.A.A. is not as sensitive as agarose gel to reveal the oligoclonal aspect, particularly in the study of C.S.F. from S.S.P.E. patients. In this case, the absence of information results in the loss of gammaglobulins which migrate in very cathodical position.
Conclusion Comparison of two electrophoretic methods using different support mediums permitted to confirm the superiority of high resolution agarose gel for routinely qualitative study of CSF gamma globulins in clinical laboratories. High resolution agarose gel system with silver staining is more pratical and more performant than P.A.A. gel to demonstrate oligoclonal IgG locally produced in chronic inflammatory C.N.S. disorders.
References 1.
Gerson, B.,Krolikowski, F. I., Gerson, I. M. : Clin. Chem. 26/2 , 343-345 (1980)
2.
Ornstein, L. : Ann. N. Y. Acad. Sci. 121 , 321-349 (1964)
3. 4.
Davis, B. J. : Ann. N. Y. Acad. Sci. 121 , 404-427 (1964) Johansson, B. G. : Scand. J. Clin. lab. Invest. 29^ , suppl. 124, 7-19 (1972)
5.
Kerenyi, L., Gallyas, F. : Clin. Chim. Acta 3¡8 , 465-467 (1972)
400 6.
G e r s o n , B., C o h e n , S. R., G e r s o n , 2. M . , G u e s t , G. H. : C l i n . C h e m . 2 7 / 1 2 , 1 9 7 4 - 1 9 7 7 (1981)
7.
L a t e r r e , E. C . , C a l l e w a e r t , A . , H e r e m a n s , J. S. : N e u r o l . 20 , 9 8 2 - 9 9 0 (1970)
8.
L i n k , H . , M u e l l e r , R.
9. 10.
: A r c h . N e u r o l . 25^ , 326-344
(1971)
: Ann. Neurol. 2 , 425-431
(1977)
J o h n s o n , K . , N e l s o n , B.
J o h n s o n , K., A r r i g o , S. C . , N e l s o n , B . J. e t al. : N e u r o l o g y 27 , 2 7 3 - 2 7 7 (1977)
TWO DIMENSIONAL ELECTROPHORESIS OF CSF PROTEINS : ELECTROPHORESIS QUALITY CONTROL
Salma Gehamy, Sylvie Reynier, Christiane Caudie, Claude Quincy Laboratoire de biologie (Professeur Quincy) - Hôpital Neurologique, 59, boulevard Pinel - 69 003 - LYON
Introduction A high resolution two dimensional gel electrophoresis procedure has been developed for the analysis of complex mixtures of proteins (O'Farrell 1975). By combining isoelectric focusing (IEF) in the first dimension with sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS) gel electrophoresis in the second dimension, proteins are separated according to isoelectric point and molecular weight- This technique is an extremely powerful investigative tool for analysis of CSF proteins. We report electrophoresis quality control data for our two dimensional gel electrophoresis system to allow the routine examination of CSF specimens.
Material and methods . First dimension Apparatus :
:
The first dimensional separation or isofocali-
sation in glass tubes is performed in the Pharmacia gel electrophoresis apparatus GE-4 : (glass tubes 150 X 1,2 mm in size, gel rods Reagents :
T = 4 % , C = 5 % ) .
Ampholytes are purchased from LKB Instruments,
Inc. (pH : 3,5 - 9,5 78 %, pH : 2,5 - 4 11 %, pH : 9 - 11 11 %) and all other reagents and solvents used are of the highest purity available.
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
402
Sample preparations
:
We use fresh sera and CSF and Rabbit
muscle Powder (Sigma) to study the electrophoresis quality control of our system (repeatability and reproducibility). Each serum or CSF, and rabbit muscle powder specimen are prepared by specific methods, respectively Tracy's (4) and Anderson's (1). . SDS electrophoresis Dimension Apparatus
:
:
For the second dimension, the vertical
polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis apparatus built by Mula , France, is used, (gel concentration 12 % or 14 % and gel slab dimension 140 X 140 X 1 mm). Reagents
:
Calibration kit Pharmacia
(lmw), running
gel buffer based composed of tris-glycin-SDS, pH : 8,3-8,5 (2) Staining
:
silver staining is performed as described
by Oakley et al. (3). Background staining is eliminated by a longer washing after the silver diammine treatment (2 hours instead of 2 mn in Oakley's technique with agitation and eight changes of glass-distilled water).
SDS electrophoresis dimension 94000
1-2-3-4
67000 5
43000
30000
20100
J
2
3
,4
: different concentrations of rabbit muscle : calibration kit
403 Results . A typical 2D gel pattern of CSF is shown in the following figure. It demontrates the capability of this gel electrophoresis system.
. Electrophoresis quality control : First dimension
:
The curves for pH gradients are plotted
routinely according to Tracy (4) and we calculate the slope and intercept of the regression line. The gels used as Iso dimension quality control gels for pH gradients do not contain samples. The following table lists repeatability and reproducibility CVs for the slope and intercept of the regression line of our system. The values are 5,5 % or less as Tracy's (4).
404 i i
"o 1 rH II G
Repeatability
1
i •H 0 • "3 tJ >i ! II 0 -P ^ -RH 1 G OJH a) -H 1
Pi X)
PH Slope
i i
x
=
0,354
i
SD
=
0,0195
i
cv
5,5%
i
x
=
4,629
i ,
SD
=
0,255 5,5 %
, ,
i
cv
I
=
0,370
I
X
=
4,423
,
=
0,020 5,4 %
I
SD
=
,
CV
0,178 4,02 %
, , ;
CV
I
Second dimension
i ,
1
Intercept
i
I
i x , SD I
1
gradient i
1 :
The curves for molecular mass are
plotted routinely with rabbit muscle powder and Pharmacia calibration kit (lmw). The following table lists CVs values for the slopes of the molecular mass curves (log Mr Vs relative mobility). The values are 5,9 or less, close to Tracy's values (4). I
Log Mw curves
I 1 •H
o 1—1 +I || 0 -P U -H FTH Q) -H A .Q
I I
CV
= —
Intercept
I
0,376
X
" SD !
I
Slope
I
0,012
"
3,1 %
1
!
X
=
5,2
SD
=
0,018
!
3,3 %
!
CV
=
I
_
0,385
!
x
=
5,213
!
! SD
=
0,023
!
SD
=
0,025
!
! CV
=
5,9 %
!
CV
:
4,7 %
!
!
x
I
2D electrophoresis
I
:
An important cause of poor reproduci-
bility are losses of proteins during manipulation and particulary during equilibration. To measure these losses,
405
we introduced in each batch a sample of rabbit muscle proteins. In view of results, we progressively decrease the duration from 30 mn to 5 mn and finally we eliminated this step without effect on the quality of the rabbit muscle pattern (no more streaks). The reproducibility of the separation is sufficient to permit each spot on one separation to be matched with a spot on a different separation.
Conclusion We examined the various steps of the 2D electrophoresis for repeatability and reproducibility. The quality control of
our simple 2D electrophoresis system seems sufficient
to allow us to begin developing methods for CSF protein study. The rabbit muscle powder, easy to use and of little cost in 2D electrophoresis routine technique, can be utilised for electrophoresis quality control.
References 1.
Giometti, C. S., Anderson, N. G. and Anderson, N. L. : Clin. Chem. 25 , 11 , 1877 - 1884 (1979)
2.
Johnson,B. J. : Analytical Biochem. 127 , 235-246 (1982)
3. 4.
Oakley, R. B. : Anal. Biochem. 105 , 361-363 (1980) Tracy, R. P., Currie, R. M., Young, D. S. : Clin. Chem. 28 , 4 , 908 - 914 (1982)
ANTHROPOMETRIC AND BIOLOGICAL CHARACTERIZATION STATES IN MAN Claude André and Simone
OF MALNUTRITION
Danière
1
Groupe d I m m u n o p a t h o l o g i e digestive, INSERM U 45, Pavillon Centre Hospitalier Lyon Sud, 69310 PIERRE BENITE, FRANCE
1G,
Introduction Defining
the
normal
human
nutritional
state
There are n e v e r t h e l e s s several
situations
sification
instance
is
necessary,
compare
populations
quiring
medical have
we must
because
they
that
subjects had
time
identify
body
in
problem.
this we
clas-
wish
individuals
a
higher could
or shorter
be
life
Underweight
individuals
spans, but to a lesser
extent.
The
of
nutritional
comparison to
state
anthropometric
criterion(a)
does not
an
prevent
has(have) us
from
also
individual
can
or biological not
using
yet
have
been
currently
be
standards. employed
to determine
indispensable therapeutic
complements.
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
to
expectanand
life-
determined
predict the chances of success of failure of a given
or
com-
used
shorter
defined,
to re-
death
American insurance
weights
longer
a
There is in fact a clear association with mortality
overweight.
fect
each
are
In this context,
established
determine which cies.
or when
care
illness risk group. panies
for
is
in which
in
A
per-
but
this
methods
to
treatment
410
Anthropometric
Standards
1) Mean weight - Ideal weight The simplest measurement
is that of body weight.
that this parameter is height- and sex-related. studies This
have shown
"normal"
that mean
weight
life expectancy.
gain
weight
We admit Population
increases with
is undesirable
if
we
aging.
refer
to
This idea has led to the definition of an
ideal weight, constant in an adult regardless of age. A
number
of
formulas
has been
proposed
ideal weight. The most classical of Lorenz and Vague,
to
calculate
where the ideal theoretical weight is
equal to height expressed as cm above one m, subtract
a number
this
formula for adults is that
equal
to
1/4
of the
from which we
difference
between
150 and height expressed in cm: Ideal weight
(kg) = (height cm-100) - (height cm-150)/4-
There are two major
criticisms to
be leveled
against
this
formula. It neglects sex and, more importantly, it neglects individual
morphology.
among 4 compartments:
Body weight
is in fact
the skeleton, adipose tissue, extra-
cellular liquid and the cellular mass, cles, tions
and blood and visceral proteins. in
relation
to
distributed
a standards
may
which includes musBody weight variabe
the
result
of
a
large skeleton or large muscle mass as much as of large fat reserves.
The size of the skeleton may be estimated by the
width
of
rence
of the
measured
the pelvis wrist.
between
the
or the shoulders and by the The
slight
anterior
type and
circumfe-
has a pelvic
superior
iliac
width, spines
which is less than 28 cm and a wrist circumference which is less than 16 cm. The heavy skeletal type has an iliac width
411
greater than 20 cm.
29 cm and a wrist circumference greater than
The mean type has intermediate values.
account for this skeletal parameter,
In order to
Monnerot-Dumaine
(1)
proposed another formula in which ideal weight is given by the equation: W = (H - 100 + 4C)/2, most widespread
where C is wrist circumference.
current us involves tables
(2).
The
Neverthe-
less, the comparison of data must also include the clinical examination. dromes,
Edema
accompanying certain
nutritional
syn-
for example in children with kwashiorkor, causes a
weight increase which may
cause the degree of
denutrition
to be underestimated. 2) Importance of the lipid compartment Virtually all human energy reserves are in adipose tissue. In
a
normal
weight,
male,
it
accounts
for
10 to
15%
of
total
while the corresponding figure in normal women is
around 20 to 25%.
Half this fat is subdermal with varying
distributions.
The value of determining the adipose tissue
content
organism
of
the
is obvious.
Obesity
in
fact
is
physiologically defined as an excessive proportion of this tissue.
On the contrary,
and
a bit too excessive,
the
Littre dictionary defines the state emaciated as an individual whose subcutaneous tissue contains little or no fat. On the
practical
level,
there
is no
means
for
directly
measuring the mass of adipose tissue.
It is calculated by
subtracting the non-fatty
extracellular
and support tissue
cell
from total
mass,
body weight.
water
The non-fatty
cell mass is determined isotopically as the dilution space
412
of
potassium-42;
measuring
inulin
extracellular or
mannitol
exchangeable sodium chloride. tissues
is
determined
function of height. difference
between
The weight
of an
by
water
is
dilution
or
determined by
by
measuring
Finally, the mass of support
estimations
from
tables
as
a
An alternative method uses the density adipose
tissue
individual
is
and the
expressed
non-fatty on the
mass.
basis
of
his volume measured in a bathtub and reading off a nomogram gives the proportion of adipose tissue. baum et al.
however
(3),
the exact determination
As noted by Apfel-
the difficulty of this method is
of respiratory
volumes.
Two
indirect methods which are easier to use are more employed. with
an
g/mm
,
regularly
One is the measurement of skin folds, determined appropriate
compass
exerting
a
pressure
sub-scapular, regions.
pectoro-axi11ary,
supra-iliac and abdominal
The approximate weight of the adipose
ness of the skin fold in women
and
on the posterior
5-7 mm
in men.
compartment
The normal
tion indices have also been described
These
data
vary
however,
is
as a
correla-
between per cent body
(or skin fold) and the weight/size ratio consensus,
thick-
face of the arm
function of age and also of racial type. Excellent
is no
10
usually the tricipital, bicipital,
can be deduced from these measurements.
fat
of
regardless of the spread. The measurement should be
done at several points,
15 mm
other
concerning
the
(W/S). ideal
There
formula:
W / S ^ or W/S"^, or even an exponent W/S^, where P accounts for age, sex and a racial factor (4, 5).
413
3) Importance of the non-fatty mass The proportion composition
of proteins,
of
the
organism
especially muscles, can
be
determined
in the by
easy
measurements or may require special equipment. The simplest method is arm circumference,
measured halfway between the
olecranon and the acromion. Muscular diameter in the middle of the arm can be calculated by deducting the contribution of skin and sub-cutaneous fat with the formula: muscle diameter = (arm circumference/3•14) - tricipital skin fold,
where values are in mm.
Similarly,
the
muscle surface in the middle of the arm is calculated with: 2 muscle surface (mm ) = 3-14/4 x (diameter of arm 2
muscles) . The protein content of children and adults is well shown by the muscle surface of the arm, and the diameter or circumference of its muscles (6, 7). Some authors perform these measurements with the thigh. A more sophisticated method for determining total protein in the organism involves measuring body nitrogen (8), total cell
mass by measuring exchangeable
potassium
and (9),
the latter excluding bone cells.
Biological Standards 1 ) Laboratory data Anthropometric obesity however,
as
tests
much
as
are for
used
for
the
dénutrition.
determination Laboratory
of
tests,
are primarily concerned with the study of malnu-
trition. The significance of certain tests is mainly at the level of general status, while others are more specific.
Urea nitrogen tein supply infectious tion.
may be
low if there
in the diet. state
which
is an insufficient
Standard blood tests indicate an
is
often
This is as important
associated
in the
case of
are the determinations of cholesterol an
obese
have
subject.
long
general
included
decrease
number
of
proposed
plasma
proteins as
an
as in
the
of
leaves
synthesized
index,
of
denutrition
proteins;
immunoglobulins by
including
denutri-
denutrition
criteria
levels
with
and triglycerides
The biological usually
pro-
the
liver
albumin,
the
intact. have
A
been
prealbu min,
siderophi1 in and retinol binding protein. The determination of these parameters must not neglect the fact that such
as
albumin,
concentration
of
are
large
retinol
reserves,
binding
while
protein or
plasma
prealbumin
much lower. In addition, these proteins have very half lives:
certain,
the
20 days for albumin, 8 days for
is
different
siderophilin,
48 hours for prealbumin and 12 hours for the retinol
bind-
ing protein.
reac-
These data explain the highly different
tivities of these biological
Serum crease
complement in
and
protein
indices.
hemoglobin
and
calorie
concentrations malnutrition.
also
de-
Creatinine
clearance is also an excellent, indication of muscle mass in adult, as in children ed
for
diet.
72
hours
in
(10). Creatinine clearance is measurthe
absence
of
meat
and
fish
in
the
The index is determined as the ratio between urinary
creatinine
per
24 hours
and
the
same
parameter
healthy size-paired subjects. A number of clinical tions sometimes lead to the search for more local
in
normal
observaassociat-
ed deficiencies, for example vitamins, folic acid, elements such as zinc.
415
Malnutrition caused
by
is
important
sign
lymphocytes. mined
often
a decreased of
denutrition,
by
as
On a more functional
if the immune
nutritional presenting
accompanied
insufficiency
hypersensitivity
to
infections
Lymphopenia
is
the
level,
is
decrease
an
of
T
it can be deter-
system is or- is not compromised by the
a positive
tetanus anatoxin,
frequent
immune function.
by
studying
anamnestic
contact
the
response
antigens
of
such
capacity delayed
as
of skin
tuberculin,
Candida, diphtheria anatoxin,
Trichophy-
ton , varidase, Proteus or Streptococcus. Usefulness of markers of nutritional
state
It is a fact that severe malnutrition, such as observed in the third world or in concentration camp victims, causes irreversible sequelae intractable to any therapy. A lowered to trauma subjects 20%.
in the form of major surgery who
pre-operative
body
weight
decreases
These situations are unfortunately
no less maximalist.
The
problem posed
that of selecting high
risk subjects,
tients
would
whose
prognosis
be
resistance
is also established more
too frequent
in
than
and are
in Western nations of defining
improved
by
is
those
pa-
nutritional
and
immune therapy. A large number of studies has been inspired by this idea.
In addition, there is an upsurge of in interest in
nutrition today. this key
word
There are in fact about 20,000 entries under
in the last two years of MEDLINE.
sions of this work are far from unanimous, case
of
plasma
concentration vital
albumin
lower than
prognosis
in
levels.
Some
25 g/l
is an
subjects
with
The
for example in the
workers
believe
unfavorable
severe
in the
nephrology
department
(12).
that
sign
diseases
predicts a longer hospitalization arid more frequent in patients
conclua
for a
(11)
or
infections
Treatment
of
416
surgical patients by enteral or parenteral nutrition,
accord-
ing to whether it
concen-
succeeds in increasing the
tration over 35 mg/1
or fails to do so,
element in survival or death Other authors,
albumin
is also a predictive
(13).
however, believe that post-operative complica-
tions can be better predicted by the dynamometric
measurement
of hand clenching force than by albumin assays (14,
15)- This
questioning of the value of albumin assays is consistent
with
other workers who believe that albumin is a correct reflection of the less
nutritional
reliable
on
state an
on an epidemiological
individual
basis
(16).
level
but
Similarly,
is in
cancer patients on parenteral alimentation, increased survival is
better
(17)-
predicted
by
siderophilin
levels
than
Plasma proteins with short half lives,
protein
and
excellent
prealbumin,
indices
of
are
also
nutritional
by
albumin
retinol
binding
considered
status
(18)
to
be
or
unreliable
markers as a result of excessively rapid fluctuations There are also supporters hypersensitivity test.
and detractors
(19).
delayed
skin
The former admit a predictive capacity
for the course of the disease property
of the
either-
(20),
the latter
denying this
(21).
Conclusions The critical analysis of these data, tive prognosis, gence
of
the
especially in pre-opera-
is deceiving as long as there exists a diver-
results
obtained.
The
has
caused
well
nutrition workers to emit defeatist considerations (22).
known They
believe that a careful clinical examination contributes information
at
least
sophisticated
identical
anthropometric
to
that
arid
furnished
biological
by
the
most
determinations.
417
This hard line opinion may nevertheless contain nuances. authors
ask
if
a clinical
spirit
as precise
as this
Some is
not
specific to several specialists in nutritional problems and if their
experience
can
not
have
been
partially
acquired
as a
result of practicing those very same anthropometric and biological indices.
Also, although biological assays would seem to
be superfluous on a practical level in cases of extreme clinical situations, they are useful in equivocal cases Finally,
(23).
a review of the literature gives the impression that
defiance of anthropometric and biological determinations could very
well
studies. analysis during
be
related
For
example,
of
several
the
last
inconclusive
12
the treatment context,
immune
hundred only
given was
of
skin
articles
explains
tests,
in
why
3 studies used
taken
into
a
English the
of
patients It
in
is
the
critical appearing
results
age-paired
remain
controls,
in the disease
account..
In
this
nor
special con-
although it is the rreasui ement of an anamnes-
response.
whom
also
We
thus
understand
what
when
they
are
the search for an anergic state in patient
undergoing digestive (25).
in terms
inadaptation
neither the differences
homogenous series, of
frequent
the effect of repeating the skin tests was not
sidered either , tic
a
years
(24):
and in most cases
to
tract operations a
clear
leads
hyperalimentation that
the
malnutrition would be beneficial
to
the
selection
reduces
mortality
correction
in the
of
treatment
a of
state
of
a large
number of diseases.
The use be
of anthropometric
encouraged,
providing
greater strictness effectiveness.
and biological that
this
use
in its application,
indices should is
accompanied
thus by
the only guarantee
a of
418 References 1.
Monnerot-Dumaine, M.: Presse Med. 6_3, 1037-1038
2.
Geigy, Bale
3.
J.R.:
Scientific
edition
Geigy
SA,
(1963)
Apfelbaum,
M.
Vigy,
Paris 10506 B10-9 4.
Tables,
( 1955 )
Cronk.,
M.,
Igoin, L.:
Encycl. Med.
Chir.
(1973)
C.E., Roche, A.F.: Am. J. Clin. Nutr. 35,
347-354
(1982)
5.
Frisancho, A.R., Flegel, P.N.: 697-699
Am. J. Clin. Nutr. ¿ 6 ,
(1982)
6.
Durnin,
J.V.G.A.,
7.
(1974) Cureton, K.J., Boileau, R.A., Lohman, T.G.: Hum. Biol. 321-326
8.
J.: Br. J. Nutr. ¿2,
77-97 47,
(1975)
McNeill, S.L.,
Womersley,
K.G.,
Memagh,
Harrison,
J.E.:
J.R., Am.
J e e j e e b h o y , K.N., Wolman,
J. Clin. Nutr. _32, 1955-1961
(1979) 9.
Talso,
P.J.,
Metabolism
Miller,
9., 456-471
10. Trowbridge,
F.L.,
Clin. Nutr. 3 6 ,
C.E.
Carballo, A.J., Vasquez,
I.:
(I960)
Hiner,
69I-696
C.D.,
Robertson, A.D.: Am. J.
(1982)
11. Apelgren, K.N., Rombeau, J.L., Twomey, P.L., M i l l e r , R.A.: Crit. Care Med. J_0, 305-307
( 1982)
12. Anderson, C.F., Wochos, D.N.: Mayo Clin. Proc.
57., 181 - 1 8 4
(1982) 13- Ching, Mills,
N.,
Grossi,
C.B.,
C.E.,
Nealon,
T.F.:
Angers, J., Zurawinsky, Surg. Gynecol. Onstet.
H.S., 151,
199-202 (1980) 14- Klidjian, A.M., Foster, K.J., K a m m e r l i n g , R.M., Cooper, A, Karrah, S.J.: Br. Med. J. 281, 899-901 15-
(1980)
Klidjian, A.M., Archer, T.L., Foster, K.J., Karran, J.P.E.N. 6, 119-121
(1882)
S.J.:
419 16. Forse, R.A., Shizgal, H.M.: J.P.E.N. 4, 450-454 17. Eriksson,
B.,
Douglass,
H.O.:
J.A.M.A.
(1980)
243,
2049-2052
( 1980) 18. Cals,
M.J.,
Delacoux,
Drevillon,
C.,
Raffray,
Y.,
Miocque, M.: Sem. Hop. Paris ¿ 8 , 2833-2837 19- Farthing, M.J.G.: Nutr. Res. 2, 561-568 20. Tasseau,
Succari, M.,
E., Evstigneeff, T., Desmoulins, D., Arsac, M.,
F.
(1982)
(1982)
Gaucher, L. Nicolas, F.: Sem. Hop. Paris
58,
7 8 1 - 7 8 4 (1982) 21. Brown, C.A.,
R.,
Bancewicz,
Farrand,
R.J., Pumphrey, R.S.H., Irving, M.:
Med. J. 284, 851-853 22. Baker,
J.P.,
Stewart,
S.,
J., Hamid, J . , Patel, N.J., W a r d , Brit.
(1982)
Cetsky,
A.S.,
Wesson, D.E., W o l m a n ,
S.L.,
Whitewell, J., Langer, B. J e e j e e b h o y ,
K.N.:
N. Eng. J. Med. 396, 969-972 (1982) 23. Collins, J.A.: N. Eng. J. Med. 306, 987-988 24. Twomey,
P.,
Ziegler,
(1982)
D., Rombeau, J.: J.P.E.N.
6^, 50-58
(1982) 25- Champault, G., Fabre, F.,Patel, J.C.: Nouv. Presse Méd. 9_, 1559-1563
(1980)
NEW FINDINGS ON THE ROLE OF ZINC AS A BIOLOGICAL RESPONSE MODIFIER
Susanna Cunningham-Rundles, Ph.D. L a b o r a t o r i e s o f C l i n i c a l Immunology and Human Immunogenetics Memorial S l o a n - K e t t e r i n g Cancer Center 1275 York Avenue, New York, NY 10021
Introduction Several l i n e s of i n v e s t i g a t i o n have suggested that the c e l l u l a r immune response may be modulated
both in v i t r o and i n v i v o by network
i n t e r a c t i o n s i n which z i n c may act as a p o t e n t i a t i n g agent ( 1 - 4 ) .
We and
others have p r e v i o u s l y demonstrated that zinc i s a monocyte dependent T lymphocyte mitogen i n v i t r o ( 5 , 6 ) and that l o s s of t h i s
function
c o r r e l a t e s with advance of malignancy in cancer p a t i e n t s .
Furthermore,
we have found that z i n c can a c t i v a t e human B lymphocytes to d i f f e r e n t i a t e i n v i t r o i n t o antibody s e c r e t i n g c e l l s
(7) and to act s y n e r g i s t i c a l l y
t h i s system with other B c e l l s t i m u l a t o r s .
in
We and others have found that
zinc may improve immune response i n zinc d e f i c i e n t persons (8) i n some cases.
In a d d i t i o n , we have found a c l o s e l i n k between zinc and thymic
hormone, as reported a l s o by Bach ( 9 ) . In the s t u d i e s described here, p o s s i b l e r e g u l a t o r y i n t e r a c t i o n s with the natural k i l l e r , NK, system were explored using ZnCl, Z n + + as a source of zinc.
Methods Peripheral blood mononuclear c e l l s , PBM, were i s o l a t e d from normal, healthy v o l u n t e e r s by p r e v i o u s l y described methods ( 1 0 ) , washed and resuspended i n RPMI 1640 supplemented with p e n i c i l l i n , glutamine, and 10% pooled normal human serum.
The 4 hr
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
streptomycin, 51
C r r e l e a s e assay
422 was used to assess natural killer, NK, function against the K562 tumor target cell as previously described (11).
Details of the longer term
activated NK assay have been described (12).
The Z n + + used was freshly
diluted from a 30 mM stock solution of ZnCl.
Results and Discussion In view of previous findings that zinc has the potentiality to enhance immune response in vitro and in some individuals in vivo in situations reflecting enhanced proliferation, studies were undertaken to examine the effect of zinc on natural killer activation in vitro. natural killer, NK, function were assessed.
Two types of
The first, endogenous NK
activity, was studied using freshly isolated peripheral blood mononuclear cells, PBM, in a 4 hr
51
C r release assay against the K562 target.
The
second, activated NK function, was examined following culture of PBM for six days with and without NK activators followed by exposure of these prestimulated cells to labeled K562 target cells in the 4 hr assay.
51
C r release
Concurrent addition of NK augmenting agents, specifically a or y
interferon, IFN, was carried out in the 4 hr assay in both procedures in some cases to assess pre-NK activity and residual potential pre-NK activity.
All studies were conducted in pooled normal human serum to
avoid possible stimulating effects of fetal calf serum.
Addition of Z n + + to freshly isolated PBM in a 4 hr assay of cytotoxic activity against the K562 tumor target was observed to produce a sharply inhibitory effect on lytic activity when present in the assay period only. As shown in Table I, this effect was highly dependent upon concentration and was rapidly diluted out so that at a [Zn + + ] of 4.0 X 10" 5 M, this was no longer observed.
One day incubation without Z n + + followed by exposure
to the labeled tumor cell target produced loss of NK activity.
This
spontaneous loss of activity is usually observed in studies of normal human peripheral blood lymphocytes and has been widely reported. here, Z n
++
further depressed lysis.
was seen at 4 days.
As shown
Additional diminution of NK activity
Similarly, NK augmentation by alFN was apparently
423 i n h i b i t e d by the presence of Z n + + in the absence of preculture and again t h i s effect was r a p i d l y l o s t with lower [ Z n + + ] , Table I .
Effect of Zn + + on NK A c t i v i t y 1 Preculture Peri od 4 Days 1 Day
Augmenting Agent
None
0 7,.5 X l O " 4 M 2..0 X 10" 4 M 4..0 X 10" 5 M
None None None None
21.8 4.6 6.7 21.2
10.6 2.8 5.8 N.D.
0 7..5 X 10" 4 M 2.,0 X 10"' + M 4..0 X 10" 5 M
alFN alFN alFN alFN
39.9 10.6 18.1 39.2
39.2 19.2 46.4 47.9
Zn
J 2
i
4 hr Final
i 9
51
C r release assay against K562; E:T r a t i o , concentrations.
5.5 1.0 N.D. N.D. 7.4 21.0 N.D. N.D.
100:1.
In c o n t r a s t , enhancement of ciIFN mediated augmentation was observed following 1 day preculture with both alFN and Z n + + together at concentrations of Z n + + l e s s than 5 X 10" 4 M and furthermore, by day 4, a concentration of 7.5 X 10" 4 was associated with a 3 - f o l d increase i n NK a c t i v i t y over cultures with alFN alone. Experiments designed to test for p o s s i b l e effects of Z n + + on the target c e l l s revealed that Z n + + i n h i b i t s both spontaneous and detergent induced lysis.
As shown in Table I I , the i n h i b i t o r y effect was most marked at the
higher concentration.
Since spontaneous release was equally affected, the
S/T r a t i o did not change.
The net r e s u l t was to reduce effector c e l l
lysis. Thus, the r e s u l t s shown i n Table I considered in l i g h t of Table suggest that Z n + + may act on both target and effector c e l l s .
II
In
experiments where Zn + + was present in a preculture phase with NK augmenting agents p r i o r to target cell a d d i t i o n , effector cell enhancement was predominant.
Z n + + was a l s o able to prevent l o s s of alFN induced
a c t i v i t y over time, not by d i r e c t l y a c t i v a t i n g NK c e l l s but perhaps by prolonging the l i f e of newly matured NK c e l l s recruited by alFN.
424 Table I I . Zn + +
Z n + + Associated Target Protection 1
Total Release 2
% Inhibition Total Release
Spontaneous Release 3
S/T
3134 2545 2764 2939
0 62.0 11.8 6.0
344 268 292 308
0.11 0.11 0.11 0.10
0 7..5 X K T 4 M 2..0 X I O - 4 M 4..0 X I O ' 5 M
*4 hr assay. cpm, detergent induced l y s i s . cpm, target c e l l s alone.
2
3
P o s s i b l e s t a b i l i z i n g e f f e c t s of Z n + + on NK function during a c t i v a t i o n by alFN and ylFN were studied in further experiments c a r r i e d out over 6 days. In these experiments, PBM were cultured at a density of 1.5 to 2.5 X 10 6 lymphocytes per ml and then recollected and plated with targets.
As shown i n Table I I I , Z n
most normal donor lymphocytes.
++
51
Cr labeled
did not a c t i v a t e NK function of
( I n a few cases, 2 of 10 persons'
lymphocytes tested, augmentation by Z n + + alone was found.
This may
suggest that the NK system was being stimulated in vivo and that Z n + + acted as a cofactor to promote s u r v i v a l of newly emerging mature NK cells.) Table I I I .
Z n + + Potentiated Induction of Activated NK C y t o t o x i c i t y 1 No Addition
100: 1 50: 1 25:: 1
1.9 1.3 1.2
Zn++
cJFN
4.6 1.5 1.3
16.4 9.8 5.1
alFN + Z n + + 37.1 35.1 24.5
% A
126.2 258.2 380.3
day culture system: data are shown as % 5 1 C r release at 3 effector target r a t i o s in 4 hr assay against K562. The presence of alFN during the culture period was associated with 6 - f o l d augmentation of l y t i c a c t i v i t y compared to unstimulated NK function at an E:T r a t i o of 100:1.
In t h i s culture system, Z n + + s t r o n g l y enhanced NK
induced target l y s i s and t h i s e f f e c t was stronger proportionately at lower E:T r a t i o r e l a t i v e to cultures with alFN alone as shown by the increased net change i n Table
III.
The a b i l i t y of Z n + + to modulate NK function was a c o n s i s t e n t f i n d i n g in a l l normal donors tested.
There was v a r i a t i o n in the magnitude o f the
425
boosting e f f e c t that appeared to be proportional to response to a or ylFN in the absence of Z n + + .
As shown in Figure 1, enhancement of Z n + + was
quite concentration dependent and in t h i s longer period of c u l t u r e , of 2.5 X 10
-lt
[Zn++]
M (corresponding to Zn 1:5 in Figure 1) was the most
e f f e c t i v e concentration.
The enhancement was r a p i d l y d i l u t e d out and did
not change the slope of the curve at concentrations where no augmentation was seen. E5 E0 55 50 45 U1 >- H0 35 UJ
30
a:
25 20
15 I0 5
ISEY B=STFS »-«IFN+ZN *-°f IFN+ZN I;20 FN+ZN I;5
0
I 00 : I
50 : I
E :T
25 :
RHTI•
Figure 1 Concentration dependent enhancement of alFN induced NK a c t i v a t i o n by Z n + + . Data are shown as percent l y s i s at d i f f e r e n t e f f e c t o r target r a t i o s . [alFN] was 800 U/10 5 lymphocytes. [ Z n + + ] were as follows: 1:5 = 2.5 X I O " 4 M; 1:20 = 8.0 X I O " 5 M; and 1:100 = 6.0 X I O " 5 M. Additional studies were conducted using ylFN as an NK augmenting agent in the 6 day activated NK assay.
In studies with normal donors,
enhancement of ylFN mediated NK augmentation was c o n s i s t e n t l y observed with considerable v a r i a t i o n in magnitude and d i f f e r e n t i a l e f f e c t on a range of E:T r a t i o s .
Typical data are shown in Figure 2.
426
75 70 E5 B0 55 50 Ln H5 H0 35 tr 30 25 20
_KEY_ • -"ÏTFN *- Ï1FN+ZN I¡0E *-ÏIFN+ZN I 2H +-JIFN+ZN I
I5 I0 5 0
I 00 : I E•T
50 : I
25 : I
RBTI•
Figure 2 Zn++
Effect of on y l F N augmented NK a c t i v i t y . Concentrations of Zn++ given in legend to Figure 1. [ y l F N ] was 64 U / 1 0 6 lymphocytes. The concentration dependence of Zn++ enhancement in experiments with yIFN was less restricted.
As for alFN at ineffective concentrations of Zn++,
no significant deviation from the slope of the curve observed with ylFN alone was seen. In summary, the results described here demonstrate a s i g n i f i c a n t enhancement of NK a c t i v i t y by Zn++.
The studies suggest that the
mechanism may a f f e c t the binding reaction or s t a b i l i z e NK c e l l maturation induced by NK augmenting agents in short term culture.
The time
dependence of the results presented may r e f l e c t either a requirement for metabolism of Zn++ or reduced a v a i l a b i l i t y of Zn++ as a target protecting agent.
In longer term cultures, Zn++ was found to exert a strongly
enhancing e f f e c t on augmented NK a c t i v i t y while being i n s u f f i c i e n t alone to have any potentiating impact on the NK system.
Since the time
427
required for maximum expression of enhancement coincided exactly with the peak of Z n + + induced lymphocyte p r o l i f e r a t i o n as shown previously ( 5 ) ,
it
i s possible that precursor NK c e l l s might be within the expanded c e l l u l a r compartment and thus Z n + + would provide a larger pool of pre-NK c e l l s IFN recruitment.
for
The magnitude of Z n + + enhancement was s t r i k i n g ,
p a r t i c u l a r l y at lower E:T r a t i o s .
Since in v i v o , lower r a t i o s to
putative targets might be more r e a d i l y achieved, one may speculate that Z n + + could act as a cofactor in mediating mechanisms of immune surveillance.
Acknowledgments The e x c e l l e n t technical assistance of Mrs. K.M. Smith i s
gratefully
acknowledged.
NIH NCI CB
These studies were supported in part by:
08748-17, The Richard Molin Memorial Foundation for Cancer Research, and NIH POI CA 29502-04.
References 1.
Brummerstadt, E . , Flagstad, T., Basse, A., Anderson, E.: Acta Pathol. M i c r o b i o l . Scand. (Sect. A) 79, 686 (1971).
2.
Iwata, T . , Incefy, G.S., Tanaka, T., Fernandes, G., Menendez-Botet, C . J . , Pih, K., Good, R.A.: Fed. Proc. 37, 1827 (1978).
3.
Fraker, P . J . , De-Pasquale-Jardun, Zwickl, C.R., Luecke, B.W.: Proc. Nat. Acad. S c i . U.S.A. 76, 457 (1979).
4.
Bendtzen, K.: Scand. J. Immunol. 12, 489 (1980).
5.
Garafalo, J . A . , Cunningham-Rundles, S . , Braun, D.W., Good, R.A.: J. Immunopharmacol. 1, 60 (1980).
6.
Ruhl, H., Kirchner, H., Bochert, G.: Proc. Soc. Exp. B i o l . Med. 137, 1089 (1971).
7.
Cunningham-Rundles, S . , Cunningham-Rundles, C., Dupont, B . , Good, R.A.: C l i n . Immunol. Immunopathol. 16, 115 (1980).
Int.
428 8.
Cunningham-Rundles, C., Cunningham-Rundles, S . , Iwata, T., Incefy, G., Garafalo, J . A . , Menendez-Botet, C., Lewis, V., Twomey, J . J . , Good, R.A.: C l i n . Immunol. Immunopathol. 21, 387 (1981).
9.
Bach, J . F . : Immunology Today, 1981.
10.
Cunningham-Rundles, S . , Hansen, J . A . , Dupont, B. in C l i n i c a l Immunobiology Vol. 3, ed. F. Bach, R.A. Good. Academic P r e s s , New York, p. 151, 1976.
11.
Cunningham-Rundles, S . , F i l i p p a , D.A., Braun, D.W., A n t o n e l l i , P., A s h i k a r i , J . : J. Nat. Cancer I n s t . 67, 585 (19 ).
12.
Cunningham-Rundles, S. in NK C e l l s and Other Natural Effector C e l l s , ed. R.B. Herberman, Academic Press, New York, p. 1133, 1982.
IMMUNODEFICIENCY IN PROTEIN OR VITAMIN
A
DEPRIVED MICE
Studies of immunological responses in immediate hypersensitivity with egg albumine or vaccination with ribomunyl
Patrice Binder, Bernard Gassies and Robert Fontanges Centre de Recherches du Service de Santé des Armées Division de Microbiologie 108, boulevard Pinel 69275 Lyon Cedex 03 France
Introduction
It is generally accepted that protein malnutrition and certain specific nutrient deficiences have an adverse effect on the immune system (1,2,3). Investigations on the interactions of protein or vitamin malnutrition and various immune parameters have led to some understanding of the etiology of the increased susceptibility to infectious diseases (4,5,6). Effects of nutrition on atopic reactions are the less known facts. Magnesium deficiencies may induce a temporary allergy like crisis (7) and eicosapentanoic acid enriched diet increases synthesis of IgE and IgG (8). Abassy (9) described a less sensibility to atopy in protein deprived children although IgE level was increased, probably because these children were infected with many parasitic agents. A recent work studies atopic children who developped hypervitaminasis A (10). The vaccination study on fed deprived people is an important problem and the hazards may be increased : atopy, immune complexe diseases, infections with living vaccines. The level and duration of protection have never been evaluted. In a previous work on S. typhimurium used as a living vaccine we observed that this germ became pathogenic in protein deprived Balb/c mice (11). In the present work, two types of responses were described after Normal, Protein deficient or Vitamin A deprived mice immunization. In the first work Balb/c mice, nourished with 19 % protein feed (Normal), 4 % protein feed (P deprived) or 19 % protein feed without vitamin A (Vit. A deprived),
M a r k e r Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1 9 8 4 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
430 were immunized with egg-albumin (E.A.). Immediate hypersensitivity (I.H.) and various related parameters were studied. In the second work, vaccination with Ribomunyl of Normal or P. deprived mice was studied. This ribosomial vaccine is a protective agent against K. pneumoniae infection (12)
Material and Methods
E®®d_and_Animals *
Feeds. Feeds were made by UAR . Their composition is given in table I. Animals. Male and female Balb/c mice were bred in our laboratory 4-5 weeks old mice were weaned and the diet was only started when mice were 6 weeks aged. Animals were weighted weekly.
Feed percent of total wei ght Composition Casein D.L. Methionin
Normal 20 0,3
Protein deprived 4 0,3
Vit. A deprived 20
**
0,3 **
Cornstarch
15
20
15
Dextrose
50
61
55
5
5
5
Cornoil
5
5
-
Linoleic acid
-
-
0,5
Cellulose
Linolenic acid
-
-
1
Mineral mix
3,5
3,5
4,5
Vitamin mix
1
1
4,5
Cholin butyrate
0,2
0,2
0,2
** Vitamine A control = No Vit. A Tableau I : Composition of feeds
* U.A.R. Villemoisson 91360 Epinay sur Orge France
431
- MojrtjiljXy jstudiej^. I.H. w i t h E.A. was studied previously
(13). In this
work w e used this antigen at various doses after various duration of feed control. The best moment for immunization had been observed to be started 3 weeks after feed control. Balb/c were randomised in 3 groups for feed control. Every group was divided in 7 subgroups for each sex. After 3 weeks of dietary, any subgroups was simultaneously immunized w i t h 9 killed B. pertussis, 6 x 10
germs intraperitonealy
doses of E.A. subcutaneously
(S.C.). 2 weeks later any mouse had received
2 mg of E.A. intravenously
(I.P.) and various
(I.V.). I.H. shock was quick and mortality
data were observed in any subgroup. -
of Serotonin. Three identical dietary groups were studied w i t h
female Balb/c mice. Seven doses were used in any group of 10 mice. These doses were 0,100,150,200,250,300 and 400 mg/kg. Serotonin was I.V. injected. Number of death was computed for 30 m n and we had used these date for L.D. 50 determinations. - E.A. specific antibodies. W e used the passive hemagglutination
test.
E.A. was adsorbed on sheep red blood cells (S.R.B.C.). Balb/c were
ran-
domised and any group was divided in 4 subgroups of feed control duration 1,2,3 or 4 weeks before immunization. Mice were immunized w i t h 2 mg/mouse of E.A. and B. pertussis, as previously described. In any subgroups bloods of 5 mice were collected and pooled at 1,2,3,4 and 5 weeks after immunization. Sera were
frozen.
Vacc ination_with_Ribomun^l * - MJjomuriyl . It is a ribosomal complex w i t h ribosomes of K. pneumoniae, S. pyogenes, S. pneumoniae and H. influenzae
(14). These ribosomes are
mixed w i t h proteoglycan of K. pneumoniae membranes 25 |Jg of this product are equivalent to a vaccinal dose. - Dietary. Mice received a Normal or P. deprived feed as previously described. - VaccimitjLon. M i c e were randomised in every feed groups and distributed in 2 subgroups
: vaccinated and no vaccinated animals. The vaccinated
* Laboratoires Pierre Fabre, Castres 81100 France
432 subgroups were immunized S.C. with 2 doses (25 pg x 2) of Ribomunyl. The first dose was injected after 4 weeks and the second dose after 5 weeks of feed control. - Challenge^ Two weeks after the last injection, 20 mice of the vaccinated and the no vaccinated subgroups were challenged with K. pneumoniae (2 x 3 10
germs/mouse I.P.). Mortality data was computed over 21 days and these
data were evoluted by a statistical method previously described
(15).
- Specific antibodies. Ribosomial and proteoglycan specific antibody titers were estimated in 5 pooled sera 1,2 and 3 weeks after the first immunization in both vaccinated and no vaccinated subgroups. E.L.I.S.A. technic was used for titration. Related data are the differences between vaccinated and no vaccinated subgroups. - Di£ect_PFC_test_. Direct H?C testfor SRBC were done 1,2 and 3 weeks after the first injection of vaccine. For any assay 8 mice of every subgroup g were immunized IP with 10
SRBC, 4 days before splenectomy. We used the
method of Cunningham (16). The numbers of spleen cells and PFC/10^ cells were computed. - Inmunoglobulij^dos^ges. Different classes of immunoglobulins were estimated by the single radial immunodiffusion method. 5 sera of any subgroups were pooled 1 week after the first vaccination.
Results
Immediate_HY2ersensitivity -
reality. We observed (table IX) a major decrease of mortality
average in P. deprived mice. The sex factor was also very important, while E.A. dose was a minor factor. Bfelow 1 mg/mouse the mortality was minimal. The most significative differences between any group were observed with 2 or 3 mg/mouse. The group of Vit. A deprived mice gave comparable results to controls. - L^D._50 of serotonin^ L^D. 50 was normal or decreased in P. deprived or Vit. A deprived mice (table III).
433
Anima1s sex Normal
Vit. A Deprived
Normal
Vit. A Deprived
alive
dead
dead
alive
dead
alive
dead
alive
1
9
1
9
2
8
4
6
2
8
3
7
1
1
9
1
9
0
10
4
6
0
10
6
4
2
2
8
1
9
1
9
8
2
1
9
5
5
3
3
7
1
9
3
7
7
3
4
6
10
0
4
3
7
1
9
5
5
6
4
3
7
7
3
10
5
5
1
9
3
7
5
5
4
6
6
4
alive
dead
P.Deprivec
alive
P.Deprived
0,4
Number
Mg/animal
Female
dead
Feed
0. A.
Male
Table II : Mortality after E.A.
shock
i n t h e d i f f e r e n t g r o u p s of B a l b / c
Feed control
in weeks
1
2
Normal Feed
mice
3
4
262
P.Deprived Vit.A Deprived
223
196
229
191
203
240
231
196
T a b l e I I I : R e s u l t s of L . D . 5 0 of s e r o t o n i n (doses i n m g / k g )
434 ~ iL-Ar_S2.ecif_i.c_ antibodies. In Normal mice the E.A. specific antobodies showed a steady rise untill the 5th week (table IV). In P. deprived or Vit.A deprived mice the levels of antibodies were always lower when duration of dietary was 3 or A weeks before immunization. The differences between Normal and deprived mice were very important 4 and 5 weeks after immunization. At this moment, antibody titers in Vit. A deprived mice were very low.
Feed
Norma!
Feed control before immunization (weeks) 1 Antibodies titer for every weeks
16
Vit.A deprived
P. Deprived
0
1
2
3
4
0
1
2
3
4
64
8
4
16
64
2
2
8
32
64
2
128
128
64
64
128
128
32
16
32
64
64
3
512
256
256
256
256
256 128
64
64
128
64
4
1024
512
512
512
512
512 256
256
256
256
32
5
2048
024
1024 1024
512
128
2048
512
256
32
69
Table IV : Titers of E.A. antibodies during different periods of immunization.
Y§££.i2§£i°D_with_Ribomunyl - Chall_en_ge_. Vaccination with Ribomunyl gave a good protection in Normal mice (table V). P. deprived mice were not protected, but showed a longer mean survival time. P . deprived but not vaccinated mice had a fulminant disease. - Specif^c_a^tjibodies_. Proteoglycan antobodies were higher than ribosomes antibodies in every feed and vaccinated group. At any time the titers of these antibodies were lower in P. deprived than in controls (fig. 1). -
A*- a n y time the numbers of spleen cells were dramati-
cally decreased in P. deprived mice. The rate of S.R.B.C. antobodies bearing cells were the same in any feed groups. These rates were
435 Normal
Feed Vaccination Mortality 21th day after challenge Daily mortality Survival average (days)
P. deprived
Yes
No
Yes
No
5 %
90 %
100 %
100 %
0,05
0,39
0,47
2,99
10,93
6,45
2,68
1,54
Table V : Survival curves parameters increased when Normal or P. deprived mice were just vaccinated (table VI)
Feed
Normal Yes
Vaccination 1 WEEKS AFTER
Cells spleen 223 ± 40 x 106 b PFC/10 1099 ± 145 cells Cells/spleen x 106
2
VACCINATION 3
P. Deprived no
Yes
No
214 ± 42
54 1 10
704 ± 227
1080 ± 498
337 + 129
56 t 9
61 ± 15
39 - 9
173 1 27
152+50
1119 1 50
1285 Ì 774
404 ± 111
458 ± 269
Cells spleen
181 ± 31
195 Ì 19
42+11
47 + 11
PFC/10b cells
495 ± 109
507 ± 243
355 ± 247
326 + 229
PFC/10b cells
Table VI : Results of direct P.FoC. test
- Immunoglobulin classes. IgM were increased after vaccination. The level of these antibodies was lower in P. deprived than in Normal mice. Only IgA were higher in P. deprived than in Normal mice (table VII).
436 A
O.D.
1000
ANTIBODIES LEVEL IN VACCINATED GROUP MICE
500 450 400 350 300 250 200 150 100 50
1
2
3
WEEKS AFTER VACCINATION —
Ab a proteoglycan K.d., Normal feed,
---
Ab a proteoglycan K.p., P.Deprived feed, Ab a ribosomes K:p., Normal feed, Ab â ribosomes K.p., P.Deprived feed
Figure 1 : Specific antibodies in vaccinated mice
437
Feed
Normal Yes
No
IgG1
5,83
6,91
5,«
IgG2a
3,22
3,39
2,20
IgG2b
1,18
0,86
1 ,58
Ig M
0,93
0,32
0,49
Ig A
1 ,05
1,10
2,30
Vaccination
Ig Class
P. Deprived Yes
Table VII : Results of estimations of Immunoglobulin class
Discussion and Conclusions
Malnutritions are impairment factors for immunological responses. Observed modifications may be very important and opposed : protein deficiency may be a good thing for atopy and very bad thing for vaccinal protection ! Systems for immunological responses have regulation steps. Nutritional disorders can be induced on increase or decrease of atopy, vaccinal protection and immunological memory. Fundamental studies on AMPc (17), histamin release (18) or IgE receptors of mast cells are very important for understanding the role of unbalanced nutrition in atopy. Likewise antibodies affinity and cellular cooperations are essential factors. Their modifications may be cause an infectious disease in spite of vaccination or immunostimulation (19).
Acknowledgment. P. Binder thanks Pierre Fabre Laboratories for the free gift of Ribomunyl.
438 References 1.
Chandra, R.K., Newberne, P.M. : Nutrition Immunity and Infection, mechanism of interactions, Plenum Press, New York, London 1979.
2.
Bounous, G. , Kongshawn, P.A.L. : J. Nutr. JJ_2, 1 /47-1755 (1982).
3.
Watson, R.R. , Mc Murray, D.N. : CRC Critical Reviews in Food Sciences and Nutrition, _1_2, 1 13-150 (1979).
4.
Shaedler, R.W., Dubos, R.J. : J. Exp. Med. J_K), 921-934 (1959).
5.
Scrimshaw, N.S., Taylor, C.E., Gordon, J.E. : WHO, Monograph, serie 57,(1968).
6.
Newberne, P.M., Hunt, C.E., Young, V.R. : Brit. J. Exp. Rathol. 4_9, 448 (1968).
7.
Claverie-Benureau, S., Lebel, B., Gaudin-Harding, F. : Reprod. Nutr. Developp. 2J_, 591-600 (1981).
8.
Prickett, J.D., Robinson, D.R., Black, K.J. : Immunol. 46, 819-826 (1982).
9.
Abassy, A.S., El Din, M.K., Hassan, A.I., Aref, G.H., Hammad, S.A., El Araby, I.I., El Din, A.A. : J. Trop. Med. Hyg. 77, 18 (1974).
10. Silverman, S.H., Leks, H.I. : Clin Pediatr. 2_j_, 172-174 (1982). 11. Binder, P., Fontanges, R. : Personnal Communication SO1"*1 Reunion of Association of Physiologist (France), Toulouse 14-17 Juin 1982. 12. Fontanges, R., Robert, D., Content, Y., Nis, G. : Arzneim. Forsh./ Drug Res. 30, 142-172 (1980). 13. Fournier, J.M., Accominotti, J.C., Leclerc, J.L., Fontanges, R. : Rev. Franç. Allergol., 135-141 (1976). 14. Fontanges, R., Robert, D., Content, U., Nils, G. : Rev. Franc. Allergol _T7, 35-81 (1977). 15. Binder, P., Epinat, R., Eprinchard, Y., Fontanges, R. : C.R. Soc. Biol. 176, 345-351 (1982). 16. Cunningham, A.J. , Szenberg, A. : Immunol., U\_, 599-600 (1968). 17. Spach, C., Askhenasy, A. : J. Nutr. _109, 1265-1273 (1979). 18. Gaudin-Harding, F., Claverie-Benureau, S., Armier, J., Davy, J., Lebel, B. : Internat. J. Vit. Nutr. Res. 50, 185-192 (1980). 19. Lambert, R. : Cahier de Nutrition et de Diététique, 1, 53-57 (1976).
IMMUNOLOGICAL CONSEQUENCES OF PROTEIN DEPRIVATION IN PRIMATES
Saman Qazzaz Department of Biochemistry, University of Manchester, Stopford Building, Oxford Road, Manchester M13 9PT.
Introduction
The association of malnutrition and infectious disease is the most common problem of disease in tropical and sub-tropical countries. disease nearly always worsens co-existing malnutrition.
Infectious
Furthermore, the
consequences of infection are likely to be more serious in a malnourished host than in a well nourished one.
When infection aggravates malnutri-
tion or when malnutrition weakens resistance to infection, the term "synergism of infection and malnutrition" has been applied to this association (Scrimshaw, Taylor and Girdon, 1959).
Protein-energy mal-
nutrition is usually accompanied by suppression of the immune response as well as by severe infections.
Reports of field studies in children with
severe malnutrition have documented the suppressed immune response (McFarlane et al, 1970).
Nevertheless, because of the frequent episodes
of infection in these children, it is still not clear whether it is the infection in these children or the malnutrition, or both, that are responsible for the immune suppression.
The present study was therefore
designed to investigate this problem.
Materials and Methods
Establishment of malnutrition in primates
Three baboons and one cynomolgus monkey, mean age 2h years, were used. The primates were offered a Mazuri primate diet which was obtained from British Petroleum (BP) Nutrition, Essex, England.
This diet consisted of
217. protein, 427. carbohydrate and 4.27„ digestible crude oil containing
M a r k e r Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1 9 8 4 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
440 both saturated and unsaturated fatty acids. 3851 calories. vitamins.
One kg of the diet contained
The rest of the diet consisted of trace minerals and
The control baboon received 220 g of this diet as established
in preliminary studies and the remaining 2 baboons and the m o n k e y received 44, 11 and 22 g/day respectively. 5 and 107, of the control diet.
The animals were fed twice daily on 20,
In addition to their respective diets each
primate received 4 g of a soluble multivitamin mixture containing all the known vitamins, calcium pantothenate and choline daily in their drinking water, as well as 130 g/day of fresh vegetables and fruits comprising apples, carrots, grapes, cauliflower and bananas.
Prior attempts to feed
these primates w i t h any other type of food were unsuccessful and hence this factor had to be taken into account in the design of the study.
After 4 weeks on their respective diets attempts were made to achieve a steady metabolic state by increasing the amount of food for all the m a l nourished animals to 357„ of the Mazuri primate diet and maintaining it at this level.
Assessment of the nutritional
status
General appearance. The animals were examined daily for any changes in appearance, behaviour and signs of infection.
Body weight. The animals were weighed twice weekly after being anaesthetised.
Plasma protein quantitation. The serum albumin, transferrin and C3 concentrations were measured by the specific single radial method (Mancini, Carbonara and Heremans,
immunodiffusion
1965).
Assessment of the immune response
Delayed hypersensitivity. This was performed according to the m e t h o d of Catalona et al, 1972.
In preliminary experiments w i t h different
ing doses of dinitrofluorobenzene
sensitiz-
(DNFB) in 0.1 ml acetone on the shaved
forearm all the primates produced a distinct inflammatory response w i t h i n
441 2 days regardless
of their n u t r i t i o n a l
sensitizing dose a challenging w a s a p p l i e d to the o p p o s i t e
status.
Fourteen days after
the
d o s e of D N F B of 100, 50 a n d 25 jUg i n 0 . 1 m l
f o r e a r m w h i c h w a s r e - e x a m i n e d a t 24 a n d 48 h
for e v i d e n c e of d e l a y e d c u t a n e o u s h y p e r s e n s i t i v i t y .
A positive
response
w a s i n t e r p r e t e d as a n a r e a h a v i n g d i s t i n c t e r y t h e m a ,
induration
and
vesiculation.
T h e s i z e s of s u c h a r e a s w e r e m e a s u r e d w i t h a W e l l c o t e s t 2 the a r e a of w h i c h w a s c a l i b r a t e d i n c m .
skin reaction gauge
Skin transplantation. performed according grafts, examined
First and second set skin transplantations
to the m e t h o d d e s c r i b e d b y M e d a w a r
were Auto-
allografts and x e n o g r a f t s were done, and all skin grafts
were
daily.
Passive cutaneous anaphylaxis out in primate kwashiorkor levels.
(1944).
(PCA). S t a n d a r d P C A r e a c t i o n s w e r e
skin with serum specimens
f r o m (i) c h i l d r e n
carried
with
a n d (ii) c h i l d r e n w i t h a s t h m a k n o w n to h a v e r a i s e d s e r u m
Serum specimens with
n o r m a l c o n c e n t r a t i o n s of I g E f r o m
m a t c h e d h e a l t h y c h i l d r e n s e r v e d as c o n t r o l s .
A positive PCA reaction was
i n t e r p r e t e d as a d i s t i n c t b l u e a r e a , w h i c h a p p e a r e d o n the b a b o o n s ' within 5 minutes after
the a l l e r g e n c h a l l e n g e .
T h e s i z e s of the
reactions were m e a s u r e d w i t h a ruler calibrated in cm and w i t h Wellcotest
skin reaction
skin
PCA
a
gauge.
Lymphocyte activation by mitogen. The method used was m o d i f i e d from of J a n o s s y a n d G r e a v e s , haemagglutinin
1971, a m i c r o - m e t h o d being employed.
DNA synthesis
(PHA) s t i m u l a t i o n of D N A s y n t h e s i s b y p e r i p h e r a l
blood
primates.
(E) a n d to
1 9 7 5 ) , i n w h i c h the p e r c e n t a g e of r o s e t t e s a m o n g
lymphocytes was estimated. established by counting duplicate.
to s h e e p e r y t h r o c y t e s
antibody
(EAC) r o s e t t e s w e r e p e r f o r m e d as p r e v i o u s l y d e s c r i b e d
and McFarlane,
after
t h a t 40 j/Ug of P H A p e r 1 m i l l i o n c e l l s c a u s e d m a x i m u m
i n the n o r m a l
Rosetting. Spontaneous rosettes complement
that
Phyto-
l y m p h o c y t e s w a s p e r f o r m e d a t l e a s t t w i c e p e r w e e k for e a c h p r i m a t e , having established
IgE
age-
The reproducibility
in t r i p l i c a t e a s a m p l e
(Jones 200
of the c e l l c o u n t s t h a t w a s s e t up
in
was
442 Immunoglobulin G (IrG) measurements. This was quantitated by the single radial immunodiffusion assay (SRID). Test for infection Microbiological methods. Throat and conjunctival, swabs taken at least twice weekly from each primate into Stuart's transport medium were examined by means of Gram-stained films, cultures on blood agar, chocolate agar and MacConkey agar, and anaerobic cultures carried out on brain-heart infusion agar with 107o blood.
All colony types were Gram-
stained then subcultured to appropriate media for further examination. Organisms were identified by the method of Cowan and Steel (1974). Peripheral blood from each primate was also inoculated into brain-heart infusion broth and Brewer's thioglycollate.
Subcultures were made on to
blood agar and chocolate agar plates at 24 and 48 h and at 7 days.
At the end of the experiment the animals were killed and specimens of lungs, liver, spleen, kidneys and lymph nodes were cultured as above.
Results Changes in behaviour By the end of the first week on the restricted diets the animals appeared more aggressive and by the fourth week they had become withdrawn and lethargic. Body weight Changes in total body weight are summarized in figure 1.
When body
weight was expressed as a percentage of initial weight, a significant change (p t > I-
5
S
4
! D
3
£ X
2
H
1 0
controls
anorexia nervosa
Figure 1. Thymulin activity in anorexia nervosa
464 References 1.
Herbeth, B., Henny, J. and Siest, G. : Ann. Biol. Clin. 41, 23-32 (1983).
2.
Pertschuk, M.J., Crosby, L.O., Barot, L. and Mullen, J.L. : Am. J. Clin. Nutr. 35., 968-972 (1982).
3.
Richard, J.L., Rodier, M., Bringer, J., Bellet, M.H., Mirouze, J. : Nouv. Presse Med. 11, 3327-3330 (1982).
4.
Ingenbleek, Y. : In The Thyroid Gland (M. de Visscher, ed.) 499-527, Raven Press, New-York (1980).
MALNUTRITION IN CANCER AND CACHECTIC PATIENTS Federico Bozzetti, M.D. Istituto Nazionale per lo Studio e la Cura dei Tumori, Milan.
Cancer cachexia is a metabolic syndrome characterized by weakness, anorexia, depletion and translocation of host components and loss of immunocompatence which often occurs in patients with cancer independently from the tumor burden. It is related to the type and site of origin of tumor, stage and duration of the disease (5). Also therapy (chemotherapy, radiation and surgery) may occasionally precipitate a cachectic state in patients with borderline malnutrition. From a clinical point of view, cachexia manifests as asthenia, anorexia, significant loss of body fat, protein and other components, anemia, electrolyte abnormalities, hormonal aberrations and sometimes fever. The patients appear chronically ill and emaciated, the skin is atrophic and shiny, with loose folds. The temporal fossae and cheeks are sunken leaving prominent zygomatic protuberances and old denture plates become large. Depletion of fat tissue is revealed with prominent borders of the sternocleidomastoid muscles, larynx, clavicles and vertebral spines. The sternum and xyphoid and ribs are often well visible, the interspaces are sunken and the breast sag and are shrivelled. The abdomen is protuberant or scaphoid and pubis is prominent. The genitalia are atrophic, and sexual interest and arousability almost absent. The elbows and knees look large compared to atrophic muscle masses. The sacrum and the greater trochanters and sometimes the scapulae, lateral malleoli and heels are prominent; they
may present erythematous
and bullous lesions which subsequently may evolve into decubitus ulceration with dry eschar or undermining necrosis of the entire skin. Fluid may accumulate in the bulbar conjunctiva and along the chest and abdominal walls posterolaterlly as an eccentric bulging or may occupate the entire low back and occur also in the scrotum and prepuce and in the lower legs. Bizzarre patterns of fluid accumulation occur in patients who assume unusual constant postures, usually to avoid pain. Fluid accumulation may contribute to mantain a falsely normal or subnormal weight. The loss of body weight consists primarily of the loss of
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
466 muscle mass and secondly of body fat, while the visceral life-supporting system is, to a considerable extent, spared (11) Pathogenesis of cachexia is multifactorial. It includes an increased energy requirements despite a decrease in the caloric intake, and alterations in protein, carbohydrate and lipid metabolism. Increased energy requirements The energy requirements in patients affected by tumor include the energy required by the tumor for active transport of nutrients and ions and synthesis of cellular materials and the caloric requirements imposed on host (Cori cycle activity, assimilation and transport of nutrients to tumor and synthesis of host tissues in response to tumor).
In tumor cells, glucose
is metabolized via glycolysis to lactate (18, 60). The lactate which is formed is returned to the host liver, where it is resynthesized to glucose (29). This cyclic metabolic pathway, involving metabolism of glucose to lactate and the conversion of lactate to glucose, is termed the Cori cycle. Utilization of lactate and gluconeogenic aminoacids for glucose synthesis requires energy within the host liver and kidney and an increased rate of gluconeogenesis has been proposed a possible mechanism for increased energy expenditure in the cancer patients (18, 21). Holroyde et al. (25) have recently reported studies of Cori cycle activity in cancer patients. Patients who were not losing weight had normal levels of Cori cycle activity, but patients with progressive weight loss had increased Cori cycle activity, showing that lactate production was higher in these patients. In a critical appraisal of data of Holroyde and other authors (46, 63, 71) Young (71) has estimated that less than 10 percent of daily total expenditure in the cancer patients can be accounted by the cost of lactate recycling. Furthermore it can be estimated that, if 15% of total lactate production is oxidized to CO^ and 1^0, and 85% of lactate is converted to glucose, there will be a maintenance of high-energy phosphate balance. It is difficult to accept therefore, that changes in the Cori cycle activity are a significant cause of the marked body wasting in patients with progressive neoplasia. Nevertheless, it is of interest that Holroyde et al. ( 2 5 ) observed highest Cori cycle activity in patients with greatest total
467 energy expenditure. Additional causes for the increased energy expenditure include activation of futile cycles. These cycles occur when there are two opposing metabolic pathways in the cell in which the reactions in the forward and reverse directions are catalyzed by separate enzymes. For example three futile cycles in carbohydrate metabolism are: the glucose 6-phosphate, fructose 6-phosphate and phosphoenolpiruvate cycles. In one direction the reaction requires the participation of a high energy compound, such as ATP, while the reaction in the opposite direction is energetically spontaneous. Although there is no net flux of reactants in these cycles, the cycling causes ATP hydrolysis and thus an energy wastage. The increased energy expenditure could be the result of some alteration in the energy yielding reaction and the coupling mechanism of
oxidative phosfhorylation. In fact
there is some documentation in vitro (15, 41, 42) of alteration in the oxidative phosphorylation in the tumor bearing animal, but convincing evidence is still lacking in vivo (14, 24). Finally the protein turnover (synthesis and degradation) accounts for a significant proportion of basal energy expenditure (about
507c).
An incre-
ase in protein turnover, either in synthesis or breakdown could explain the alteration of resting metabolic expenditure. Alterations in protein metabolism can occur in malignant tissue (21, 22, 23, 32) and recently Carmichael et al. (10) have demonstrated
a correlation between rates of
protein synthesis and degradation and extent of tumor in patients with colorectal carcinoma and have suggested a translocation of protein stores from muscle to areas of more rapid protein synthesis such as tumor. Finally it is of particular interest the observation of changes which inevitably occur in various body organs in malignant disease. The liver has a high oxygen consumption and therefore contributes relatively more per unit weight to energy expenditure than other tissues. Although liver size is often diminished in malnutrition (27), may be increased in patients with cancer independently from presence of hepatic metastases. An alteration in the liver function cannot be ruled out as contributory factor to the change in the resting metabolic expenditure.
468 In humans, when energy expenditure has been estimated as basal metabolic rate, this rate frequently has been found elevated and there are very few reports in the 1 terature of a low basal metabolic rate in patients with metastatic cancer (58). Some variation in reported basal metabolic rates among and within the various studies probably reflects differences in methodological and biological variables, as well as possibly effects of different cancers and severity and stage of disease. If we accept +15-20% as the upper limit of the normal basal metabolic rate on the basis of the date of Boothby and Sandiford (3), than the frequency of abnormal BMR pooled from several studies (6, 8, 37, 39, 68, 49, 57) (Table l) ranges from 35% for patients with carcinoma to 74% for patients with leukemia (4). Table 1 INCIDENCE AND RATE OF INCREASED BMR IN PATIENTS WITH MALIGNANCY Type Leukemia
No. pts. 133
% pts. with high BMR
Mean value
74.4
+35
Plasmacytoma Lymphoma
4
50
+28
Miscellanea
31
35
+38
INT series
65
59
+29
64.8
+32
Total
233
469 Despite the extra energy requirement is relatively small, its cumulative effect may be significant over a long period. In fact a correlation between increased energy expenditure and malnutrition evaluated as weight loss and decrease in serum transferrin has been reported by Bozzetti and Co. (6). From a speculative point of view it is intriguing the fact that although healthy subjects with decreased alimentation usually demonstrate decreased metabolic rate, in contrast, patients with cancer may show increased metabolic rate despite their falling caloric intake. Starvation causes a decrease in oxygen consumption, resulting in diminished ATP requirements since the formation of glycogen, fatty acids and triglycerides that follows the transient excess of foodstuffs is diminished. Waterhouse (64), however, demonstrated that in patients with cancer long after the postabsortive state, the oxidative metabolism persists at increased rates. It appears therefore that the energy expenditure is inappropriately high in the semistarved patient with cancer. Decreased caloric intake The second major factor in negative energy balance in cancer patients is decreased caloric intake. The insufficient food consumption may be consequence of (1) localized disease-related effects (lesions localized to the upper digestive tract), or of (2) systemic disease-related effects. These include anorexia, changes in taste and small sensation, increased sense of fullness interfering with eating. Finally (3) treatment-related effects include for instance undernutrition following total gastrectomy, malabsorption following pancreatectomy, and nutritional complications of radiotherapy and chemotherapy. A special problem for both radiation and chemotherapy is the development of conditioned aversions. If a food is eaten shortly before the patient receives therapy, the acute malaise resulting from therapy may be psychologically associated with the food eaten before therapy. The patient may, thereafter, get a conditioned aversion for that food. Malabsorption Idiopathic steatorrhea or villous atrophy has been associated with carcinoma of the head and neck, bronchus, gastrointestinal tract, skin and ova-
470 ry (7). The presence in cancer patients of mucosal atrophy accompanied by weight loss and steatorrhea led Creamer (12) to suggest the term "cancer enteropathy" to indicate that some of the ill h e a l t h and loss of weight in advancing cancer is caused by abnormal small intestinal mucosa. H o w e ver subsequent studies (2, 19, 28) failed to confirm the findings of Creamer and others (13, 17, 20). Moreover, it has b e e n demonstrated (2) that the mucosal changes observed in cancer patients are quite similar to those in patients died from wasting disease other than cancer or gastrointestinal disease. Although these mucosal changes occur in cancer patients, they are not specific for cancer and the concept of "cancer
enteropathy"
is no more tenable. It seems probable that the mucosal changes are not the cause but the effect of cachexia, even if they m a y perpetuate to p r o g r e s sive malnutrition in a vicious circle. Energy balance A study which attempts to put the relative roles of increased caloric d e mand and decreased caloric intake into quantitative perspective h a s b e e n reported by Warnold et al. (62). In a series of
10 cancer patients, e n e r -
gy expenditure per 24h was calculated from oxygen consumption and heart rate data, and energy intake was calculated from records of food intake and standard food composition tables. These data were compared to the findings in control patients of similar age w i t h diseases affecting
physical
activities to about the same extent. Energy intake (mean 1270 Kcal/day) although varying greatly, w a s not significantly different from the intake in the controls (mean 1470 Kcal/day). Both the daily energy expenditure (mean 2020 Kcal/day) and the resting metabolic rate (mean 1630 Kcal/day) were significantly greater in the cancer patients than they were in the controls (mean, 1420 and 1170 Kcal/day, respectively). Thus the cancer patients has an average caloric intake that was nearly sufficient for a r e sting state, while their measured energy expenditure was comparable to that expected w i t h moderate activity.In the experience of Warnold (62) and of Bozzetti (6) treatment of tumor resulted in a drop of energy expenditure. Protein metabolism
471 Three separate studies have demonstrated that some cancer patients have anomalously h i g h protein turnover rates (10, 53, 4 5 , 9). Carmichael et al. (10) studied 11 patients w i t h colorectal cancer. W h e n synthesis was p l o t ted against stage of disease, synthesis and breakdown (ie. protein turnover) were found to increase as the severity of the tumor burden increased. A parallel increase in the apparent synthesis rate of the mixed plasma proteins w i t h increasing tumor burden was also found. Stein et al. (53) found that relative to normal controls (healthy young adults) those cancer patients who were o n TPN had a higher m e a n protein synthesis rate. Also Norton et al. (45) w h o studied patients w i t h various intestinal tumor found that three patients had a marked elevation of their whole body p r o tein synthesis rate. The reason w h y protein turnover is increased in some cancer patients is unclear. It is possible that this increase is not real but merely reflects the fact that the pool of faster turning over visceral proteins is r e l a t i vely expanded due to the depletion of the slower turning over muscle p r o teins (11, 69). Alternatively, the increase is real and probably it d e r i v e s from the host's tissue rather than from tumor. In fact a study on operable gastrointestinal malignancies, Stein and C o . determined the tissue fractional protein synthesis rate and concluded that "the tumor did not have an exceptionally h i g h fractional protein sinthesis rate relative to other visceral tissues, but it did sequester a disproportionate amount of parenterally administered aminoacids" (40, 54). Another possible
explana-
tion correlates the elevated protein synthesis rate to liver dysfunction. According to this hypothesis (52) the elevated protein synthesis rate would not be a direct consequence of the tumor on the host's protein m e t a bolism, but rather and indirect effect secondary to the metabolic load placed on the host's metabolic capacity by the tumor. The synthesis of v i s c e ral proteins is variously effected by the presence of cancer. Synthesis of secretary proteins such as acute-phase reactants (43), immunoglobulin (64) fibrinogen m a y be increased while the synthesis of liver structural p r o teins is normal. The liver seems to be protected from catabolic protein balance in the tumor-bearing host (34, 3 5 , 55) and liver size remains n o r m a l or increases possibly because of increased adrenocortical activity (21). The liver normally accounts for 20-25% of total oxygen consumption,
472 therefore, continued hepatic protein synthesis m a y be an important factor in energy balance in cancer patients (71). In contrast synthesis of album i n is less than normal (56) and there is some evidence that a factor in the blood of the tumor-bearing host m a y suppress albumin synthesis
(59).
Synthesis of muscle proteins is generally depressed and breakdown increased (21, 22, 23, 31, 32, 33). Reduction in protein synthesis is comparable to that of pair-fed healthy controls who showed however a decreased breakdown of muscle protein. W h e n protein synthesis is measured in cultures of tissues , the depressed synthesis is only partially corrected by an addition of an excess of aminoacids (32) or insulin (36). Enzyme activities in muscle tissue of patients w i t h cancer show depression of key enzymes of anabolism and increases activity of catabolic enzymes such as Cathepsin D w h i c h correlates w i t h the increased protein degradation. Aminoacids released from skeletal muscle are used for tumor protein synthesis and for gluconeogenesis to provide glucose for tumor metabolism (44, 18). Carbohydrate metabolism Carbohydrates provides a major source of the energy requirements of tumor tissue which metabolizes glucose predominantly v i a anaerobic glycolysis. The uptake of glucose is proportionate to tumor size and is approximately 1.4 g/24h/g of tumor according to perfusion experiments by Norton (45).This level of glucose uptake(230g/24h) by tumor agrees w i t h the increased g l u cose turnover of 170 g/24h reported by Holroyde (25). One consequence of anaerobic metabolism is the release into circulation of lactate by tumor cells. The recycling of lactate v i a the Cori cycle requires an energy e x penditure of 6 moles of ATP per mole of glucose synthesized. The anaerobic breakdown of glucose to lactic acid by the tumor yields 2 moles of ATP for a potential net loss of 8 moles of high-energy phosphate by normal tissue. If production of lactate exceeds the ability of liver or kidney to m e t a b o lize it, lactic acidosis m a y develop. Excessive lactate production m a y have a role in producing anorexia. A n interesting feature of carbohydrate metabolism w h i c h m a y be relevant to cachexia is abnormality of glucose
in-
tolerance (38, 5 1 , 66, 70). Various authors have demonstrated that cancer patients have a higher m e a n blood glucose, w i t h a slower insulin response,
473 lower insulin/glucose ratio and insulin resistance when compared to controls (48, 50, 51). Lipid metabolism The cachectic patients demonstrate an overt wasting of body fat. Free fatty acids serve as an important metabolic full for the liver, the cortex of the kidney, and cardiac and skeletal muscle. Under conditions of long-term fasting the latter three tissues, as well as the brain, can obtain energy from the combustion of acetoacetate and ^-hydroxybutyrrate, and the ketone bodies which are products of fatty acid oxidation. Fasting free fatty acid levels are usually normal (25, 48) in the cancer patients and they fall appropriately in response to insulin (36, 47). However, free fatty acid oxidation was suppressed to a lesser extent by glucose loading of cancer patients than that observed in normal controls (66) in contrast to recent observations by Axelrod and Costa. The decreased suppression of free fatty acid oxidation probably reflects utilization of glycerol for the accelerated gluconeogenesis (47). CONCLUSION Interest in cancer cachexia is not merely speculative. It has been demonstrated that 10-23% of terminal cancer patients ultimately die exclusively because of cachexia (26, 61). More recently DeWys et al. (16) using data from 3047 patients enrolled in 12 protocols of the Eastern Cooperative Oncology Group, definitely showed that median survival was significantly shorter in nine protocols for the patients with weight loss compared with the patients with no weight loss, and chemotherapy response rate were lower in patients with weight loss. Decreasing weight and frequency of weight loss were generally correlated with decreasing performance status and with increasing number of anatomic sites involved with metastases, but within homogeneous performance status categories and categories of anatomic involvement, weight loss was associated with decreased median survival. As it always occurs when people get interested in some kind of clinical nutrition which is not directly related to starvation, as cancer cachexia or infection or injury, the boundaries between alterations due to uncomplicated undernutrition and dismetabolic malnutrition are not clear. Even if we define the nutritional status, according to an old definition as "the who-
474 le of physical and biochemical parameters which are altered by a poor or unbalanced nutrition and are reversed to normal by an adeguate intake of nutrients" (F. Black, personal communication), we frequently observe that some "nutritional" parameters are altered in these diseases independently from the nutritional state and it is therefore unlikely that they may be corrected by a conventional nutritional support. Knowledge of the metabolic alterations of cancer is therefore essential to the clinicians involved to the nutritional support of patients with cancer and to the researchers who are interested to the nutritional manipulation of cancer.
References 1.
Axelrod L., Costa G.: Cancer 2: 81-83, 1980.
2.
Barry R.E. : Gut 15: 562
3.
Boothbay W.M., Sandiford I.: J. Biol. Chem. 54: 783
, 1974.
4.
Bozzetti F.: Argom. Oncol, (in stampa).
5.
Bozzetti F., Migliavacca S., Scotti A., Bonalumi M.G., Scarpa D., Ba-
, 1922.
ticci F., Ammatuna M., Pupa A., Terno G., Sequeira C., Masserini M., Emanuelli H.: Ann. Surg. 196: 170-179, 1982. 6.
Bozzetti F., Pagnoni A.M., Del Vecchio M.: Surg. Gyn. Obstet. 150:
7.
Brezechwa-Ajdukiewicz A., McCarthy C.F., Austad W., Cornes J., Harri-
8.
Burke M., Bryson E.I., Kart E.A. Br. Med. J.
9.
Burt M.E., Stein T.P., Schwabe J.G. et al.: Am. J. Clin. Nutr. 34:
229-234, 1980. son W.J., and Read AEA. Gut 7: 572
, 1966. 211-215, 1980.
628, 1981. 10.
Carmichael M.J., Clagne M.B., Keir M.J., Johnston I.D.A.: Br. J. Surg.
11.
Cohn S.H., Gartenhaus A., Sawitsky A., Rai K., Zanzi I., Vaswani A.,
67: 736-739, 1980. Ellis K.J., Yasumara S., Cortes E., Vantsky D.: Metabolism 30: 222229, 1981. 12.
Creamer B.: Br. Med. J. 2: 1435, 1964.
475 13. Deller D., Murrell T.G.C., Blowes R.: Austral Ann. Med. 16: 236 1967. 14. Devlin T.K., Costa G.: Proc. Soc. Exp. Biol. Med., 116: 1095, 1964. 15. Devlin T.M., Pruss M.P.: Fed. Proc. 17: 211
, 1958.
16. DeWys W.D., Begg C., Layin P.T. et al.s Am. J. Med. 69: 491-497, 198a 17.
Dymock J.W., Mackay N., Miller V., Thomson T.J., Gray B., Kennedy E.H., Adams J.F.: Br. J. Cancer 21: 505
, 1967.
18. Fenninger L.D., Mider G.B.: Adv. Cancer Res. 2: 229 19.
H.M.: Cancer 18: 1278 20.
, 1954.
Fischer R.A., Rosoff B.M., Altshuler J.J., Thayer W.R. Jr., Spiro , 1965.
Gilat T., Fischel B., Dammon J., Loenthal M.: Digestion 7: 147
,
1972. 21.
Gold J.: Ann. N.Y. Acad. Sei 230: 103
22.
Goodlad G.A.J., Clark C.M.: Eur. J. Cancer 16: 1153-1162, 1980.
, 1974.
23.
Goodlad G.A.J., Tee M.K., Clark C.M.: Biochem. Med. 26: 143-147, 1981.
24.
Green A.A.: Cancer Res. 20: 233
25.
Holroyde C.P., Gaburda T.G., Putnam R.C., Paul P., Reichard G.A.:
, 1960.
Cancer Res. 35: 3710-3714, 1975. 26.
Inagaki J., Rodriguez V., Bodey G.B.: Cancer 53: 568-573, 1974.
27.
Keys A., Brozek J., Herschel A., et al.: Vol. 1 Minnesota: Universi-
28.
Klipstein F.A., Smarth G.: Am. J. Dig. Dis. 14: 887
ty of Minnesota. Press. 1950. , 1969.
29.
Krebs H.A.: Adv. Enzyme Regul. 10: 397
30.
Loehry C.A., Creamer B.: Br. Med. J. 1: 827
, 1972.
31.
Lundholm K., Bemegard K., Eden E., Svaninger G., Emery P.W., Remie
, 1966.
M.J.: Cancer Res. 42: 4807-4811, 1982. 32.
Lundholm K., Bylund A.C., Holm J., Scherstein T.: Eur. J. Cancer 12: 465
, 1976.
33.
Lundholm K., Edstrom S., Ekman L. et al.: Cancer 42: 453-461, 1978.
34.
Lundholm K., Ekman L., Edstrom S., Karlberg I., Jagenburg R., Schersten T.: Cancer Res. 39: 4657-4661, 1979.
35.
Lundholm K., Ekman L., Karlberg I., Edstrom S., Schersten T.: Cancer Res., 40: 1680-1685, 1980.
476 57.
Terepka A . R . , Waterhouse C . : A m . J . Med. 20: 225
58.
Theologides A . : A n n . N Y . Acad. Sci 230: 14-22,
59.
Toporek M . : Cancer Res. 31: 1962,
, 1956
1974.
1971.
60.
Warburg 0 . : L o n d o n , Constable,
61.
Warnold I., Lundholm K . , and Schersten T.: Cancer Res. 38:
62.
W a r r e n S.: A m . J. M e d . Sci 184: 610-615,
63.
Waterhouse C.: Cancer 33: 66
64.
Waterhouse C.: Ann. NY Acad. Sci 230: 86
65.
Waterhouse C.L., Fenninger L.D., Keutmann E . H . : Cancer 4 : 500
66.
Waterhouse C., K e m p e r m a n J.H.: Cancer Res., 31: 1273-1278,
67.
W a t k i n D.M.: A m . J . Clin. Nutr. 9: 446
68.
W a t k i n D.M., Steinfield J.L.: A m . J . Clin. N u t r . 16: 182,
69.
W a t s o n W . S . , Sammon A . M . : Cancer 4 6 : 2041-2046,
70.
Young V.R.: Cancer Res. 37: 2336-2347,
8807,
1930. 1801-
1978. 1932.
, 1974. ,1974. ,
1951. 1971.
, 1961.
1977.
1980.
1965.
MARKER PROTEINS OF INFLAMMATION AND NUTRITION IN ADVANCED CANCER
Laurent Deneux, Marco Magalhaesf Henri Magdelenat, Pierre Pouillart Institut Curie - 75231 Paris Cédex - France * Universidade Fédéral da Paraiba - Brésil
Introduction The host-tumor relashionship is more and more frequently evoked as a control mechanism of tumor progression (1,2). Among the parameters easily attainable in the investigation of the host response to a tumor burden are the marker proteins of inflammation and nutrition. Some of these proteins, particularly those with a rapid metabolic turnover or a sensitive "switchon - switch-off" synthesis may prove to be usefull for the follow-up of the disease and the efficiency of the therapy. Three marker proteins of nutrition, the retinol binding protein (RBP), prealbumin (PA) and transferrin
(TF) and a marker protein of inflammation,
C reactive protein (CRP) were assayed in ^2 patients with advanced cancers before and during the course of chemotherapy. The initial values were compared to those of healthy donors and cancer patients in clinical remission.
Patients and Methods Cancer bearing patients : 4-2 patients admitted at the Institut Curie for chemotherapy of advanced cancer (CA).
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter d e Gruyter & Co., Berlin • N e w York - Printed in G e r m a n y
478
Table 1 : Cancer patients (Age : 21-65 ; Mean : 47) Primary site
Number
With metastasis
With liver metastasis
Breast
7
6
ORL
5
4
Ovary
4
2
Cervix
4
4
Lung
3
2
Testis
3
3
Sarcoma
3
2
Kidney
2
2
Uterus
2
1
Melanoma
2
1
Other
7
4
4 1 1
Normal values were obtained from 100 healthy blood donors (N) 50 patients in complete remission were also assayed (REM). Serum proteins were assayed by immunonephelemetry using Atlantic Antibodies and a Hyland Disc 120 Nephelometer. Carcinoembryonic antigen (ACE) was assayed by radioimmunoassay
(CIS).
Results As seen in Figure 1, initial CRP values are generally elevated in cancer patients (22/42 patients above the upper normal limit) in contrast with REM patients who do not differ from normals. The difference is statistically significant (p 0,30
"lower
upper limit
0,10 limit
Figure 1 : orosomucoid and prealbumin serum levels at the onset (O) and at the recovery ( R )
References
1. Reid M.M., Craft A.W. and Cox J.R. : J. Clin. Pathol. 34, 479-482 (1981). 2. Koller M.E., Romslo I., Finne P.H. and Haneberg B. : Acta Paediatr. Scand. 68, 93-96 (1979). 3. Schofield K.P., Voulgari F., Gozzard D.I., Leyland M.J., Beeching N.J. and Stuart J. : J. Clin. Pathol. 35, 866-869 (1982). 4. Caldani C., Milano G., Thyss A., Lesbats,G. and Schneider M. : Nouv. Presse Med. U , 3576 (1982).
COMPARISON BETWEEN CRP SERUM VALUES AND HEMATOLOGICAL PARAMETERS FOR DIAGNOSIS AND THERAPEUTIC SURVEILLANCE OF NEONATAL
INFECTION
C. Benattar, D. Vauzelle and A . Lindenbaum Laboratoire de Biochimie (R. Leluc), Hopital A Beclere, 157 Rue de la porte de Trivaux, 921^1 Clamart (France)
J.F. Magny See de Reanimation neonatale (J.C. Gabilan), Hopital A Beclere, 157 Rue de la porte de Trivaux, 921^1 Clamart (France)
The severity of neonatal infections and the scarcity of their clinical symptoms at an early stage has promoted the research for biological parameters of infection which would be both reliable and precocious. a i m of this work was to compare the value of CRP a n d hematologic for an early diagnosis of neonatal
The
criteria
infection.
The clinical samples included 36 newborn hospitalized during the first 3 days of life which were suspected of maternofetal infection. lated C R P values measured by radial immunodiffusion Behring) w i t h hematologic parameters of infection
We c o r r e -
(Partigen LC plates,
(hyperfibrinogenemia,
neutrophilia or neutropenia, myelemia, thrombopenia) a n d w i t h the bacteriological tests.
The latter allowed to differentiate
retrospectively three groups of children.
1.
Eleven newborns presented w i t h septicemia and CRP levels were above
18 mg/1 (19-122 mg/1, m e a n 68.5) at the first examination performed between 2 and 31* hours
(except for 3 patients admitted at 72 hours).
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
486 Initial hematological examinations, performed at the same time as CRP measurement, showed significant abnormalities due to infection in only 27% of the patients.
At U8 hours, 73% of these exhibited clear-cut
hematological abnormalities. regular
The follow-up of CRP levels showed a
decrease of its values, with normal values between 2 and 10 days
following efficient antibiotic treatment. 2.
Nine children had at least 2 bacteriological examinations positive
for the same infectious agent.
One of them had CRP values at 6 mg/1 and
in two of them CRP could not be detected. present any hematological abnormalities.
These three newborns did not The remaining six had increased
CRP levels (l8 - 100 mg/1, mean 20.6) of which only one presented hematological abnormalities following admission, and three after H8 hours. In three cases, the clinical symptoms favored a real infection, but for the other two, it was not possible to confirm the infection; however, in view of the high CRP levels, they were considered as infected and treated accordingly. 3.
Sixteen children had negative bacteriological examinations.
Only one
of them had a high CRP value (21 mg/l) at 15 hours without hematological abnormalities.
CRP levels were not detectable in the 15 other patients,
6 of which had only one, and two had two hematological abnormalities. In conclusion, CRP levels appear to be a valuable parameter: - for a precocious diagnosis of neonatal infection; - for the separation of the children with infection from those which are settled; - and to follow the efficacy of the treatment.
487 Therefore, the determination of CRP values should allow an early diagnosis and a more efficient use of antibiotic treatment in newborns in w h i c h an infection is questioned.
C O N T R I B U T I O N O F P R I N C I P A L C O M P O N E N T S A N A L Y S I S TO T H E S T U D Y O F FLAMMATORY
A N D N U T R I T I O N A L S T A T U S ON I N T E N S I V E C A R E
•Jfr
-3-
-K-
C L A V E L J . P . , G E R B E T D., D I E M E R T M . C . , G A L L I J . , G A L L I
-ft
IN-
PATIENTS
A.,
L a b o r a t o i r e de B i o c h i m i e de l a S a l p é t r i è r e 4 7 , B o u l e v a r d de l ' H ô p i t a l 7 5 0 1 3 P A R I S .
GLASER**P. S e r v i c e d ' A n e s t h é s i e R é a n i m a t i o n de l a P I T I E
INTRODUCTION
The
biological
status The
survey
interpretation
difficult and often The
application
variables
of
principal data
of
in p o s t - o p e r a t i v e
and
of
data
to
multiple
entire
MATERIALS -
METHODS
We
a
by
the
biologist
non
statistical
automated
level serum acid
of
analysis)
allows
and concrete
multiple
of
seven
analysis
protein,
of
laser
albumin,
glycoprotein
Multidimensionnal analysis,
the
physician
view
indépendant
a simple of
patients
who
instrument
evolution
were
was
each
of in
(like complex
relation
IgG,
to
IgM,
and
to
serum
determine
ceruloplasmin, atomic
absorption
levels.
t r e a t m e n t of these data, p e r f o r m e d by principal a method
every
determine
method
transferrin, IgA,
surveyed
surgery.
used
immunonephelemetric
prealbumin,
(orosomucoid),
is
is
biological
procedure
description
patient
spectrometric m e t h o d for zinc and copper p l a s m a
nents
or
tests.
tions.
sample
total
levels
immunological
laboratory
analysis
t h r e e o r f o u r d a y s d u r i n g a 3 - 4 weeks p e r i o d a f t e r An
and
a lot of
quantitative
multidimensionnal
to t h e t e s t e d f u n c -
present
these
nutritional
requires
incomplete.
components an
inflammatory, patients,
to p r e s e n t p a t i e n t s a n d t e s t s
Marker Proteins in Inflammation, Vol. 2 © 1984 Walter de Gruyter & Co., Berlin • New York - Printed in Germany
compo-
in a t w o
axis
490
AXE "Inflammatoire
«.V
(•Il
Éi)
a
trf.
Cu " cerul.
li.
prealb. album. Zn ai.-macro. prot.
.s r « AXE "Nutritionnel"
I9G I9M I9A
il
ïl
i i l " of romcuter
rtonnnmO
ë
491 system
in
analyses
relation
to
correlations
which
they are most discriminate.
between
variables
in
order
to
This method
reveal
masked
informations in univariate analysis, and to observe groupings of variables raising various hypothesis. This multidimensionnal analysis method can be used on most microcomputers .
RESULTS
We observed
the usual correlations between Zinc/Prealbumin,
Zinc/Albu-
min, Copper/Ceruleoplasmin, Ceruloplasmin/®